2005-11-07 Andrew Stubbs <andrew.stubbs@st.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
93 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
198 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
217 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
218
219 @menu
220 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
221 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
222 @end menu
223
224 @node Free Software
225 @unnumberedsec Free software
226
227 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
228 General Public License
229 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
230 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
231 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
232 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
233 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
234 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
235
236 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
237 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
238 from anyone else.
239
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
241
242 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
243 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
244 include with the free software. Many of our most important
245 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
246 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
247 when an important free software package does not come with a free
248 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
249 gaps today.
250
251 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
252 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
253 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
254 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
255 them from the free software world.
256
257 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
258 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
259 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
260 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
261 contract to make it non-free.
262
263 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
264 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
265 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
266 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
267 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
268 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
269 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
270
271 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
272 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
273 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
274 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
275
276 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
277 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
278 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
279 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
280 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
281 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
282 community.
283
284 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
285 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
286 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
287 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
288 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
289 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
290 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
291 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
292 of the manual.
293
294 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
295 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
296 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
297 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
298 manual to replace it.
299
300 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
301 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
302 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
303 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
304 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
305 the free software community.
306
307 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
308 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
309 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
310 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
311 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
312 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
313 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
314 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
315 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
316
317 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
318 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
319 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
320 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
321 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
322 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
323 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
324 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
325
326 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
327 published by other publishers, at
328 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
329
330 @node Contributors
331 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
332
333 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
334 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
335 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
336 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
337 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
338 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
339 blow-by-blow account.
340
341 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
342
343 @quotation
344 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
345 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
346 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
347 @end quotation
348
349 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
350 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
351 releases:
352 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
353 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
354 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
355 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
356 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
357 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
358 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
359 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
360 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
361
362 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
363 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
364
365 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
366 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
367 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
368 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
369 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
370
371 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
372 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
373 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
374
375 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
376 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
377
378 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
379
380 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
381 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
382 support.
383 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
384 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
385 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
386 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
387 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
388 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
389 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
390 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
391 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
392 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
393 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
394 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
395 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
396 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
397 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
398 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
399
400 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
401
402 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
403 libraries.
404
405 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
406 about several machine instruction sets.
407
408 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
409 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
410 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
411 and RDI targets, respectively.
412
413 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
414 command-line editing and command history.
415
416 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
417 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
418
419 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
420 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
421 symbols.
422
423 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
424 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
425
426 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
427
428 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
429 processors.
430
431 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
432
433 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
434
435 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
436
437 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
438 watchpoints.
439
440 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
441
442 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
443
444 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
445 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
446
447 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
448 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
449 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
450 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
451 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
452 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
453 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
454
455 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
456 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
457
458 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
459 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
460 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
461 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
462 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
463 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
464 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
465 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
466 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
467 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
468 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
469 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
470 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
471 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
472 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
473
474 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
475 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
476
477 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
478 Hat.
479
480 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
481 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
482 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
483 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
484 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
485 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
486
487 @node Sample Session
488 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
489
490 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
491 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
492 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
493
494 @iftex
495 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
496 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
497 @end iftex
498
499 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
500 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
501
502 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
503 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
504 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
505 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
506 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
507 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
508 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
509 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
510 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
511
512 @smallexample
513 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
514 $ @b{./m4}
515 @b{define(foo,0000)}
516
517 @b{foo}
518 0000
519 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
520
521 @b{bar}
522 0000
523 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
524
525 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
526 @b{baz}
527 @b{C-d}
528 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
529 @end smallexample
530
531 @noindent
532 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
533
534 @smallexample
535 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
536 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
537 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
538 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
539 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
540 the conditions.
541 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
542 for details.
543
544 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
545 (@value{GDBP})
546 @end smallexample
547
548 @noindent
549 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
550 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
551 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
552 that examples fit in this manual.
553
554 @smallexample
555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
556 @end smallexample
557
558 @noindent
559 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
560 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
561 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
562 @code{break} command.
563
564 @smallexample
565 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
566 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
567 @end smallexample
568
569 @noindent
570 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
571 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
572 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
573
574 @smallexample
575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
576 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @end smallexample
582
583 @noindent
584 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
585 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
586 context where it stops.
587
588 @smallexample
589 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
590
591 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
592 at builtin.c:879
593 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
594 @end smallexample
595
596 @noindent
597 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
598 the next line of the current function.
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
602 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
603 : nil,
604 @end smallexample
605
606 @noindent
607 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
608 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
609 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
610 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
611
612 @smallexample
613 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
614 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
615 at input.c:530
616 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
621 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
622 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
623 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
624 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
625 stack frame for each active subroutine.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
629 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
630 at input.c:530
631 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
632 at builtin.c:882
633 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
634 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
635 at macro.c:71
636 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
637 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
642 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
643 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
644
645 @smallexample
646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
647 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
649 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
650 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
652 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
653 : xstrdup(rq);
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
655 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
660 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
661 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
662 (@code{print}) to see their values.
663
664 @smallexample
665 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
666 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
668 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
673 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
674 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
675
676 @smallexample
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
678 533 xfree(rquote);
679 534
680 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
681 : xstrdup (lq);
682 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
683 : xstrdup (rq);
684 537
685 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
686 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
687 540 @}
688 541
689 542 void
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
694 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
695
696 @smallexample
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
698 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
699 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
700 540 @}
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
702 $3 = 9
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
704 $4 = 7
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
709 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
710 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
711 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
712 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
713 assignments.
714
715 @smallexample
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
717 $5 = 7
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
719 $6 = 9
720 @end smallexample
721
722 @noindent
723 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
724 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
725 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
726 example that caused trouble initially:
727
728 @smallexample
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
730 Continuing.
731
732 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
733
734 baz
735 0000
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
740 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
741 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
742
743 @smallexample
744 @b{C-d}
745 Program exited normally.
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
750 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
751 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
755 @end smallexample
756
757 @node Invocation
758 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
759
760 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
761 The essentials are:
762 @itemize @bullet
763 @item
764 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
765 @item
766 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
767 @end itemize
768
769 @menu
770 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
771 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
772 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
773 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
774 @end menu
775
776 @node Invoking GDB
777 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
778
779 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
780 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
781
782 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
783 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
784
785 The command-line options described here are designed
786 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
787 options may effectively be unavailable.
788
789 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
790 specifying an executable program:
791
792 @smallexample
793 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
794 @end smallexample
795
796 @noindent
797 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
798 specified:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
802 @end smallexample
803
804 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
805 to debug a running process:
806
807 @smallexample
808 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
813 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
814
815 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
816 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
817 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
818 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
819 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
820
821 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
822 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
823 option processing.
824 @smallexample
825 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
826 @end smallexample
827 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
828 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
829
830 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
831 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} -silent
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
839 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
840
841 @noindent
842 Type
843
844 @smallexample
845 @value{GDBP} -help
846 @end smallexample
847
848 @noindent
849 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
850 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
851
852 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
853 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
854 @samp{-x} option is used.
855
856
857 @menu
858 * File Options:: Choosing files
859 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
860 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
861 @end menu
862
863 @node File Options
864 @subsection Choosing files
865
866 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
867 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
868 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
869 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
870 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
871 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
872 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
873 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
874 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
875 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
876 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
877 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
878 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
879
880 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
881 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
882 argument and ignore it.
883
884 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
885 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
886 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
887 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
888 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
889
890 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
891 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
892 @c it.
893
894 @table @code
895 @item -symbols @var{file}
896 @itemx -s @var{file}
897 @cindex @code{--symbols}
898 @cindex @code{-s}
899 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
900
901 @item -exec @var{file}
902 @itemx -e @var{file}
903 @cindex @code{--exec}
904 @cindex @code{-e}
905 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
906 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
907
908 @item -se @var{file}
909 @cindex @code{--se}
910 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
911 file.
912
913 @item -core @var{file}
914 @itemx -c @var{file}
915 @cindex @code{--core}
916 @cindex @code{-c}
917 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
918
919 @item -c @var{number}
920 @item -pid @var{number}
921 @itemx -p @var{number}
922 @cindex @code{--pid}
923 @cindex @code{-p}
924 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
925 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
926 file named @var{number}.
927
928 @item -command @var{file}
929 @itemx -x @var{file}
930 @cindex @code{--command}
931 @cindex @code{-x}
932 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
933 Files,, Command files}.
934
935 @item -eval-command @var{command}
936 @itemx -ex @var{command}
937 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
938 @cindex @code{-ex}
939 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
940
941 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
942 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
943
944 @smallexample
945 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
946 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
947 @end smallexample
948
949 @item -directory @var{directory}
950 @itemx -d @var{directory}
951 @cindex @code{--directory}
952 @cindex @code{-d}
953 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
954
955 @item -r
956 @itemx -readnow
957 @cindex @code{--readnow}
958 @cindex @code{-r}
959 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
960 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
961 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
962
963 @end table
964
965 @node Mode Options
966 @subsection Choosing modes
967
968 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
969 batch mode or quiet mode.
970
971 @table @code
972 @item -nx
973 @itemx -n
974 @cindex @code{--nx}
975 @cindex @code{-n}
976 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
977 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
978 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
979 files}.
980
981 @item -quiet
982 @itemx -silent
983 @itemx -q
984 @cindex @code{--quiet}
985 @cindex @code{--silent}
986 @cindex @code{-q}
987 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
988 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
989
990 @item -batch
991 @cindex @code{--batch}
992 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
993 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
994 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
995 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
996 in the command files.
997
998 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
999 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1000 make this more useful, the message
1001
1002 @smallexample
1003 Program exited normally.
1004 @end smallexample
1005
1006 @noindent
1007 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1008 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1009 mode.
1010
1011 @item -batch-silent
1012 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1013 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1014 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1015 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1016 for an interactive session.
1017
1018 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1019 messages, for example.
1020
1021 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1022 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1023
1024 @item -return-child-result
1025 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1026 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1027 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1028
1029 @itemize @bullet
1030 @item
1031 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1032 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1033 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1034 @item
1035 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1036 @item
1037 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1038 the exit code will be -1.
1039 @end itemize
1040
1041 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1042 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1043 interface.
1044
1045 @item -nowindows
1046 @itemx -nw
1047 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1048 @cindex @code{-nw}
1049 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1050 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1051 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1052
1053 @item -windows
1054 @itemx -w
1055 @cindex @code{--windows}
1056 @cindex @code{-w}
1057 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1058 used if possible.
1059
1060 @item -cd @var{directory}
1061 @cindex @code{--cd}
1062 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1063 instead of the current directory.
1064
1065 @item -fullname
1066 @itemx -f
1067 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1068 @cindex @code{-f}
1069 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1070 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1071 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1072 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1073 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1074 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1075 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1076 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1077 frame.
1078
1079 @item -epoch
1080 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1081 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1082 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1083 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1084 separate window.
1085
1086 @item -annotate @var{level}
1087 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1088 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1089 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1090 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1091 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1092 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1093 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1094 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1095 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1096
1097 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1098 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1099
1100 @item --args
1101 @cindex @code{--args}
1102 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1103 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1104 This option stops option processing.
1105
1106 @item -baud @var{bps}
1107 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1108 @cindex @code{--baud}
1109 @cindex @code{-b}
1110 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1111 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1112
1113 @item -l @var{timeout}
1114 @cindex @code{-l}
1115 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1116 for remote debugging.
1117
1118 @item -tty @var{device}
1119 @itemx -t @var{device}
1120 @cindex @code{--tty}
1121 @cindex @code{-t}
1122 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1123 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1124
1125 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1126 @item -tui
1127 @cindex @code{--tui}
1128 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1129 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1130 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1131 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1132 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1133 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1134 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1135
1136 @c @item -xdb
1137 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1138 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1139 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1140 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1141 @c systems.
1142
1143 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1144 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1145 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1146 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1147 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1148 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1149
1150 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1151 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1152 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1153 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1154 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1155 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1156
1157 @item -write
1158 @cindex @code{--write}
1159 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1160 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1161 (@pxref{Patching}).
1162
1163 @item -statistics
1164 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1165 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1166 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1167
1168 @item -version
1169 @cindex @code{--version}
1170 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1171 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1172
1173 @end table
1174
1175 @node Startup
1176 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1177 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1178
1179 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1180
1181 @enumerate
1182 @item
1183 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1184 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1185
1186 @item
1187 @cindex init file
1188 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1189 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1190 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1191 that file.
1192
1193 @item
1194 Processes command line options and operands.
1195
1196 @item
1197 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1198 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1199 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1200 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1201 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1202 @value{GDBN}.
1203
1204 @item
1205 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1206 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1207
1208 @item
1209 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1210 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1211 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1212 @end enumerate
1213
1214 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1215 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1216 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1217 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1218 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1219 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1220
1221 @cindex init file name
1222 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1223 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1224 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1225 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1226 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1227 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1228 environments with special init file names:
1229
1230 @itemize @bullet
1231 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1232 @item
1233 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1234 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1235 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1236 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1237 the file to the standard name.
1238
1239 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1240 @item
1241 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1242
1243 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1244 @item
1245 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1246
1247 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1248 @item
1249 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1250
1251 @item
1252 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1253 @end itemize
1254
1255
1256 @node Quitting GDB
1257 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1259 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1260
1261 @table @code
1262 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1263 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1264 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1265 @itemx q
1266 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1267 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1268 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1269 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1270 error code.
1271 @end table
1272
1273 @cindex interrupt
1274 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1275 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1276 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1277 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1278 until a time when it is safe.
1279
1280 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1281 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1282 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1283
1284 @node Shell Commands
1285 @section Shell commands
1286
1287 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1288 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1289 just use the @code{shell} command.
1290
1291 @table @code
1292 @kindex shell
1293 @cindex shell escape
1294 @item shell @var{command string}
1295 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1296 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1297 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1298 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1299 @end table
1300
1301 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1302 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1303 @value{GDBN}:
1304
1305 @table @code
1306 @kindex make
1307 @cindex calling make
1308 @item make @var{make-args}
1309 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1310 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1311 @end table
1312
1313 @node Logging output
1314 @section Logging output
1315 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1316 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1317
1318 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1319 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1320
1321 @table @code
1322 @kindex set logging
1323 @item set logging on
1324 Enable logging.
1325 @item set logging off
1326 Disable logging.
1327 @cindex logging file name
1328 @item set logging file @var{file}
1329 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1330 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1331 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1332 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1333 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1334 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1335 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1336 @kindex show logging
1337 @item show logging
1338 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1339 @end table
1340
1341 @node Commands
1342 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1343
1344 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1345 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1346 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1347 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1348 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1349
1350 @menu
1351 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1352 * Completion:: Command completion
1353 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1354 @end menu
1355
1356 @node Command Syntax
1357 @section Command syntax
1358
1359 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1360 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1361 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1362 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1363 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1364 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1365
1366 @cindex abbreviation
1367 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1368 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1369 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1370 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1371 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1372 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1373 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1374
1375 @cindex repeating commands
1376 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1377 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1378 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1379 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1380 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1381 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1382 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1383
1384 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1385 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1386 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1387
1388 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1389 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1390 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1391 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1392 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1393
1394 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1395 @cindex comment
1396 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1397 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1398 Files,,Command files}).
1399
1400 @cindex repeating command sequences
1401 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1402 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1403 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1404 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1405 for editing.
1406
1407 @node Completion
1408 @section Command completion
1409
1410 @cindex completion
1411 @cindex word completion
1412 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1413 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1414 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1415 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1416
1417 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1418 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1419 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1420 enter it). For example, if you type
1421
1422 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1423 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1424 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1425 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1426 @smallexample
1427 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1428 @end smallexample
1429
1430 @noindent
1431 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1432 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1433
1434 @smallexample
1435 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1436 @end smallexample
1437
1438 @noindent
1439 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1440 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1441 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1442 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1443 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1444 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1445
1446 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1447 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1448 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1449 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1450 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1451 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1452 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1453 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1454 example:
1455
1456 @smallexample
1457 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1458 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1459 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1460 make_abs_section make_function_type
1461 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1462 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1463 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1464 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1465 @end smallexample
1466
1467 @noindent
1468 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1469 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1470 command.
1471
1472 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1473 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1474 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1475 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1476 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1477
1478 @cindex quotes in commands
1479 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1480 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1481 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1482 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1483 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1484 @value{GDBN} commands.
1485
1486 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1487 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1488 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1489 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1490 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1491 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1492 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1493 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1494 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1495 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1496 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1497
1498 @smallexample
1499 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1500 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1501 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1502 @end smallexample
1503
1504 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1505 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1506 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1507 place:
1508
1509 @smallexample
1510 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1511 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1513 @end smallexample
1514
1515 @noindent
1516 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1517 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1518 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1519
1520 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1521 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1522 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1523 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1524
1525
1526 @node Help
1527 @section Getting help
1528 @cindex online documentation
1529 @kindex help
1530
1531 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1532 using the command @code{help}.
1533
1534 @table @code
1535 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1536 @item help
1537 @itemx h
1538 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1539 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1540
1541 @smallexample
1542 (@value{GDBP}) help
1543 List of classes of commands:
1544
1545 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1546 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1547 data -- Examining data
1548 files -- Specifying and examining files
1549 internals -- Maintenance commands
1550 obscure -- Obscure features
1551 running -- Running the program
1552 stack -- Examining the stack
1553 status -- Status inquiries
1554 support -- Support facilities
1555 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1556 stopping the program
1557 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1558
1559 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1560 commands in that class.
1561 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1562 documentation.
1563 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1564 (@value{GDBP})
1565 @end smallexample
1566 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1567
1568 @item help @var{class}
1569 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1570 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1571 help display for the class @code{status}:
1572
1573 @smallexample
1574 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1575 Status inquiries.
1576
1577 List of commands:
1578
1579 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1580 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1581 info -- Generic command for showing things
1582 about the program being debugged
1583 show -- Generic command for showing things
1584 about the debugger
1585
1586 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1587 documentation.
1588 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1589 (@value{GDBP})
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @item help @var{command}
1593 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1594 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1595
1596 @kindex apropos
1597 @item apropos @var{args}
1598 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1599 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1600 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1601
1602 @smallexample
1603 apropos reload
1604 @end smallexample
1605
1606 @noindent
1607 results in:
1608
1609 @smallexample
1610 @c @group
1611 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1612 multiple times in one run
1613 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1614 multiple times in one run
1615 @c @end group
1616 @end smallexample
1617
1618 @kindex complete
1619 @item complete @var{args}
1620 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1621 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1622 command you want completed. For example:
1623
1624 @smallexample
1625 complete i
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent results in:
1629
1630 @smallexample
1631 @group
1632 if
1633 ignore
1634 info
1635 inspect
1636 @end group
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1640 @end table
1641
1642 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1643 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1644 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1645 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1646 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1647 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1648
1649 @c @group
1650 @table @code
1651 @kindex info
1652 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1653 @item info
1654 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1655 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1656 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1657 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1658 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1659 @w{@code{help info}}.
1660
1661 @kindex set
1662 @item set
1663 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1664 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1665 @code{set prompt $}.
1666
1667 @kindex show
1668 @item show
1669 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1670 @value{GDBN} itself.
1671 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1672 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1673 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1674 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1675
1676 @kindex info set
1677 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1678 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1679 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1680 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1681 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1682 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1683 @end table
1684 @c @end group
1685
1686 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1687 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1688
1689 @table @code
1690 @kindex show version
1691 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1692 @item show version
1693 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1694 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1695 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1696 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1697 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1698 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1699 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1700 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1701 @value{GDBN}.
1702
1703 @kindex show copying
1704 @kindex info copying
1705 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1706 @item show copying
1707 @itemx info copying
1708 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1709
1710 @kindex show warranty
1711 @kindex info warranty
1712 @item show warranty
1713 @itemx info warranty
1714 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1715 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1716
1717 @end table
1718
1719 @node Running
1720 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1721
1722 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1723 debugging information when you compile it.
1724
1725 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1726 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1727 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1728 kill a child process.
1729
1730 @menu
1731 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1732 * Starting:: Starting your program
1733 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1734 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1735
1736 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1737 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1738 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1739 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1740
1741 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1742 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1823
1824 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1825 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1826 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1827 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1828 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1829 divided into four categories:
1830
1831 @table @asis
1832 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1833 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1834 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1835 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1836 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1837 the arguments.
1838 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1839 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1840 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1841
1842 @item The @emph{environment.}
1843 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1844 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1845 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1846 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1847
1848 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1849 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1850 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1851 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1854 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1855 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1856 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1857 set a different device for your program.
1858 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1859
1860 @cindex pipes
1861 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1862 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1863 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1864 wrong program.
1865 @end table
1866
1867 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1868 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1869 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1870 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1871 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1872
1873 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1874 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1875 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1876 your current breakpoints.
1877
1878 @table @code
1879 @kindex start
1880 @item start
1881 @cindex run to main procedure
1882 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1883 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1884 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1885 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1886 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1887 procedure, depending on the language used.
1888
1889 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1890 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1891 the @samp{run} command.
1892
1893 @cindex elaboration phase
1894 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1895 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1896 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1897 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1898 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1899 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1900 will remain to halt execution.
1901
1902 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1903 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1904 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1905 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1906 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1907
1908 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1909 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1910 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1911 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1912 elaboration code before running your program.
1913 @end table
1914
1915 @node Arguments
1916 @section Your program's arguments
1917
1918 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1919 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1920 @code{run} command.
1921 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1922 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1923 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1924 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1925 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1926
1927 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1928 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1929 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1930 the program, not by the shell.
1931
1932 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1933 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1934
1935 @table @code
1936 @kindex set args
1937 @item set args
1938 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1939 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1940 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1941 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1942 it again without arguments.
1943
1944 @kindex show args
1945 @item show args
1946 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1947 @end table
1948
1949 @node Environment
1950 @section Your program's environment
1951
1952 @cindex environment (of your program)
1953 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1954 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1955 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1956 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1957 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1958 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1959 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1960
1961 @table @code
1962 @kindex path
1963 @item path @var{directory}
1964 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1965 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1966 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1967 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1968 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1969 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1970 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1971
1972 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1973 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1974 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1975 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1976 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1977 @var{directory} to the search path.
1978 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1979 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1980
1981 @kindex show paths
1982 @item show paths
1983 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1984 environment variable).
1985
1986 @kindex show environment
1987 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1988 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1989 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1990 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1991 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1992
1993 @kindex set environment
1994 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1995 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1996 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1997 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1998 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1999 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2000 null value.
2001 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2002 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2003
2004 For example, this command:
2005
2006 @smallexample
2007 set env USER = foo
2008 @end smallexample
2009
2010 @noindent
2011 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2012 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2013 are not actually required.)
2014
2015 @kindex unset environment
2016 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2017 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2018 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2019 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2020 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2021 @end table
2022
2023 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2024 the shell indicated
2025 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2026 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2027 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2028 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2029 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2030 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2031 @file{.profile}.
2032
2033 @node Working Directory
2034 @section Your program's working directory
2035
2036 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2037 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2038 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2039 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2040 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2041 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2042
2043 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2044 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2045 specify files}.
2046
2047 @table @code
2048 @kindex cd
2049 @cindex change working directory
2050 @item cd @var{directory}
2051 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2052
2053 @kindex pwd
2054 @item pwd
2055 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2056 @end table
2057
2058 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2059 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2060 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2061 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2062 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2063 current working directory of the debuggee.
2064
2065 @node Input/Output
2066 @section Your program's input and output
2067
2068 @cindex redirection
2069 @cindex i/o
2070 @cindex terminal
2071 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2072 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2073 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2074 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2075 running your program.
2076
2077 @table @code
2078 @kindex info terminal
2079 @item info terminal
2080 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2081 program is using.
2082 @end table
2083
2084 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2085 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2086
2087 @smallexample
2088 run > outfile
2089 @end smallexample
2090
2091 @noindent
2092 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2093
2094 @kindex tty
2095 @cindex controlling terminal
2096 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2097 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2098 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2099 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2100 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2101
2102 @smallexample
2103 tty /dev/ttyb
2104 @end smallexample
2105
2106 @noindent
2107 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2108 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2109 that as their controlling terminal.
2110
2111 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2112 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2113 terminal.
2114
2115 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2116 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2117 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2118 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2119
2120 @cindex inferior tty
2121 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2122 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2123 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2124 program.
2125
2126 @table @code
2127 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2128 @kindex set inferior-tty
2129 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2130
2131 @item show inferior-tty
2132 @kindex show inferior-tty
2133 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2134 @end table
2135
2136 @node Attach
2137 @section Debugging an already-running process
2138 @kindex attach
2139 @cindex attach
2140
2141 @table @code
2142 @item attach @var{process-id}
2143 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2144 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2145 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2146 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2147 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2148
2149 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2150 executing the command.
2151 @end table
2152
2153 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2154 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2155 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2156 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2157
2158 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2159 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2160 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2161 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2162 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2163 Specify Files}.
2164
2165 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2166 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2167 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2168 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2169 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2170 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2171 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2172
2173 @table @code
2174 @kindex detach
2175 @item detach
2176 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2177 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2178 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2179 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2180 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2181 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2182 executing the command.
2183 @end table
2184
2185 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2186 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2187 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2188 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2189 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2190 messages}).
2191
2192 @node Kill Process
2193 @section Killing the child process
2194
2195 @table @code
2196 @kindex kill
2197 @item kill
2198 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2199 @end table
2200
2201 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2202 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2203 is running.
2204
2205 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2206 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2207 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2208 outside the debugger.
2209
2210 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2211 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2212 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2213 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2214 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2215 breakpoint settings).
2216
2217 @node Threads
2218 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2219
2220 @cindex threads of execution
2221 @cindex multiple threads
2222 @cindex switching threads
2223 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2224 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2225 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2226 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2227 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2228 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2229 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2230
2231 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2232 programs:
2233
2234 @itemize @bullet
2235 @item automatic notification of new threads
2236 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2237 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2238 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2239 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2240 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2241 @end itemize
2242
2243 @quotation
2244 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2245 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2246 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2247 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2248 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2249 like this:
2250
2251 @smallexample
2252 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2253 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2254 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2255 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2256 @end smallexample
2257 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2258 @c doesn't support threads"?
2259 @end quotation
2260
2261 @cindex focus of debugging
2262 @cindex current thread
2263 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2264 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2265 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2266 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2267 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2268
2269 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2270 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2271 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2272 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2273 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2274 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2275 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2276 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2277 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2278 LynxOS, you might see
2279
2280 @smallexample
2281 [New process 35 thread 27]
2282 @end smallexample
2283
2284 @noindent
2285 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2286 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2287 further qualifier.
2288
2289 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2290 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2291 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2292 @c program?
2293 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2294 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2295 @c threads ab initio?
2296
2297 @cindex thread number
2298 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2299 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2300 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2301
2302 @table @code
2303 @kindex info threads
2304 @item info threads
2305 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2306 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2307
2308 @enumerate
2309 @item
2310 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2311
2312 @item
2313 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2314
2315 @item
2316 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2317 @end enumerate
2318
2319 @noindent
2320 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2321 indicates the current thread.
2322
2323 For example,
2324 @end table
2325 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2326
2327 @smallexample
2328 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2329 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2330 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2331 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2332 at threadtest.c:68
2333 @end smallexample
2334
2335 On HP-UX systems:
2336
2337 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2338 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2339 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2340 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2341 thread in your program.
2342
2343 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2344 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2345 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2346 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2347 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2348 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2349 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2350 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2351 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2352 HP-UX, you see
2353
2354 @smallexample
2355 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2356 @end smallexample
2357
2358 @noindent
2359 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2360
2361 @table @code
2362 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2363 @item info threads
2364 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2365 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2366
2367 @enumerate
2368 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2369
2370 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2371
2372 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2373 @end enumerate
2374
2375 @noindent
2376 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2377 indicates the current thread.
2378
2379 For example,
2380 @end table
2381 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2382
2383 @smallexample
2384 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2385 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2386 at quicksort.c:137
2387 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2388 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2389 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2390 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2391 @end smallexample
2392
2393 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2394 Solaris-specific command:
2395
2396 @table @code
2397 @item maint info sol-threads
2398 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2399 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2400 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2401 @end table
2402
2403 @table @code
2404 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2405 @item thread @var{threadno}
2406 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2407 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2408 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2409 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2410 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2411
2412 @smallexample
2413 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2414 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2415 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2416 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2417 @end smallexample
2418
2419 @noindent
2420 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2421 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2422 threads.
2423
2424 @kindex thread apply
2425 @cindex apply command to several threads
2426 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2427 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2428 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2429 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2430 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2431 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2432 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2433 @end table
2434
2435 @cindex automatic thread selection
2436 @cindex switching threads automatically
2437 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2438 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2439 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2440 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2441 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2442 thread.
2443
2444 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2445 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2446 programs with multiple threads.
2447
2448 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2449 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2450
2451 @node Processes
2452 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2453
2454 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2455 @cindex multiple processes
2456 @cindex processes, multiple
2457 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2458 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2459 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2460 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2461 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2462 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2463 will cause it to terminate.
2464
2465 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2466 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2467 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2468 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2469 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2470 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2471 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2472 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2473 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2474 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2475
2476 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2477 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2478 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2479 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2480
2481 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2482 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2483
2484 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2485 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2486
2487 @table @code
2488 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2489 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2490 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2491 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2492 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2493
2494 @table @code
2495 @item parent
2496 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2497 unimpeded. This is the default.
2498
2499 @item child
2500 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2501 unimpeded.
2502
2503 @end table
2504
2505 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2506 @item show follow-fork-mode
2507 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2508 @end table
2509
2510 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2511 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2512 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2513 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2514 the child process's @code{main}.
2515
2516 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2517 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2518
2519 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2520 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2521 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2522 argument.
2523
2524 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2525 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2526 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2527
2528 @node Stopping
2529 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2530
2531 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2532 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2533 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2534
2535 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2536 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2537 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2538 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2539 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2540 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2541 explicitly request this information at any time.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info program
2545 @item info program
2546 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2547 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2548 @end table
2549
2550 @menu
2551 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2552 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2553 * Signals:: Signals
2554 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2555 @end menu
2556
2557 @node Breakpoints
2558 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2559
2560 @cindex breakpoints
2561 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2562 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2563 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2564 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2565 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2566 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2567 program.
2568
2569 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2570 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2571 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2572 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2573 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2574 call).
2575
2576 @cindex watchpoints
2577 @cindex memory tracing
2578 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2579 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2580 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2581 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2582 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2583 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2584 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2585 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2586
2587 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2588 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2589 Automatic display}.
2590
2591 @cindex catchpoints
2592 @cindex breakpoint on events
2593 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2594 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2595 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2596 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2597 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2598 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2599 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2600
2601 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2602 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2603 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2604 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2605 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2606 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2607 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2608 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2609 enable it again.
2610
2611 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2612 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2613 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2614 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2615 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2616 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2617 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2618
2619 @menu
2620 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2621 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2622 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2623 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2624 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2625 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2626 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2627 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2628 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2629 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2630 @end menu
2631
2632 @node Set Breaks
2633 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2634
2635 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2636 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2637 @c
2638 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2639
2640 @kindex break
2641 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2642 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2643 @cindex latest breakpoint
2644 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2645 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2646 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2647 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2648 convenience variables.
2649
2650 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2651
2652 @table @code
2653 @item break @var{function}
2654 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2655 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2656 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2657 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2658
2659 @item break +@var{offset}
2660 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2661 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2662 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2663 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2664
2665 @item break @var{linenum}
2666 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2667 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2668 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2669 code on that line.
2670
2671 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2672 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2673
2674 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2675 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2676 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2677 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2678 functions.
2679
2680 @item break *@var{address}
2681 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2682 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2683 information or source files.
2684
2685 @item break
2686 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2687 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2688 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2689 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2690 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2691 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2692 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2693 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2694 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2695 inside loops.
2696
2697 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2698 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2699 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2700 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2701 existed when your program stopped.
2702
2703 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2704 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2705 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2706 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2707 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2708 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2709 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2710
2711 @kindex tbreak
2712 @item tbreak @var{args}
2713 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2714 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2715 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2716 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2717
2718 @kindex hbreak
2719 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2720 @item hbreak @var{args}
2721 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2722 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2723 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2724 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2725 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2726 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2727 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2728 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2729 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2730 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2731 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2732 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2733 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2734 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2735 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2736 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2737 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2738
2739
2740 @kindex thbreak
2741 @item thbreak @var{args}
2742 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2743 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2744 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2745 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2746 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2747 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2748 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2749 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2750
2751 @kindex rbreak
2752 @cindex regular expression
2753 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2754 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2755 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2756 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2757 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2758 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2759 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2760 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2761 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2762
2763 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2764 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2765 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2766 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2767 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2768 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2769
2770 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2771 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2772 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2773 classes.
2774
2775 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2776 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2777 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2778
2779 @smallexample
2780 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2781 @end smallexample
2782
2783 @kindex info breakpoints
2784 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2785 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2786 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2787 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2788 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2789 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2790
2791 @table @emph
2792 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2793 @item Type
2794 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2795 @item Disposition
2796 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2797 @item Enabled or Disabled
2798 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2799 that are not enabled.
2800 @item Address
2801 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
2802 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
2803 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
2804 @item What
2805 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2806 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
2807 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
2808 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
2809 @end table
2810
2811 @noindent
2812 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2813 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2814 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
2815 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
2816 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
2817 valid location.
2818
2819 @noindent
2820 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2821 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2822 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2823 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2824 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2825
2826 @noindent
2827 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2828 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2829 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2830 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2831 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2832 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2833 @end table
2834
2835 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2836 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2837 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2838 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2839
2840 @cindex pending breakpoints
2841 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
2842 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
2843 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
2844 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
2845 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
2846 gets loaded.
2847
2848 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
2849 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
2850 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
2851 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
2852 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
2853 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
2854
2855 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
2856 breakpoint support:
2857
2858 @kindex set breakpoint pending
2859 @kindex show breakpoint pending
2860 @table @code
2861 @item set breakpoint pending auto
2862 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
2863 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
2864
2865 @item set breakpoint pending on
2866 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
2867 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
2868
2869 @item set breakpoint pending off
2870 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
2871 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
2872 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
2873
2874 @item show breakpoint pending
2875 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
2876 @end table
2877
2878 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
2879 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
2880 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
2881 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
2882 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
2883 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
2884 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
2885 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
2886 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
2887 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
2888 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
2889 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
2890 of these loads could resolve the location.
2891
2892 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2893 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2894 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2895 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2896 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2897 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2898 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2899 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2900
2901
2902 @node Set Watchpoints
2903 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2904
2905 @cindex setting watchpoints
2906 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2907 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2908 this may happen.
2909
2910 @cindex software watchpoints
2911 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2912 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2913 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2914 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2915 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2916 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2917 culprit.)
2918
2919 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
2920 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
2921 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
2922
2923 @table @code
2924 @kindex watch
2925 @item watch @var{expr}
2926 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2927 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2928
2929 @kindex rwatch
2930 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2931 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
2932 by the program.
2933
2934 @kindex awatch
2935 @item awatch @var{expr}
2936 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
2937 or written into by the program.
2938
2939 @kindex info watchpoints
2940 @item info watchpoints
2941 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2942 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
2943 @end table
2944
2945 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2946 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2947 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2948 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2949 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2950 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2951
2952 @cindex use only software watchpoints
2953 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
2954 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
2955 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
2956 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
2957 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
2958 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
2959 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
2960
2961 @table @code
2962 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
2963 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
2964 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
2965
2966 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
2967 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
2968 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
2969 @end table
2970
2971 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2972 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2973 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2974
2975 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2976
2977 @smallexample
2978 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2979 @end smallexample
2980
2981 @noindent
2982 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2983
2984 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2985 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2986 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2987 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2988 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2989 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2990 will print a message like this:
2991
2992 @smallexample
2993 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2994 @end smallexample
2995
2996 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2997 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2998 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2999 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3000 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3001 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3002 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3003 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3004
3005 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3006 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3007 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3008 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3009 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3010 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3011
3012 @smallexample
3013 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3014 @end smallexample
3015
3016 @noindent
3017 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3018
3019 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3020 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3021 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3022 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3023 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3024 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3025 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3026 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3027 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3028 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3029
3030 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3031 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3032 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3033
3034 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3035 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3036 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3037 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3038 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3039 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3040 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3041 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3042 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3043
3044 @quotation
3045 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3046 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3047 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3048 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3049 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3050 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3051 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3052 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3053 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3054 the expression.
3055
3056 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3057 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3058 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3059 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3060 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3061 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3062 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3063 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3064 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3065 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3066 @end quotation
3067
3068 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3069
3070 @node Set Catchpoints
3071 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3072 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3073 @cindex exception handlers
3074 @cindex event handling
3075
3076 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3077 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3078 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3079
3080 @table @code
3081 @kindex catch
3082 @item catch @var{event}
3083 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3084 @table @code
3085 @item throw
3086 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3087 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3088
3089 @item catch
3090 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3091
3092 @item exec
3093 @cindex break on fork/exec
3094 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3095
3096 @item fork
3097 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3098
3099 @item vfork
3100 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3101
3102 @item load
3103 @itemx load @var{libname}
3104 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3105 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3106 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3107
3108 @item unload
3109 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3110 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3111 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3112 @end table
3113
3114 @item tcatch @var{event}
3115 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3116 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3117
3118 @end table
3119
3120 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3121
3122 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3123 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3124
3125 @itemize @bullet
3126 @item
3127 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3128 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3129 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3130 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3131 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3132 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3133 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3134 disabled within interactive calls.
3135
3136 @item
3137 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3138
3139 @item
3140 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3141 @end itemize
3142
3143 @cindex raise exceptions
3144 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3145 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3146 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3147 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3148 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3149 out where the exception was raised.
3150
3151 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3152 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3153 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3154 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3155
3156 @smallexample
3157 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3158 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3159 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3160 @end smallexample
3161
3162 @noindent
3163 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3164 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3165 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3166
3167 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3168 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3169 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3170 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3171 raised.
3172
3173
3174 @node Delete Breaks
3175 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3176
3177 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3178 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3179 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3180 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3181 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3182 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3183
3184 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3185 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3186 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3187 their breakpoint numbers.
3188
3189 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3190 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3191 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3192
3193 @table @code
3194 @kindex clear
3195 @item clear
3196 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3197 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3198 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3199 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3200
3201 @item clear @var{function}
3202 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3203 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3204
3205 @item clear @var{linenum}
3206 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3207 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3208 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3209
3210 @cindex delete breakpoints
3211 @kindex delete
3212 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3213 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3214 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3215 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3216 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3217 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3218 @end table
3219
3220 @node Disabling
3221 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3222
3223 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3224 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3225 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3226 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3227 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3228
3229 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3230 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3231 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3232 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3233 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3234
3235 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3236 states of enablement:
3237
3238 @itemize @bullet
3239 @item
3240 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3241 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3242 @item
3243 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3244 @item
3245 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3246 disabled.
3247 @item
3248 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3249 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3250 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3251 @end itemize
3252
3253 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3254 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3255
3256 @table @code
3257 @kindex disable
3258 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3259 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3260 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3261 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3262 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3263 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3264 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3265
3266 @kindex enable
3267 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3268 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3269 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3270
3271 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3272 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3273 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3274
3275 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3276 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3277 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3278 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3279 @end table
3280
3281 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3282 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3283 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3284 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3285 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3286 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3287 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3288 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3289 stepping}.)
3290
3291 @node Conditions
3292 @subsection Break conditions
3293 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3294 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3295
3296 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3297 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3298 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3299 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3300 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3301 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3302 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3303 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3304
3305 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3306 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3307 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3308 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3309 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3310
3311 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3312 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3313 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3314 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3315 one.
3316
3317 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3318 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3319 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3320 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3321 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3322 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3323 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3324 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3325 conditions for the
3326 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3327 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3328
3329 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3330 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3331 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3332 with the @code{condition} command.
3333
3334 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3335 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3336 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3337 catchpoint.
3338
3339 @table @code
3340 @kindex condition
3341 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3342 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3343 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3344 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3345 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3346 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3347 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3348 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3349 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3350 prints an error message:
3351
3352 @smallexample
3353 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3354 @end smallexample
3355
3356 @noindent
3357 @value{GDBN} does
3358 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3359 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3360 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3361
3362 @item condition @var{bnum}
3363 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3364 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3365 @end table
3366
3367 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3368 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3369 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3370 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3371 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3372 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3373 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3374 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3375 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3376 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3377 your program reaches it.
3378
3379 @table @code
3380 @kindex ignore
3381 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3382 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3383 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3384 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3385 takes no action.
3386
3387 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3388 a count of zero.
3389
3390 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3391 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3392 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3393 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3394
3395 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3396 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3397 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3398
3399 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3400 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3401 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3402 variables}.
3403 @end table
3404
3405 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3406
3407
3408 @node Break Commands
3409 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3410
3411 @cindex breakpoint commands
3412 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3413 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3414 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3415 enable other breakpoints.
3416
3417 @table @code
3418 @kindex commands
3419 @kindex end
3420 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3421 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3422 @itemx end
3423 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3424 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3425 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3426
3427 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3428 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3429
3430 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3431 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3432 recently encountered).
3433 @end table
3434
3435 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3436 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3437
3438 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3439 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3440 that resumes execution.
3441
3442 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3443 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3444 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3445 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3446 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3447
3448 @kindex silent
3449 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3450 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3451 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3452 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3453 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3454 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3455
3456 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3457 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3458 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3459
3460 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3461 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3462
3463 @smallexample
3464 break foo if x>0
3465 commands
3466 silent
3467 printf "x is %d\n",x
3468 cont
3469 end
3470 @end smallexample
3471
3472 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3473 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3474 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3475 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3476 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3477 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3478 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3479
3480 @smallexample
3481 break 403
3482 commands
3483 silent
3484 set x = y + 4
3485 cont
3486 end
3487 @end smallexample
3488
3489 @node Breakpoint Menus
3490 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3491 @cindex overloading
3492 @cindex symbol overloading
3493
3494 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3495 single function name
3496 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3497 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3498 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3499 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3500 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3501 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3502 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3503 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3504 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3505 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3506 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3507 breakpoints.
3508
3509 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3510 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3511 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3512
3513 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3514 @smallexample
3515 @group
3516 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3517 [0] cancel
3518 [1] all
3519 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3520 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3521 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3522 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3523 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3524 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3525 > 2 4 6
3526 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3527 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3528 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3529 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3530 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3531 breakpoints.
3532 (@value{GDBP})
3533 @end group
3534 @end smallexample
3535
3536 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3537 @node Error in Breakpoints
3538 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3539 @c
3540 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3541 @c
3542 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3543 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3544 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3545 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3546
3547 @smallexample
3548 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3549 The same program may be running in another process.
3550 @end smallexample
3551
3552 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3553
3554 @enumerate
3555 @item
3556 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3557
3558 @item
3559 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3560 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3561 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3562 Then start your program again.
3563
3564 @item
3565 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3566 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3567 to nonsharable executables.
3568 @end enumerate
3569 @c @end ifclear
3570
3571 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3572 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3573
3574 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3575 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3576 @smallexample
3577 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3578 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3579 @end smallexample
3580
3581 @noindent
3582 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3583 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3584 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3585
3586 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3587 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3588
3589 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3590 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3591 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3592
3593 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3594 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3595 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3596 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3597
3598 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3599 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3600 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3601 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3602 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3603 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3604 first in the bundle.
3605
3606 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3607 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3608 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3609 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3610 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3611 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3612 is hit.
3613
3614 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3615 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3616
3617 @smallexample
3618 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3619 @end smallexample
3620
3621 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3622 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3623 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3624 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3625 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3626 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3627 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3628 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3629
3630 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3631 adjusted breakpoints:
3632
3633 @smallexample
3634 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3635 to 0x00010410.
3636 @end smallexample
3637
3638 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3639 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3640 frequently than expected.
3641
3642 @node Continuing and Stepping
3643 @section Continuing and stepping
3644
3645 @cindex stepping
3646 @cindex continuing
3647 @cindex resuming execution
3648 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3649 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3650 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3651 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3652 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3653 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3654 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3655 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3656
3657 @table @code
3658 @kindex continue
3659 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3660 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3661 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3662 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3663 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3664 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3665 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3666 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3667 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3668 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3669
3670 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3671 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3672 @code{continue} is ignored.
3673
3674 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3675 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3676 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3677 @code{continue}.
3678 @end table
3679
3680 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3681 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3682 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3683 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3684
3685 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3686 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3687 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3688 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3689 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3690 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3691
3692 @table @code
3693 @kindex step
3694 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3695 @item step
3696 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3697 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3698 abbreviated @code{s}.
3699
3700 @quotation
3701 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3702 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3703 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3704 @c distinction here.
3705 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3706 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3707 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3708 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3709 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3710 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3711 below.
3712 @end quotation
3713
3714 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3715 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3716 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3717 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3718 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3719 called within the line.
3720
3721 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3722 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3723 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3724 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3725 was any debugging information about the routine.
3726
3727 @item step @var{count}
3728 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3729 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3730 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3731
3732 @kindex next
3733 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3734 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3735 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3736 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3737 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3738 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3739 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3740 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3741
3742 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3743
3744
3745 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3746 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3747 @c
3748 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3749 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3750 @c function are executed without stopping.
3751
3752 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3753 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3754 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3755
3756 @kindex set step-mode
3757 @item set step-mode
3758 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3759 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3760 @itemx set step-mode on
3761 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3762 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3763 information rather than stepping over it.
3764
3765 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3766 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3767 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3768
3769 @item set step-mode off
3770 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3771 debug information. This is the default.
3772
3773 @item show step-mode
3774 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
3775 source line debug information.
3776
3777 @kindex finish
3778 @item finish
3779 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3780 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3781
3782 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3783 ,Returning from a function}).
3784
3785 @kindex until
3786 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3787 @cindex run until specified location
3788 @item until
3789 @itemx u
3790 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3791 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3792 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3793 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3794 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3795 than the address of the jump.
3796
3797 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3798 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3799 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3800 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3801 through the next iteration.
3802
3803 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3804 stack frame.
3805
3806 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3807 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3808 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3809 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3810 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3811
3812 @smallexample
3813 (@value{GDBP}) f
3814 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3815 206 expand_input();
3816 (@value{GDBP}) until
3817 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3818 @end smallexample
3819
3820 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3821 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3822 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3823 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3824 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3825 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3826 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3827
3828 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3829 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3830 argument.
3831
3832 @item until @var{location}
3833 @itemx u @var{location}
3834 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3835 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3836 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3837 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3838 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3839 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3840 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3841 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3842 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3843 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3844 invocations have returned.
3845
3846 @smallexample
3847 94 int factorial (int value)
3848 95 @{
3849 96 if (value > 1) @{
3850 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
3851 98 @}
3852 99 return (value);
3853 100 @}
3854 @end smallexample
3855
3856
3857 @kindex advance @var{location}
3858 @itemx advance @var{location}
3859 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
3860 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3861 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3862 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3863 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3864 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3865
3866
3867 @kindex stepi
3868 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3869 @item stepi
3870 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3871 @itemx si
3872 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3873
3874 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3875 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3876 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3877 Display,, Automatic display}.
3878
3879 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3880
3881 @need 750
3882 @kindex nexti
3883 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3884 @item nexti
3885 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3886 @itemx ni
3887 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3888 proceed until the function returns.
3889
3890 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 @node Signals
3894 @section Signals
3895 @cindex signals
3896
3897 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3898 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3899 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3900 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3901 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3902 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3903 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3904 requested an alarm).
3905
3906 @cindex fatal signals
3907 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3908 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3909 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3910 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3911 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3912 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3913
3914 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3915 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3916 signal.
3917
3918 @cindex handling signals
3919 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3920 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3921 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3922 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3923 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3924
3925 @table @code
3926 @kindex info signals
3927 @kindex info handle
3928 @item info signals
3929 @itemx info handle
3930 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3931 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3932 the defined types of signals.
3933
3934 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3935
3936 @kindex handle
3937 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3938 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3939 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3940 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3941 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3942 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3943 @end table
3944
3945 @c @group
3946 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3947 Their full names are:
3948
3949 @table @code
3950 @item nostop
3951 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3952 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3953
3954 @item stop
3955 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3956 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3957
3958 @item print
3959 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3960
3961 @item noprint
3962 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3963 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3964
3965 @item pass
3966 @itemx noignore
3967 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3968 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3969 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3970
3971 @item nopass
3972 @itemx ignore
3973 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3974 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3975 @end table
3976 @c @end group
3977
3978 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3979 program until you
3980 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3981 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3982 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3983 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3984 program sees that signal when you continue.
3985
3986 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3987 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3988 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3989 erroneous signals.
3990
3991 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3992 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3993 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3994 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3995 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3996 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3997 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3998 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3999 program a signal}.
4000
4001 @node Thread Stops
4002 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4003
4004 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4005 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4006 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4007
4008 @table @code
4009 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4010 @cindex thread breakpoints
4011 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4012 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4013 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4014 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4015 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4016
4017 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4018 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4019 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4020 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4021 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4022
4023 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4024 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4025 program.
4026
4027 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4028 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4029 breakpoint condition, like this:
4030
4031 @smallexample
4032 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4033 @end smallexample
4034
4035 @end table
4036
4037 @cindex stopped threads
4038 @cindex threads, stopped
4039 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4040 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4041 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4042 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4043 underfoot.
4044
4045 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4046 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4047 @cindex premature return from system calls
4048 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4049 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4050 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4051 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4052 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4053 stop execution.
4054
4055 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4056 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4057 style anyways.
4058
4059 For example, do not write code like this:
4060
4061 @smallexample
4062 sleep (10);
4063 @end smallexample
4064
4065 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4066 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4067
4068 Instead, write this:
4069
4070 @smallexample
4071 int unslept = 10;
4072 while (unslept > 0)
4073 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4074 @end smallexample
4075
4076 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4077 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4078 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4079 @value{GDBN}.
4080
4081 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4082 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4083 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4084 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4085
4086 @cindex continuing threads
4087 @cindex threads, continuing
4088 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4089 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4090 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4091
4092 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4093 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4094 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4095 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4096 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4097 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4098 stops.
4099
4100 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4101 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4102 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4103 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4104
4105 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4106 thread to run.
4107
4108 @table @code
4109 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4110 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4111 @cindex lock scheduler
4112 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4113 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4114 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4115 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4116 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4117 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4118 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4119 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4120 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4121 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4122 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4123
4124 @item show scheduler-locking
4125 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4126 @end table
4127
4128
4129 @node Stack
4130 @chapter Examining the Stack
4131
4132 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4133 stopped and how it got there.
4134
4135 @cindex call stack
4136 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4137 is generated.
4138 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4139 the arguments of the call,
4140 and the local variables of the function being called.
4141 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4142 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4143 stack}.
4144
4145 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4146 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4147
4148 @cindex selected frame
4149 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4150 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4151 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4152 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4153 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4154 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4155
4156 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4157 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4158 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4159
4160 @menu
4161 * Frames:: Stack frames
4162 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4163 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4164 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4165
4166 @end menu
4167
4168 @node Frames
4169 @section Stack frames
4170
4171 @cindex frame, definition
4172 @cindex stack frame
4173 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4174 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4175 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4176 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4177 which the function is executing.
4178
4179 @cindex initial frame
4180 @cindex outermost frame
4181 @cindex innermost frame
4182 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4183 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4184 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4185 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4186 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4187 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4188 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4189 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4190
4191 @cindex frame pointer
4192 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4193 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4194 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4195 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4196 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4197 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4198
4199 @cindex frame number
4200 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4201 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4202 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4203 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4204 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4205
4206 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4207 @c underflow problems.
4208 @cindex frameless execution
4209 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4210 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4211 @smallexample
4212 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4213 @end smallexample
4214 generates functions without a frame.)
4215 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4216 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4217 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4218 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4219 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4220 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4221 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4222
4223 @table @code
4224 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4225 @cindex current stack frame
4226 @item frame @var{args}
4227 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4228 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4229 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4230 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4231
4232 @kindex select-frame
4233 @cindex selecting frame silently
4234 @item select-frame
4235 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4236 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4237 @code{frame}.
4238 @end table
4239
4240 @node Backtrace
4241 @section Backtraces
4242
4243 @cindex traceback
4244 @cindex call stack traces
4245 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4246 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4247 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4248 stack.
4249
4250 @table @code
4251 @kindex backtrace
4252 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4253 @item backtrace
4254 @itemx bt
4255 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4256 frames in the stack.
4257
4258 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4259 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
4260
4261 @item backtrace @var{n}
4262 @itemx bt @var{n}
4263 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4264
4265 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4266 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4267 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4268
4269 @item backtrace full
4270 Print the values of the local variables also.
4271 @itemx bt full
4272 @end table
4273
4274 @kindex where
4275 @kindex info stack
4276 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4277 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4278
4279 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4280 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4281 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4282 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4283 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4284 line number.
4285
4286 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4287 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4288
4289 @smallexample
4290 @group
4291 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4292 at builtin.c:993
4293 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4294 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4295 at macro.c:71
4296 (More stack frames follow...)
4297 @end group
4298 @end smallexample
4299
4300 @noindent
4301 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4302 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4303 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4304
4305 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4306 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4307 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4308 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4309 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4310 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4311 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4312 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4313 such a backtrace might look like:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 @group
4317 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4318 at builtin.c:993
4319 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4320 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4321 at macro.c:71
4322 (More stack frames follow...)
4323 @end group
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 @noindent
4327 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4328 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4329
4330 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4331 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4332 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4333
4334 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4335 @cindex program entry point
4336 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4337 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4338 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4339 @code{main}@footnote{
4340 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4341 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4342 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4343 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4344 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4345 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4346
4347 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4348 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4349
4350 @table @code
4351 @item set backtrace past-main
4352 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4353 @kindex set backtrace
4354 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4355
4356 @item set backtrace past-main off
4357 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4358 default.
4359
4360 @item show backtrace past-main
4361 @kindex show backtrace
4362 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4363
4364 @item set backtrace past-entry
4365 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4366 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4367 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4368 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4369
4370 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4371 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4372 application. This is the default.
4373
4374 @item show backtrace past-entry
4375 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4376
4377 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4378 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4379 @cindex backtrace limit
4380 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4381 unlimited.
4382
4383 @item show backtrace limit
4384 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4385 @end table
4386
4387 @node Selection
4388 @section Selecting a frame
4389
4390 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4391 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4392 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4393 of the stack frame just selected.
4394
4395 @table @code
4396 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4397 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4398 @item frame @var{n}
4399 @itemx f @var{n}
4400 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4401 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4402 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4403 @code{main}.
4404
4405 @item frame @var{addr}
4406 @itemx f @var{addr}
4407 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4408 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4409 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4410 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4411 switches between them.
4412
4413 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4414 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4415
4416 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4417 pointer and a program counter.
4418
4419 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4420 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4421
4422 @kindex up
4423 @item up @var{n}
4424 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4425 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4426 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4427
4428 @kindex down
4429 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4430 @item down @var{n}
4431 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4432 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4433 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4434 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4435 @end table
4436
4437 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4438 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4439 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4440 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4441
4442 @need 1000
4443 For example:
4444
4445 @smallexample
4446 @group
4447 (@value{GDBP}) up
4448 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4449 at env.c:10
4450 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4451 @end group
4452 @end smallexample
4453
4454 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4455 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4456 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4457 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4458 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4459 for details.
4460
4461 @table @code
4462 @kindex down-silently
4463 @kindex up-silently
4464 @item up-silently @var{n}
4465 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4466 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4467 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4468 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4469 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4470 distracting.
4471 @end table
4472
4473 @node Frame Info
4474 @section Information about a frame
4475
4476 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4477 stack frame.
4478
4479 @table @code
4480 @item frame
4481 @itemx f
4482 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4483 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4484 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4485 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4486 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4487
4488 @kindex info frame
4489 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4490 @item info frame
4491 @itemx info f
4492 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4493 including:
4494
4495 @itemize @bullet
4496 @item
4497 the address of the frame
4498 @item
4499 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4500 @item
4501 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4502 @item
4503 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4504 @item
4505 the address of the frame's arguments
4506 @item
4507 the address of the frame's local variables
4508 @item
4509 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4510 @item
4511 which registers were saved in the frame
4512 @end itemize
4513
4514 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4515 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4516 the usual conventions.
4517
4518 @item info frame @var{addr}
4519 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4520 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4521 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4522 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4523 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4524 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4525
4526 @kindex info args
4527 @item info args
4528 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4529
4530 @item info locals
4531 @kindex info locals
4532 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4533 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4534 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4535
4536 @kindex info catch
4537 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4538 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4539 @item info catch
4540 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4541 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4542 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4543 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4544 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4545
4546 @end table
4547
4548
4549 @node Source
4550 @chapter Examining Source Files
4551
4552 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4553 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4554 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4555 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4556 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4557 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4558 source files by explicit command.
4559
4560 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4561 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4562 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4563
4564 @menu
4565 * List:: Printing source lines
4566 * Edit:: Editing source files
4567 * Search:: Searching source files
4568 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4569 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4570 @end menu
4571
4572 @node List
4573 @section Printing source lines
4574
4575 @kindex list
4576 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4577 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4578 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4579 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4580
4581 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4582
4583 @table @code
4584 @item list @var{linenum}
4585 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4586 current source file.
4587
4588 @item list @var{function}
4589 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4590 @var{function}.
4591
4592 @item list
4593 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4594 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4595 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4596 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4597 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4598
4599 @item list -
4600 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4601 @end table
4602
4603 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4604 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4605 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4606
4607 @table @code
4608 @kindex set listsize
4609 @item set listsize @var{count}
4610 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4611 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4612
4613 @kindex show listsize
4614 @item show listsize
4615 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4616 @end table
4617
4618 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4619 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4620 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4621 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4622 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4623
4624 @cindex linespec
4625 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4626 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4627 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4628 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4629
4630 @table @code
4631 @item list @var{linespec}
4632 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4633
4634 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4635 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4636 linespecs.
4637
4638 @item list ,@var{last}
4639 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4640
4641 @item list @var{first},
4642 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4643
4644 @item list +
4645 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4646
4647 @item list -
4648 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4649
4650 @item list
4651 As described in the preceding table.
4652 @end table
4653
4654 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4655 kinds of linespec.
4656
4657 @table @code
4658 @item @var{number}
4659 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4660 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4661 the same source file as the first linespec.
4662
4663 @item +@var{offset}
4664 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4665 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4666 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4667 first linespec.
4668
4669 @item -@var{offset}
4670 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4671
4672 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4673 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4674
4675 @item @var{function}
4676 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4677 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4678
4679 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4680 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4681 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4682 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4683 identically named functions in different source files.
4684
4685 @item *@var{address}
4686 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4687 @var{address} may be any expression.
4688 @end table
4689
4690 @node Edit
4691 @section Editing source files
4692 @cindex editing source files
4693
4694 @kindex edit
4695 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4696 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4697 The editing program of your choice
4698 is invoked with the current line set to
4699 the active line in the program.
4700 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4701 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4702
4703 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4704
4705 @table @code
4706 @item edit
4707 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4708
4709 @item edit @var{number}
4710 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4711
4712 @item edit @var{function}
4713 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4714
4715 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4716 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4717
4718 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4719 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4720 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4721 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4722 identically named functions in different source files.
4723
4724 @item edit *@var{address}
4725 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4726 @var{address} may be any expression.
4727 @end table
4728
4729 @subsection Choosing your editor
4730 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4731 @footnote{
4732 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4733 following command-line syntax:
4734 @smallexample
4735 ex +@var{number} file
4736 @end smallexample
4737 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
4738 the file where to start editing.}.
4739 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
4740 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4741 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4742 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4743 @smallexample
4744 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4745 export EDITOR
4746 gdb @dots{}
4747 @end smallexample
4748 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4749 @smallexample
4750 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4751 gdb @dots{}
4752 @end smallexample
4753
4754 @node Search
4755 @section Searching source files
4756 @cindex searching source files
4757
4758 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4759 regular expression.
4760
4761 @table @code
4762 @kindex search
4763 @kindex forward-search
4764 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4765 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4766 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4767 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4768 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4769 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4770 @code{fo}.
4771
4772 @kindex reverse-search
4773 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4774 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4775 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4776 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4777 this command as @code{rev}.
4778 @end table
4779
4780 @node Source Path
4781 @section Specifying source directories
4782
4783 @cindex source path
4784 @cindex directories for source files
4785 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4786 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4787 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4788 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4789 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4790 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4791 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
4792
4793 For example, suppose an executable references the file
4794 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
4795 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
4796 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
4797 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
4798 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
4799 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
4800 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
4801 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
4802 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
4803 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
4804
4805 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
4806 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
4807 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
4808 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
4809 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
4810 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
4811
4812 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
4813 source files. Neither is the current working directory, unless it
4814 happens to be in the source path.
4815
4816 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4817 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4818 each line is in the file.
4819
4820 @kindex directory
4821 @kindex dir
4822 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4823 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4824 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4825
4826 @table @code
4827 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4828 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4829 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4830 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4831 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4832 part of absolute file names) or
4833 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4834 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4835
4836 @kindex cdir
4837 @kindex cwd
4838 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4839 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4840 @cindex compilation directory
4841 @cindex current directory
4842 @cindex working directory
4843 @cindex directory, current
4844 @cindex directory, compilation
4845 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4846 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4847 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4848 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4849 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4850 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4851
4852 @item directory
4853 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4854
4855 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4856 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4857
4858 @item show directories
4859 @kindex show directories
4860 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4861 @end table
4862
4863 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4864 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4865 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4866
4867 @enumerate
4868 @item
4869 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4870
4871 @item
4872 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4873 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4874 directories in one command.
4875 @end enumerate
4876
4877 @node Machine Code
4878 @section Source and machine code
4879 @cindex source line and its code address
4880
4881 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4882 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4883 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4884 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4885 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4886 well as hex.
4887
4888 @table @code
4889 @kindex info line
4890 @item info line @var{linespec}
4891 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4892 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4893 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4894 source lines}).
4895 @end table
4896
4897 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4898 the object code for the first line of function
4899 @code{m4_changequote}:
4900
4901 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4902 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4903 @smallexample
4904 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4905 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4906 @end smallexample
4907
4908 @noindent
4909 @cindex code address and its source line
4910 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4911 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4912 @smallexample
4913 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4914 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4915 @end smallexample
4916
4917 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4918 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
4919 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4920 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4921 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4922 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4923 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4924 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4925 variables}).
4926
4927 @table @code
4928 @kindex disassemble
4929 @cindex assembly instructions
4930 @cindex instructions, assembly
4931 @cindex machine instructions
4932 @cindex listing machine instructions
4933 @item disassemble
4934 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4935 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4936 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4937 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4938 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4939 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4940 @end table
4941
4942 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4943 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4944
4945 @smallexample
4946 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4947 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4948 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4949 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4950 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4951 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4952 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4953 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4954 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4955 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4956 End of assembler dump.
4957 @end smallexample
4958
4959 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4960 mnemonics or other syntax.
4961
4962 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
4963 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
4964 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
4965 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
4966 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
4967
4968 @table @code
4969 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4970 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4971 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4972 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4973 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4974 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4975
4976 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4977 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4978 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4979 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4980
4981 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
4982 @item show disassembly-flavor
4983 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
4984 @end table
4985
4986
4987 @node Data
4988 @chapter Examining Data
4989
4990 @cindex printing data
4991 @cindex examining data
4992 @kindex print
4993 @kindex inspect
4994 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4995 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4996 @c different window or something like that.
4997 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4998 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4999 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5000 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5001 Different Languages}).
5002
5003 @table @code
5004 @item print @var{expr}
5005 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5006 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5007 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5008 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5009 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5010 formats}.
5011
5012 @item print
5013 @itemx print /@var{f}
5014 @cindex reprint the last value
5015 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5016 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5017 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5018 @end table
5019
5020 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5021 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5022 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5023
5024 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5025 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5026 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5027 Table}.
5028
5029 @menu
5030 * Expressions:: Expressions
5031 * Variables:: Program variables
5032 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5033 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5034 * Memory:: Examining memory
5035 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5036 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5037 * Value History:: Value history
5038 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5039 * Registers:: Registers
5040 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5041 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5042 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5043 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5044 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5045 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5046 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5047 character set than GDB does
5048 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5049 @end menu
5050
5051 @node Expressions
5052 @section Expressions
5053
5054 @cindex expressions
5055 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5056 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5057 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5058 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5059 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5060 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5061 @ref{Compilation}.
5062
5063 @cindex arrays in expressions
5064 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5065 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5066 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5067 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5068
5069 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5070 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5071 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5072 languages.
5073
5074 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5075 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5076
5077 @cindex casts, in expressions
5078 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5079 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5080 at that address in memory.
5081 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5082
5083 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5084 to programming languages:
5085
5086 @table @code
5087 @item @@
5088 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5089 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5090
5091 @item ::
5092 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5093 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5094
5095 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5096 @cindex type casting memory
5097 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5098 @cindex casts, to view memory
5099 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5100 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5101 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5102 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5103 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5104 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5105 @end table
5106
5107 @node Variables
5108 @section Program variables
5109
5110 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5111 in your program.
5112
5113 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5114 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5115
5116 @itemize @bullet
5117 @item
5118 global (or file-static)
5119 @end itemize
5120
5121 @noindent or
5122
5123 @itemize @bullet
5124 @item
5125 visible according to the scope rules of the
5126 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5127 @end itemize
5128
5129 @noindent This means that in the function
5130
5131 @smallexample
5132 foo (a)
5133 int a;
5134 @{
5135 bar (a);
5136 @{
5137 int b = test ();
5138 bar (b);
5139 @}
5140 @}
5141 @end smallexample
5142
5143 @noindent
5144 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5145 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5146 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5147 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5148
5149 @cindex variable name conflict
5150 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5151 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5152 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5153 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5154 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5155 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5156 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5157
5158 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5159 @iftex
5160 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5161 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5162 @end iftex
5163 @smallexample
5164 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5165 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5166 @end smallexample
5167
5168 @noindent
5169 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5170 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5171 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5172 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5173
5174 @smallexample
5175 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5176 @end smallexample
5177
5178 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5179 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5180 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5181 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5182 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5183 @c conflict?? --mew
5184
5185 @cindex wrong values
5186 @cindex variable values, wrong
5187 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5188 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5189 @quotation
5190 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5191 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5192 scope, and just before exit.
5193 @end quotation
5194 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5195 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5196 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5197 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5198 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5199 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5200 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5201 variable definitions may be gone.
5202
5203 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5204 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5205 when compiling.
5206
5207 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5208 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5209 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5210 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5211 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5212 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5213 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5214
5215 @smallexample
5216 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5217 @end smallexample
5218
5219 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5220 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5221 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5222 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5223 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5224 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5225 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5226 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5227 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5228 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5229
5230 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5231 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5232 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5233 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5234
5235 @node Arrays
5236 @section Artificial arrays
5237
5238 @cindex artificial array
5239 @cindex arrays
5240 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5241 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5242 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5243 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5244 program.
5245
5246 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5247 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5248 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5249 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5250 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5251 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5252 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5253 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5254 example. If a program says
5255
5256 @smallexample
5257 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5258 @end smallexample
5259
5260 @noindent
5261 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5262
5263 @smallexample
5264 p *array@@len
5265 @end smallexample
5266
5267 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5268 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5269 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5270 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5271 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5272
5273 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5274 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5275 The value need not be in memory:
5276 @smallexample
5277 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5278 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5279 @end smallexample
5280
5281 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5282 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5283 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5284 @smallexample
5285 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5286 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5287 @end smallexample
5288
5289 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5290 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5291 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5292 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5293 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5294 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5295 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5296 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5297 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5298 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5299
5300 @smallexample
5301 set $i = 0
5302 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5303 @key{RET}
5304 @key{RET}
5305 @dots{}
5306 @end smallexample
5307
5308 @node Output Formats
5309 @section Output formats
5310
5311 @cindex formatted output
5312 @cindex output formats
5313 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5314 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5315 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5316 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5317 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5318
5319 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5320 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5321 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5322 letters supported are:
5323
5324 @table @code
5325 @item x
5326 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5327 hexadecimal.
5328
5329 @item d
5330 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5331
5332 @item u
5333 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5334
5335 @item o
5336 Print as integer in octal.
5337
5338 @item t
5339 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5340 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5341 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5342 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5343
5344 @item a
5345 @cindex unknown address, locating
5346 @cindex locate address
5347 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5348 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5349 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5350
5351 @smallexample
5352 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5353 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5354 @end smallexample
5355
5356 @noindent
5357 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5358 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5359
5360 @item c
5361 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5362 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5363 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5364 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5365
5366 @item f
5367 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5368 using typical floating point syntax.
5369 @end table
5370
5371 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5372
5373 @smallexample
5374 p/x $pc
5375 @end smallexample
5376
5377 @noindent
5378 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5379 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5380
5381 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5382 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5383 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5384
5385 @node Memory
5386 @section Examining memory
5387
5388 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5389 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5390
5391 @cindex examining memory
5392 @table @code
5393 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5394 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5395 @itemx x @var{addr}
5396 @itemx x
5397 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5398 @end table
5399
5400 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5401 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5402 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5403 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5404 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5405
5406 @table @r
5407 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5408 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5409 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5410 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5411 @c 4.1.2.
5412
5413 @item @var{f}, the display format
5414 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5415 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5416 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5417 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5418 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5419 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5420
5421 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5422 The unit size is any of
5423
5424 @table @code
5425 @item b
5426 Bytes.
5427 @item h
5428 Halfwords (two bytes).
5429 @item w
5430 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5431 @item g
5432 Giant words (eight bytes).
5433 @end table
5434
5435 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5436 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5437 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5438
5439 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5440 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5441 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5442 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5443 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5444 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5445 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5446 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5447 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5448 a value from memory).
5449 @end table
5450
5451 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5452 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5453 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5454 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5455 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5456
5457 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5458 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5459 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5460 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5461 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5462
5463 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5464 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5465 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5466 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5467 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5468 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5469
5470 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5471 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5472 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5473 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5474 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5475 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5476 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5477
5478 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5479 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5480 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5481 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5482 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5483 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5484 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5485 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5486 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5487
5488 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5489 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5490 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5491
5492 @cindex remote memory comparison
5493 @cindex verify remote memory image
5494 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5495 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5496 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5497 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5498 situations.
5499
5500 @table @code
5501 @kindex compare-sections
5502 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5503 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5504 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5505 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5506 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5507 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5508 remote request.
5509 @end table
5510
5511 @node Auto Display
5512 @section Automatic display
5513 @cindex automatic display
5514 @cindex display of expressions
5515
5516 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5517 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5518 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5519 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5520 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5521 The automatic display looks like this:
5522
5523 @smallexample
5524 2: foo = 38
5525 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5526 @end smallexample
5527
5528 @noindent
5529 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5530 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5531 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5532 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5533 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5534 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5535 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5536
5537 @table @code
5538 @kindex display
5539 @item display @var{expr}
5540 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5541 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5542
5543 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5544
5545 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5546 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5547 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5548 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5549 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5550
5551 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5552 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5553 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5554 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5555 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5556 @end table
5557
5558 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5559 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5560 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5561
5562 @table @code
5563 @kindex delete display
5564 @kindex undisplay
5565 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5566 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5567 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5568
5569 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5570 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5571
5572 @kindex disable display
5573 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5574 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5575 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5576 enabled again later.
5577
5578 @kindex enable display
5579 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5580 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5581 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5582
5583 @item display
5584 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5585 done when your program stops.
5586
5587 @kindex info display
5588 @item info display
5589 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5590 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5591 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5592 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5593 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5594 @end table
5595
5596 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5597 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5598 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5599 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5600 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5601 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5602 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5603 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5604 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5605 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5606 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5607
5608 @node Print Settings
5609 @section Print settings
5610
5611 @cindex format options
5612 @cindex print settings
5613 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5614 and symbols are printed.
5615
5616 @noindent
5617 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5618
5619 @table @code
5620 @kindex set print
5621 @item set print address
5622 @itemx set print address on
5623 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
5624 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5625 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5626 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5627 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5628 @code{set print address on}:
5629
5630 @smallexample
5631 @group
5632 (@value{GDBP}) f
5633 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5634 at input.c:530
5635 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5636 @end group
5637 @end smallexample
5638
5639 @item set print address off
5640 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5641 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5642
5643 @smallexample
5644 @group
5645 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5646 (@value{GDBP}) f
5647 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5648 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5649 @end group
5650 @end smallexample
5651
5652 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5653 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5654 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5655 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5656
5657 @kindex show print
5658 @item show print address
5659 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5660 @end table
5661
5662 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5663 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5664 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5665 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5666 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5667 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5668 it prints a symbolic address:
5669
5670 @table @code
5671 @item set print symbol-filename on
5672 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
5673 @cindex symbol, source file and line
5674 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5675 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5676
5677 @item set print symbol-filename off
5678 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5679 default.
5680
5681 @item show print symbol-filename
5682 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5683 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5684 @end table
5685
5686 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5687 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5688 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5689
5690 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5691 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5692
5693 @table @code
5694 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5695 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
5696 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5697 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5698 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5699 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5700
5701 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5702 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5703 symbolic address.
5704 @end table
5705
5706 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5707 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5708 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5709 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5710 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5711 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5712 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5713 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5714
5715 @smallexample
5716 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5717 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5718 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5719 @end smallexample
5720
5721 @quotation
5722 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5723 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5724 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5725 @end quotation
5726
5727 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5728
5729 @table @code
5730 @item set print array
5731 @itemx set print array on
5732 @cindex pretty print arrays
5733 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5734 but uses more space. The default is off.
5735
5736 @item set print array off
5737 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5738
5739 @item show print array
5740 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5741 arrays.
5742
5743 @cindex print array indexes
5744 @item set print array-indexes
5745 @itemx set print array-indexes on
5746 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
5747 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
5748 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
5749
5750 @item set print array-indexes off
5751 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
5752
5753 @item show print array-indexes
5754 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
5755 arrays.
5756
5757 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5758 @cindex number of array elements to print
5759 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
5760 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5761 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5762 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5763 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5764 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5765 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5766
5767 @item show print elements
5768 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5769 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5770
5771 @item set print repeats
5772 @cindex repeated array elements
5773 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
5774 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
5775 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
5776 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
5777 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
5778 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
5779 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
5780
5781 @item show print repeats
5782 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
5783 elements.
5784
5785 @item set print null-stop
5786 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
5787 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5788 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5789 contain only short strings.
5790 The default is off.
5791
5792 @item show print null-stop
5793 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
5794 @sc{null} character.
5795
5796 @item set print pretty on
5797 @cindex print structures in indented form
5798 @cindex indentation in structure display
5799 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5800 per line, like this:
5801
5802 @smallexample
5803 @group
5804 $1 = @{
5805 next = 0x0,
5806 flags = @{
5807 sweet = 1,
5808 sour = 1
5809 @},
5810 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5811 @}
5812 @end group
5813 @end smallexample
5814
5815 @item set print pretty off
5816 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5817
5818 @smallexample
5819 @group
5820 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5821 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5822 @end group
5823 @end smallexample
5824
5825 @noindent
5826 This is the default format.
5827
5828 @item show print pretty
5829 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5830
5831 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5832 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
5833 @cindex octal escapes in strings
5834 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5835 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5836 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5837 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5838 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5839
5840 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5841 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5842 international character sets, and is the default.
5843
5844 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5845 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5846
5847 @item set print union on
5848 @cindex unions in structures, printing
5849 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
5850 and other unions. This is the default setting.
5851
5852 @item set print union off
5853 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
5854 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
5855 instead.
5856
5857 @item show print union
5858 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5859 structures and other unions.
5860
5861 For example, given the declarations
5862
5863 @smallexample
5864 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5865 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5866 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5867 Bug_forms;
5868
5869 struct thing @{
5870 Species it;
5871 union @{
5872 Tree_forms tree;
5873 Bug_forms bug;
5874 @} form;
5875 @};
5876
5877 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5878 @end smallexample
5879
5880 @noindent
5881 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5882
5883 @smallexample
5884 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5885 @end smallexample
5886
5887 @noindent
5888 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5889
5890 @smallexample
5891 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5892 @end smallexample
5893
5894 @noindent
5895 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
5896 and in Pascal.
5897 @end table
5898
5899 @need 1000
5900 @noindent
5901 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5902
5903 @table @code
5904 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
5905 @item set print demangle
5906 @itemx set print demangle on
5907 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5908 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5909 linkage. The default is on.
5910
5911 @item show print demangle
5912 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5913
5914 @item set print asm-demangle
5915 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5916 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5917 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5918 The default is off.
5919
5920 @item show print asm-demangle
5921 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5922 or demangled form.
5923
5924 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5925 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5926 @kindex set demangle-style
5927 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5928 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5929 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5930
5931 @table @code
5932 @item auto
5933 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5934
5935 @item gnu
5936 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5937 This is the default.
5938
5939 @item hp
5940 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5941
5942 @item lucid
5943 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5944
5945 @item arm
5946 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5947 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5948 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5949 require further enhancement to permit that.
5950
5951 @end table
5952 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5953
5954 @item show demangle-style
5955 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5956
5957 @item set print object
5958 @itemx set print object on
5959 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
5960 @cindex display derived types
5961 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5962 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5963 the virtual function table.
5964
5965 @item set print object off
5966 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5967 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5968
5969 @item show print object
5970 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5971
5972 @item set print static-members
5973 @itemx set print static-members on
5974 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
5975 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5976
5977 @item set print static-members off
5978 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5979
5980 @item show print static-members
5981 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
5982
5983 @item set print pascal_static-members
5984 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
5985 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
5986 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
5987 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
5988
5989 @item set print pascal_static-members off
5990 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
5991
5992 @item show print pascal_static-members
5993 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
5994
5995 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5996 @item set print vtbl
5997 @itemx set print vtbl on
5998 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
5999 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6000 @cindex VTBL display
6001 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6002 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6003 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6004
6005 @item set print vtbl off
6006 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6007
6008 @item show print vtbl
6009 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6010 @end table
6011
6012 @node Value History
6013 @section Value history
6014
6015 @cindex value history
6016 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6017 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6018 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6019 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6020 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6021 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6022 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6023 symbol table.
6024
6025 @cindex @code{$}
6026 @cindex @code{$$}
6027 @cindex history number
6028 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6029 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6030 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6031 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6032 history number.
6033
6034 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6035 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6036 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6037 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6038 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6039 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6040 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6041
6042 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6043 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6044
6045 @smallexample
6046 p *$
6047 @end smallexample
6048
6049 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6050 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6051
6052 @smallexample
6053 p *$.next
6054 @end smallexample
6055
6056 @noindent
6057 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6058 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6059
6060 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6061 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6062
6063 @smallexample
6064 print x
6065 set x=5
6066 @end smallexample
6067
6068 @noindent
6069 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6070 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6071
6072 @table @code
6073 @kindex show values
6074 @item show values
6075 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6076 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6077 values} does not change the history.
6078
6079 @item show values @var{n}
6080 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6081
6082 @item show values +
6083 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6084 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6085 @end table
6086
6087 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6088 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6089
6090 @node Convenience Vars
6091 @section Convenience variables
6092
6093 @cindex convenience variables
6094 @cindex user-defined variables
6095 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6096 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6097 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6098 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6099 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6100
6101 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6102 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6103 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6104 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6105 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6106
6107 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6108 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6109 For example:
6110
6111 @smallexample
6112 set $foo = *object_ptr
6113 @end smallexample
6114
6115 @noindent
6116 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6117 @code{object_ptr}.
6118
6119 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6120 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6121 value with another assignment at any time.
6122
6123 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6124 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6125 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6126 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6127
6128 @table @code
6129 @kindex show convenience
6130 @cindex show all user variables
6131 @item show convenience
6132 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6133 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6134 @end table
6135
6136 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6137 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6138 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6139
6140 @smallexample
6141 set $i = 0
6142 print bar[$i++]->contents
6143 @end smallexample
6144
6145 @noindent
6146 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6147
6148 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6149 values likely to be useful.
6150
6151 @table @code
6152 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6153 @item $_
6154 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6155 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6156 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6157 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6158 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6159 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6160 to the type of @code{$__}.
6161
6162 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6163 @item $__
6164 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6165 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6166 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6167
6168 @item $_exitcode
6169 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6170 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6171 the program being debugged terminates.
6172 @end table
6173
6174 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6175 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6176 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6177
6178 @node Registers
6179 @section Registers
6180
6181 @cindex registers
6182 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6183 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6184 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6185 your machine.
6186
6187 @table @code
6188 @kindex info registers
6189 @item info registers
6190 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6191 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6192
6193 @kindex info all-registers
6194 @cindex floating point registers
6195 @item info all-registers
6196 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6197 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6198
6199 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6200 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6201 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6202 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6203 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6204 @end table
6205
6206 @cindex stack pointer register
6207 @cindex program counter register
6208 @cindex process status register
6209 @cindex frame pointer register
6210 @cindex standard registers
6211 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6212 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6213 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6214 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6215 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6216 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6217 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6218 you could print the program counter in hex with
6219
6220 @smallexample
6221 p/x $pc
6222 @end smallexample
6223
6224 @noindent
6225 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6226
6227 @smallexample
6228 x/i $pc
6229 @end smallexample
6230
6231 @noindent
6232 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6233 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6234 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6235 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6236 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6237 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6238 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6239
6240 @smallexample
6241 set $sp += 4
6242 @end smallexample
6243
6244 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6245 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6246 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6247 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6248 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6249 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6250 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6251
6252 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6253 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6254 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6255 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6256 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6257 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6258 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6259
6260 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6261 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6262 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6263 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6264 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6265 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6266 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6267 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6268 prints the data in both formats.
6269
6270 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6271 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6272 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6273 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6274 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6275 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6276
6277 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6278 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6279 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6280 frame makes no difference.
6281
6282 @node Floating Point Hardware
6283 @section Floating point hardware
6284 @cindex floating point
6285
6286 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6287 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @kindex info float
6291 @item info float
6292 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6293 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6294 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6295 the ARM and x86 machines.
6296 @end table
6297
6298 @node Vector Unit
6299 @section Vector Unit
6300 @cindex vector unit
6301
6302 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6303 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6304
6305 @table @code
6306 @kindex info vector
6307 @item info vector
6308 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6309 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6310 @end table
6311
6312 @node OS Information
6313 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6314 @cindex OS information
6315
6316 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6317 you debug your program.
6318
6319 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6320 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6321 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6322 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6323 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6324 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6325 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6326 structure.
6327
6328 @table @code
6329 @item info udot
6330 @kindex info udot
6331 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6332 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6333 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6334 the @code{examine} command.
6335 @end table
6336
6337 @cindex auxiliary vector
6338 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6339 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6340 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6341 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6342 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6343 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6344 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6345 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6346 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6347 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6348 support of the @samp{qPart:auxv:read} packet, see @ref{Remote
6349 configuration, auxiliary vector}.
6350
6351 @table @code
6352 @kindex info auxv
6353 @item info auxv
6354 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6355 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6356 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6357 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6358 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6359 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6360 an unrecognized tag.
6361 @end table
6362
6363
6364 @node Memory Region Attributes
6365 @section Memory region attributes
6366 @cindex memory region attributes
6367
6368 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6369 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
6370 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
6371 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
6372
6373 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6374 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6375 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6376 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6377 all memory.
6378
6379 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6380 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6381
6382 @table @code
6383 @kindex mem
6384 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6385 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6386 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6387 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6388 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6389 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6390
6391 @kindex delete mem
6392 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6393 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6394 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6395
6396 @kindex disable mem
6397 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6398 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6399 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6400 It may be enabled again later.
6401
6402 @kindex enable mem
6403 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6404 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6405
6406 @kindex info mem
6407 @item info mem
6408 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6409 for each region:
6410
6411 @table @emph
6412 @item Memory Region Number
6413 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6414 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6415 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6416
6417 @item Lo Address
6418 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6419
6420 @item Hi Address
6421 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6422
6423 @item Attributes
6424 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6425 @end table
6426 @end table
6427
6428
6429 @subsection Attributes
6430
6431 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6432 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6433 write accesses to a memory region.
6434
6435 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6436 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6437 etc. from accessing memory.
6438
6439 @table @code
6440 @item ro
6441 Memory is read only.
6442 @item wo
6443 Memory is write only.
6444 @item rw
6445 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6446 @end table
6447
6448 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6449 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6450 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6451 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6452 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6453
6454 @table @code
6455 @item 8
6456 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6457 @item 16
6458 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6459 @item 32
6460 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6461 @item 64
6462 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6463 @end table
6464
6465 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6466 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6467 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6468 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6469 @c
6470 @c @table @code
6471 @c @item hwbreak
6472 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6473 @c @item swbreak (default)
6474 @c @end table
6475
6476 @subsubsection Data Cache
6477 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6478 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6479 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6480 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6481 registers.
6482
6483 @table @code
6484 @item cache
6485 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6486 @item nocache
6487 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6488 @end table
6489
6490 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6491 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6492 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6493 @c
6494 @c @table @code
6495 @c @item verify
6496 @c @item noverify (default)
6497 @c @end table
6498
6499 @node Dump/Restore Files
6500 @section Copy between memory and a file
6501 @cindex dump/restore files
6502 @cindex append data to a file
6503 @cindex dump data to a file
6504 @cindex restore data from a file
6505
6506 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6507 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6508 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6509 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6510 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6511 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6512 files.
6513
6514 @table @code
6515
6516 @kindex dump
6517 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6518 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6519 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6520 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6521
6522 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6523 @table @code
6524 @item binary
6525 Raw binary form.
6526 @item ihex
6527 Intel hex format.
6528 @item srec
6529 Motorola S-record format.
6530 @item tekhex
6531 Tektronix Hex format.
6532 @end table
6533
6534 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6535 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6536 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6537 form.
6538
6539 @kindex append
6540 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6541 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6542 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6543 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6544 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6545
6546 @kindex restore
6547 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6548 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6549 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6550 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6551 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6552
6553 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6554 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6555 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6556 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6557 from that location.
6558
6559 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6560 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6561 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6562 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6563
6564 @end table
6565
6566 @node Core File Generation
6567 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
6568 @cindex dump core from inferior
6569
6570 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
6571 image of a running process and its process status (register values
6572 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
6573 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
6574 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
6575 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
6576 the post-mortem debugging mode.
6577
6578 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
6579 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
6580 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
6581
6582 @table @code
6583 @kindex gcore
6584 @kindex generate-core-file
6585 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
6586 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
6587 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
6588 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
6589 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
6590 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
6591
6592 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
6593 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
6594 @end table
6595
6596 @node Character Sets
6597 @section Character Sets
6598 @cindex character sets
6599 @cindex charset
6600 @cindex translating between character sets
6601 @cindex host character set
6602 @cindex target character set
6603
6604 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
6605 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
6606 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
6607 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
6608 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
6609 @dfn{target character set}.
6610
6611 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
6612 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
6613 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
6614 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
6615 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
6616 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
6617 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
6618 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
6619 character and string literals in expressions.
6620
6621 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
6622 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
6623 target-charset} command, described below.
6624
6625 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
6626 support:
6627
6628 @table @code
6629 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
6630 @kindex set target-charset
6631 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
6632 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
6633 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6634 list the target character sets it supports.
6635 @end table
6636
6637 @table @code
6638 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
6639 @kindex set host-charset
6640 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
6641
6642 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
6643 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
6644 @code{set host-charset} command.
6645
6646 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
6647 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
6648 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
6649 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6650 list the host character sets it supports.
6651
6652 @item set charset @var{charset}
6653 @kindex set charset
6654 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
6655 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6656 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
6657 for both host and target.
6658
6659
6660 @item show charset
6661 @kindex show charset
6662 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
6663
6664 @itemx show host-charset
6665 @kindex show host-charset
6666 Show the name of the current host charset.
6667
6668 @itemx show target-charset
6669 @kindex show target-charset
6670 Show the name of the current target charset.
6671
6672 @end table
6673
6674 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6675 sets:
6676
6677 @table @code
6678
6679 @item ASCII
6680 @cindex ASCII character set
6681 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6682 character set.
6683
6684 @item ISO-8859-1
6685 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6686 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6687 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
6688 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6689 this as its host character set.
6690
6691 @item EBCDIC-US
6692 @itemx IBM1047
6693 @cindex EBCDIC character set
6694 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6695 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6696 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6697 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6698
6699 @end table
6700
6701 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6702 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6703 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6704
6705 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6706 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6707 @file{charset-test.c}:
6708
6709 @smallexample
6710 #include <stdio.h>
6711
6712 char ascii_hello[]
6713 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6714 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6715 char ibm1047_hello[]
6716 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6717 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6718
6719 main ()
6720 @{
6721 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6722 @}
6723 @end smallexample
6724
6725 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6726 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6727 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6728
6729 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6730
6731 @smallexample
6732 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6733 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6734 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6735 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6736 @dots{}
6737 (@value{GDBP})
6738 @end smallexample
6739
6740 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6741 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6742 strings:
6743
6744 @smallexample
6745 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
6746 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
6747 (@value{GDBP})
6748 @end smallexample
6749
6750 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6751 initial character set:
6752 @smallexample
6753 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
6754 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
6755 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
6756 (@value{GDBP})
6757 @end smallexample
6758
6759 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6760 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6761 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6762 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6763 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6764
6765 @smallexample
6766 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
6767 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6768 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
6769 $2 = 72 'H'
6770 (@value{GDBP})
6771 @end smallexample
6772
6773 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6774 literals you use in expressions:
6775
6776 @smallexample
6777 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
6778 $3 = 43 '+'
6779 (@value{GDBP})
6780 @end smallexample
6781
6782 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6783 character.
6784
6785 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6786 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6787 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6788
6789 @smallexample
6790 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
6791 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6792 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6793 $5 = 200 '\310'
6794 (@value{GDBP})
6795 @end smallexample
6796
6797 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6798 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6799
6800 @smallexample
6801 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
6802 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
6803 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
6804 @end smallexample
6805
6806 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6807 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6808 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6809 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6810 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6811
6812 @smallexample
6813 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
6814 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
6815 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
6816 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
6817 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
6818 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6819 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
6820 $7 = 72 '\110'
6821 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
6822 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6823 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6824 $9 = 200 'H'
6825 (@value{GDBP})
6826 @end smallexample
6827
6828 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6829 string literals you use in expressions:
6830
6831 @smallexample
6832 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
6833 $10 = 78 '+'
6834 (@value{GDBP})
6835 @end smallexample
6836
6837 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6838 character.
6839
6840 @node Caching Remote Data
6841 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
6842 @cindex caching data of remote targets
6843
6844 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
6845 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
6846 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
6847 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
6848 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
6849 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
6850 volatile registers are in use.
6851
6852 @table @code
6853 @kindex set remotecache
6854 @item set remotecache on
6855 @itemx set remotecache off
6856 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
6857 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
6858
6859 @kindex show remotecache
6860 @item show remotecache
6861 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
6862
6863 @kindex info dcache
6864 @item info dcache
6865 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
6866 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
6867 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
6868 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
6869 the data cache operation.
6870 @end table
6871
6872
6873 @node Macros
6874 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6875
6876 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
6877 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6878 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6879 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6880 where it was defined.
6881
6882 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6883 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6884 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6885 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6886
6887 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6888 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6889 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6890 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6891 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6892 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6893 see @ref{List}.
6894
6895 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6896 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6897 variable-arity macros.
6898
6899 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6900 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6901 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6902
6903 @table @code
6904
6905 @kindex macro expand
6906 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6907 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6908 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6909 @item macro expand @var{expression}
6910 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6911 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6912 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6913 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6914 it can be any string of tokens.
6915
6916 @kindex macro exp1
6917 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6918 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6919 @cindex expand macro once
6920 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6921 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6922 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6923 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6924 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6925 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6926 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6927 can be any string of tokens.
6928
6929 @kindex info macro
6930 @cindex macro definition, showing
6931 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
6932 @item info macro @var{macro}
6933 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6934 source location where that definition was established.
6935
6936 @kindex macro define
6937 @cindex user-defined macros
6938 @cindex defining macros interactively
6939 @cindex macros, user-defined
6940 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6941 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6942 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6943 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6944 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6945 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6946 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6947 given in @var{arglist}.
6948
6949 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6950 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6951 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6952 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6953 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6954
6955 @kindex macro undef
6956 @item macro undef @var{macro}
6957 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6958 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6959 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6960 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6961 debugged.
6962
6963 @kindex macro list
6964 @item macro list
6965 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
6966 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
6967 @end table
6968
6969 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
6970 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6971 show our source files:
6972
6973 @smallexample
6974 $ cat sample.c
6975 #include <stdio.h>
6976 #include "sample.h"
6977
6978 #define M 42
6979 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6980
6981 main ()
6982 @{
6983 #define N 28
6984 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6985 #undef N
6986 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6987 #define N 1729
6988 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6989 @}
6990 $ cat sample.h
6991 #define Q <
6992 $
6993 @end smallexample
6994
6995 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6996 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6997 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6998 information.
6999
7000 @smallexample
7001 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7002 $
7003 @end smallexample
7004
7005 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7006
7007 @smallexample
7008 $ gdb -nw sample
7009 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7010 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7011 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7012 (@value{GDBP})
7013 @end smallexample
7014
7015 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7016 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7017 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7018
7019 @smallexample
7020 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7021 3
7022 4 #define M 42
7023 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7024 6
7025 7 main ()
7026 8 @{
7027 9 #define N 28
7028 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7029 11 #undef N
7030 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7031 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7032 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7033 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7034 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7035 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7036 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7037 #define Q <
7038 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7039 expands to: (42 + 1)
7040 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7041 expands to: once (M + 1)
7042 (@value{GDBP})
7043 @end smallexample
7044
7045 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7046 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7047 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7048 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7049
7050 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7051 the source line of the current stack frame:
7052
7053 @smallexample
7054 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7055 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7056 (@value{GDBP}) run
7057 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7058
7059 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7060 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7061 (@value{GDBP})
7062 @end smallexample
7063
7064 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7065
7066 @smallexample
7067 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7068 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7069 #define N 28
7070 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7071 expands to: 28 < 42
7072 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7073 $1 = 1
7074 (@value{GDBP})
7075 @end smallexample
7076
7077 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7078 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7079 thereof) in force at each point:
7080
7081 @smallexample
7082 (@value{GDBP}) next
7083 Hello, world!
7084 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7085 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7086 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7087 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7088 (@value{GDBP}) next
7089 We're so creative.
7090 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7091 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7092 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7093 #define N 1729
7094 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7095 expands to: 1729 < 42
7096 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7097 $2 = 0
7098 (@value{GDBP})
7099 @end smallexample
7100
7101
7102 @node Tracepoints
7103 @chapter Tracepoints
7104 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7105 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7106
7107 @cindex tracepoints
7108 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7109 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7110 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7111 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7112 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7113 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7114 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7115
7116 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7117 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7118 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7119 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7120 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7121 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7122 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7123 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7124 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7125 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7126 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7127
7128 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7129 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
7130 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
7131 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
7132 tracepoints as of this writing.
7133
7134 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7135
7136 @menu
7137 * Set Tracepoints::
7138 * Analyze Collected Data::
7139 * Tracepoint Variables::
7140 @end menu
7141
7142 @node Set Tracepoints
7143 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7144
7145 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7146 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7147 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7148 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7149 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7150 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7151 work on.
7152
7153 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7154 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7155 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7156 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7157 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7158 tracepoint was hit.
7159
7160 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7161 conditions and actions.
7162
7163 @menu
7164 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7165 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7166 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7167 * Tracepoint Actions::
7168 * Listing Tracepoints::
7169 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7170 @end menu
7171
7172 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7173 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7174
7175 @table @code
7176 @cindex set tracepoint
7177 @kindex trace
7178 @item trace
7179 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7180 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7181 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7182 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7183 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7184 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7185 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7186 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7187 running.
7188
7189 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7190
7191 @smallexample
7192 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7193
7194 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7195
7196 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7197
7198 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7199
7200 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7201 @end smallexample
7202
7203 @noindent
7204 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7205
7206 @vindex $tpnum
7207 @cindex last tracepoint number
7208 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7209 @cindex tracepoint number
7210 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7211 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7212
7213 @kindex delete tracepoint
7214 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7215 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7216 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7217 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7218
7219 Examples:
7220
7221 @smallexample
7222 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7223
7224 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7225 @end smallexample
7226
7227 @noindent
7228 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7229 @end table
7230
7231 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7232 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7233
7234 @table @code
7235 @kindex disable tracepoint
7236 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7237 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7238 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7239 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7240 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7241
7242 @kindex enable tracepoint
7243 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7244 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7245 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7246 run.
7247 @end table
7248
7249 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7250 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7251
7252 @table @code
7253 @kindex passcount
7254 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7255 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7256 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7257 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7258 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7259 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7260 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7261 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7262 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7263 user.
7264
7265 Examples:
7266
7267 @smallexample
7268 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7269 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7270
7271 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7272 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7273 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7274 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7275 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7276 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7277 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7278 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7279 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7280 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7281 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7282 @end smallexample
7283 @end table
7284
7285 @node Tracepoint Actions
7286 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7287
7288 @table @code
7289 @kindex actions
7290 @cindex tracepoint actions
7291 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7292 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7293 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7294 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7295 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7296 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7297 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7298 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7299 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7300 @code{while-stepping}.
7301
7302 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7303 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7304 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7305
7306 @smallexample
7307 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7308
7309 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7310
7311 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7312 @end smallexample
7313
7314 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7315 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7316 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7317 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7318 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7319 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7320 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7321 @code{end} command.
7322
7323 @smallexample
7324 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7325 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7326 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7327 > collect bar,baz
7328 > collect $regs
7329 > while-stepping 12
7330 > collect $fp, $sp
7331 > end
7332 end
7333 @end smallexample
7334
7335 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7336 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7337 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7338 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7339 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7340 special arguments are supported:
7341
7342 @table @code
7343 @item $regs
7344 collect all registers
7345
7346 @item $args
7347 collect all function arguments
7348
7349 @item $locals
7350 collect all local variables.
7351 @end table
7352
7353 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7354 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7355 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7356
7357 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7358 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7359
7360 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7361 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7362 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7363 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7364 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7365 its own @code{end} command):
7366
7367 @smallexample
7368 > while-stepping 12
7369 > collect $regs, myglobal
7370 > end
7371 >
7372 @end smallexample
7373
7374 @noindent
7375 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7376 @code{stepping}.
7377 @end table
7378
7379 @node Listing Tracepoints
7380 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7381
7382 @table @code
7383 @kindex info tracepoints
7384 @kindex info tp
7385 @cindex information about tracepoints
7386 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7387 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7388 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7389 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7390 shown:
7391
7392 @itemize @bullet
7393 @item
7394 its number
7395 @item
7396 whether it is enabled or disabled
7397 @item
7398 its address
7399 @item
7400 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7401 @item
7402 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7403 @item
7404 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7405 @item
7406 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7407 @end itemize
7408
7409 @smallexample
7410 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7411 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7412 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7413 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7414 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7415 (@value{GDBP})
7416 @end smallexample
7417
7418 @noindent
7419 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7420 @end table
7421
7422 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7423 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7424
7425 @table @code
7426 @kindex tstart
7427 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7428 @cindex collected data discarded
7429 @item tstart
7430 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7431 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7432 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7433 experiment.
7434
7435 @kindex tstop
7436 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7437 @item tstop
7438 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7439 stops collecting data.
7440
7441 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7442 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7443 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7444
7445 @kindex tstatus
7446 @cindex status of trace data collection
7447 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7448 @item tstatus
7449 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7450 collection.
7451 @end table
7452
7453 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7454
7455 @smallexample
7456 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7457 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7458 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7459 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7460 > while-stepping 11
7461 > collect $regs
7462 > end
7463 > end
7464 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7465 [time passes @dots{}]
7466 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7467 @end smallexample
7468
7469
7470 @node Analyze Collected Data
7471 @section Using the collected data
7472
7473 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7474 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7475 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7476 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7477 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7478 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7479 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7480 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7481 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7482 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7483 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7484 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7485 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7486 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7487 the buffer will fail.
7488
7489 @menu
7490 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7491 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7492 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7493 @end menu
7494
7495 @node tfind
7496 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7497
7498 @kindex tfind
7499 @cindex select trace snapshot
7500 @cindex find trace snapshot
7501 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7502 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7503 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7504 snapshot is selected.
7505
7506 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7507
7508 @table @code
7509 @item tfind start
7510 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7511 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7512
7513 @item tfind none
7514 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7515
7516 @item tfind end
7517 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7518
7519 @item tfind
7520 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7521
7522 @item tfind -
7523 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7524 retracing earlier steps.
7525
7526 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7527 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7528 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7529 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
7530 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
7531
7532 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
7533 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
7534 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
7535 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
7536 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
7537
7538 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7539 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
7540 addresses.
7541
7542 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7543 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
7544 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
7545
7546 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
7547 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
7548 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
7549 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
7550 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
7551 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
7552 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
7553 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
7554 @end table
7555
7556 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
7557 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
7558 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
7559 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
7560 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
7561 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
7562 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
7563 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
7564 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
7565 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
7566 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7567 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7568 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7569 tracepoint as the current one.
7570
7571 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
7572 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
7573 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
7574 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
7575 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
7576
7577 @smallexample
7578 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7579 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7580 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
7581 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
7582 > tfind
7583 > end
7584
7585 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
7586 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
7587 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
7588 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
7589 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
7590 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
7591 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
7592 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
7593 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
7594 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
7595 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
7596 @end smallexample
7597
7598 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
7599 the buffer:
7600
7601 @smallexample
7602 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7603 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7604 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
7605 > tfind line
7606 > end
7607
7608 Frame 0, X = 1
7609 Frame 7, X = 2
7610 Frame 13, X = 255
7611 @end smallexample
7612
7613 @node tdump
7614 @subsection @code{tdump}
7615 @kindex tdump
7616 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
7617 @cindex tracepoint data, display
7618
7619 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
7620 the current trace snapshot.
7621
7622 @smallexample
7623 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
7624 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7625 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
7626 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
7627 > end
7628
7629 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7630
7631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
7632 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
7633 at gdb_test.c:444
7634 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
7635
7636 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
7637 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
7638 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
7639 d1 0x18 24
7640 d2 0x80 128
7641 d3 0x33 51
7642 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
7643 d5 0x22 34
7644 d6 0xe0 224
7645 d7 0x380035 3670069
7646 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
7647 a1 0x3000668 50333288
7648 a2 0x100 256
7649 a3 0x322000 3284992
7650 a4 0x3000698 50333336
7651 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
7652 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
7653 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
7654 ps 0x0 0
7655 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
7656 fpcontrol 0x0 0
7657 fpstatus 0x0 0
7658 fpiaddr 0x0 0
7659 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
7660 p1 = (void *) 0x11
7661 p2 = (void *) 0x22
7662 p3 = (void *) 0x33
7663 p4 = (void *) 0x44
7664 p5 = (void *) 0x55
7665 p6 = (void *) 0x66
7666 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
7667
7668 (@value{GDBP})
7669 @end smallexample
7670
7671 @node save-tracepoints
7672 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
7673 @kindex save-tracepoints
7674 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
7675
7676 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
7677 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
7678 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
7679 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
7680 Files}).
7681
7682 @node Tracepoint Variables
7683 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
7684 @cindex tracepoint variables
7685 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
7686
7687 @table @code
7688 @vindex $trace_frame
7689 @item (int) $trace_frame
7690 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
7691 snapshot is selected.
7692
7693 @vindex $tracepoint
7694 @item (int) $tracepoint
7695 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7696
7697 @vindex $trace_line
7698 @item (int) $trace_line
7699 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7700
7701 @vindex $trace_file
7702 @item (char []) $trace_file
7703 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7704
7705 @vindex $trace_func
7706 @item (char []) $trace_func
7707 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7708 @end table
7709
7710 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7711 use @code{output} instead.
7712
7713 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7714 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7715 data.
7716
7717 @smallexample
7718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7719
7720 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7721 > output $trace_file
7722 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7723 > tfind
7724 > end
7725 @end smallexample
7726
7727 @node Overlays
7728 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7729 @cindex overlays
7730
7731 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7732 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7733 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7734 use overlays.
7735
7736 @menu
7737 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7738 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7739 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7740 mapped by asking the inferior.
7741 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7742 @end menu
7743
7744 @node How Overlays Work
7745 @section How Overlays Work
7746 @cindex mapped overlays
7747 @cindex unmapped overlays
7748 @cindex load address, overlay's
7749 @cindex mapped address
7750 @cindex overlay area
7751
7752 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7753 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7754 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7755 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7756 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7757
7758 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7759 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7760 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7761 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7762 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7763 largest overlay as well.
7764
7765 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7766 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7767 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7768 there.
7769
7770 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7771 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7772 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7773
7774 @smallexample
7775 @group
7776 Data Instruction Larger
7777 Address Space Address Space Address Space
7778 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7779 | | | | | |
7780 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7781 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7782 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
7783 | and heap | | | | | |
7784 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7785 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
7786 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7787 | | | | | |
7788 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7789 address | | | | | |
7790 | overlay | <-' | | |
7791 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7792 | | <---. | | load address
7793 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7794 | | | |
7795 +-----------+ | |
7796 +-----------+
7797 | |
7798 +-----------+
7799
7800 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
7801 @end group
7802 @end smallexample
7803
7804 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7805 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7806 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7807 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7808 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7809 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7810 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7811 program and the overlay area.
7812
7813 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7814 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7815 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7816 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7817 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7818 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7819 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7820
7821 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7822 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7823 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7824
7825 @itemize @bullet
7826
7827 @item
7828 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7829 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7830 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7831 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7832
7833 @item
7834 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7835 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7836 your program's performance.
7837
7838 @item
7839 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7840 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7841 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7842 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7843 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7844 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7845 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7846
7847 @item
7848 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7849 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7850 instruction and data spaces.
7851
7852 @end itemize
7853
7854 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7855 improved in many ways:
7856
7857 @itemize @bullet
7858
7859 @item
7860 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7861 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7862 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7863 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7864 area in the usual way.
7865
7866 @item
7867 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7868 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7869
7870 @item
7871 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7872 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7873 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7874 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7875 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7876 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7877 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7878
7879 @end itemize
7880
7881
7882 @node Overlay Commands
7883 @section Overlay Commands
7884
7885 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7886 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7887 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7888 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7889 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7890 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7891
7892 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7893 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7894
7895 @table @code
7896 @item overlay off
7897 @kindex overlay
7898 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7899 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7900 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7901 overlay support is disabled.
7902
7903 @item overlay manual
7904 @cindex manual overlay debugging
7905 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7906 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7907 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7908 commands described below.
7909
7910 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7911 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7912 @cindex map an overlay
7913 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7914 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7915 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7916 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7917 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7918 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7919
7920 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7921 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7922 @cindex unmap an overlay
7923 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7924 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7925 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7926 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7927
7928 @item overlay auto
7929 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7930 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7931 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7932 Overlay Debugging}.
7933
7934 @item overlay load-target
7935 @itemx overlay load
7936 @cindex reloading the overlay table
7937 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7938 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7939 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7940 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7941 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7942
7943 @item overlay list-overlays
7944 @itemx overlay list
7945 @cindex listing mapped overlays
7946 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7947 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7948
7949 @end table
7950
7951 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7952 of the function the address falls in:
7953
7954 @smallexample
7955 (@value{GDBP}) print main
7956 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
7957 @end smallexample
7958 @noindent
7959 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7960 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7961 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7962 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7963
7964 @smallexample
7965 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
7966 No sections are mapped.
7967 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
7968 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
7969 @end smallexample
7970 @noindent
7971 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7972 name normally:
7973
7974 @smallexample
7975 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
7976 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7977 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7978 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
7979 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
7980 @end smallexample
7981
7982 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7983 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7984 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7985 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7986 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7987
7988 @itemize @bullet
7989 @item
7990 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
7991 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7992 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7993 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7994 @item
7995 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7996 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7997 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7998 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7999 breakpoints properly.
8000 @end itemize
8001
8002
8003 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8004 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8005 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8006
8007 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8008 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8009 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8010 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8011 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8012 current state of the overlays.
8013
8014 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8015 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8016
8017 @table @asis
8018
8019 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8020 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8021
8022 @smallexample
8023 struct
8024 @{
8025 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8026 unsigned long vma;
8027
8028 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8029 unsigned long size;
8030
8031 /* The overlay's load address. */
8032 unsigned long lma;
8033
8034 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8035 zero otherwise. */
8036 unsigned long mapped;
8037 @}
8038 @end smallexample
8039
8040 @item @code{_novlys}:
8041 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8042 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8043
8044 @end table
8045
8046 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8047 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8048 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8049 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8050 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8051 currently mapped.
8052
8053 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8054 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8055 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8056 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8057 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8058 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8059 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8060 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8061 are not being executed.
8062
8063 @node Overlay Sample Program
8064 @section Overlay Sample Program
8065 @cindex overlay example program
8066
8067 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8068 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8069 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8070 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8071 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8072 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8073 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8074
8075 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8076 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8077 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8078 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8079
8080 @table @file
8081 @item overlays.c
8082 The main program file.
8083 @item ovlymgr.c
8084 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8085 @item foo.c
8086 @itemx bar.c
8087 @itemx baz.c
8088 @itemx grbx.c
8089 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8090 @item d10v.ld
8091 @itemx m32r.ld
8092 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8093 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8094 @end table
8095
8096 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8097 cross-compiler like this:
8098
8099 @smallexample
8100 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8101 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8102 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8103 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8104 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8105 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8106 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8107 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8108 @end smallexample
8109
8110 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8111 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8112 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8113
8114
8115 @node Languages
8116 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8117 @cindex languages
8118
8119 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8120 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8121 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8122 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8123 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8124 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8125
8126 @cindex working language
8127 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8128 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8129 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8130 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8131 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8132 language}.
8133
8134 @menu
8135 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8136 * Show:: Displaying the language
8137 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8138 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8139 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8140 @end menu
8141
8142 @node Setting
8143 @section Switching between source languages
8144
8145 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8146 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8147 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8148 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8149 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8150 are printed, etc.
8151
8152 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8153 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8154 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8155 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8156 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8157 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8158 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8159 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8160 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8161 Displaying the language}.
8162
8163 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8164 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8165 another language. In that case, make the
8166 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8167 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8168 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8169
8170 @menu
8171 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8172 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8173 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8174 @end menu
8175
8176 @node Filenames
8177 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8178
8179 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8180 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8181
8182 @table @file
8183 @item .ada
8184 @itemx .ads
8185 @itemx .adb
8186 @itemx .a
8187 Ada source file.
8188
8189 @item .c
8190 C source file
8191
8192 @item .C
8193 @itemx .cc
8194 @itemx .cp
8195 @itemx .cpp
8196 @itemx .cxx
8197 @itemx .c++
8198 C@t{++} source file
8199
8200 @item .m
8201 Objective-C source file
8202
8203 @item .f
8204 @itemx .F
8205 Fortran source file
8206
8207 @item .mod
8208 Modula-2 source file
8209
8210 @item .s
8211 @itemx .S
8212 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8213 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8214 @end table
8215
8216 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8217 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8218
8219 @node Manually
8220 @subsection Setting the working language
8221
8222 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8223 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8224 your program.
8225
8226 @kindex set language
8227 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8228 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8229 a language, such as
8230 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8231 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8232
8233 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8234 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8235 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8236 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8237 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8238 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8239 command such as:
8240
8241 @smallexample
8242 print a = b + c
8243 @end smallexample
8244
8245 @noindent
8246 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8247 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8248 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8249 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8250
8251 @node Automatically
8252 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8253
8254 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8255 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8256 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8257 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8258 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8259 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8260 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8261 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8262 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8263
8264 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8265 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8266 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8267 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8268 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8269
8270 @node Show
8271 @section Displaying the language
8272
8273 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8274 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8275
8276 @table @code
8277 @item show language
8278 @kindex show language
8279 Display the current working language. This is the
8280 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8281 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8282
8283 @item info frame
8284 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8285 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8286 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8287 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8288 information listed here.
8289
8290 @item info source
8291 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8292 Display the source language of this source file.
8293 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8294 information listed here.
8295 @end table
8296
8297 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8298 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8299 with a language explicitly:
8300
8301 @table @code
8302 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8303 @kindex set extension-language
8304 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8305 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8306
8307 @item info extensions
8308 @kindex info extensions
8309 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8310 @end table
8311
8312 @node Checks
8313 @section Type and range checking
8314
8315 @quotation
8316 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8317 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8318 section documents the intended facilities.
8319 @end quotation
8320 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8321
8322 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8323 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8324 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8325 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8326 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8327 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8328 errors when your program is running.
8329
8330 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8331 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8332 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8333 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8334 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8335 automatically based on your program's source language.
8336 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8337 settings of supported languages.
8338
8339 @menu
8340 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8341 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8342 @end menu
8343
8344 @cindex type checking
8345 @cindex checks, type
8346 @node Type Checking
8347 @subsection An overview of type checking
8348
8349 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8350 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8351 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8352 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8353
8354 @smallexample
8355 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8356 @exdent but
8357 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8358 @end smallexample
8359
8360 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8361 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8362
8363 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8364 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8365 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8366 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8367 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8368 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8369 also issues a warning.
8370
8371 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8372 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8373 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8374 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8375 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8376 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8377
8378 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8379 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8380 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8381 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8382 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8383 details on specific languages.
8384
8385 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8386
8387 @kindex set check type
8388 @kindex show check type
8389 @table @code
8390 @item set check type auto
8391 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8392 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8393 each language.
8394
8395 @item set check type on
8396 @itemx set check type off
8397 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8398 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8399 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8400 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8401 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8402
8403 @item set check type warn
8404 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8405 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8406 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8407 numbers and structures.
8408
8409 @item show type
8410 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8411 is setting it automatically.
8412 @end table
8413
8414 @cindex range checking
8415 @cindex checks, range
8416 @node Range Checking
8417 @subsection An overview of range checking
8418
8419 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8420 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8421 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8422 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8423 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8424
8425 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8426 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8427 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8428 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8429
8430 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8431 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8432 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8433 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8434 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8435 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8436
8437 @smallexample
8438 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8439 @end smallexample
8440
8441 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8442 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8443 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8444
8445 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8446
8447 @kindex set check range
8448 @kindex show check range
8449 @table @code
8450 @item set check range auto
8451 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8452 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8453 each language.
8454
8455 @item set check range on
8456 @itemx set check range off
8457 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8458 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8459 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8460 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8461
8462 @item set check range warn
8463 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8464 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8465 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8466 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8467 systems).
8468
8469 @item show range
8470 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8471 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8472 @end table
8473
8474 @node Supported languages
8475 @section Supported languages
8476
8477 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8478 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8479 @c This is false ...
8480 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8481 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8482 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8483 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8484 language.
8485
8486 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8487 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8488 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8489 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8490 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8491 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8492 language reference or tutorial.
8493
8494 @menu
8495 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8496 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8497 * Fortran:: Fortran
8498 * Pascal:: Pascal
8499 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8500 * Ada:: Ada
8501 @end menu
8502
8503 @node C
8504 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8505
8506 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8507 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8508
8509 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8510 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8511 together.
8512
8513 @cindex C@t{++}
8514 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8515 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8516 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8517 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8518 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8519 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8520 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8521
8522 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8523 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8524 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8525 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8526 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8527 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
8528
8529 @menu
8530 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
8531 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
8532 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
8533 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
8534 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8535 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
8536 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8537 @end menu
8538
8539 @node C Operators
8540 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
8541
8542 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
8543
8544 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8545 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8546 often defined on groups of types.
8547
8548 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
8549
8550 @itemize @bullet
8551
8552 @item
8553 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
8554 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
8555
8556 @item
8557 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
8558 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
8559
8560 @item
8561 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
8562
8563 @item
8564 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
8565
8566 @end itemize
8567
8568 @noindent
8569 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
8570 in order of increasing precedence:
8571
8572 @table @code
8573 @item ,
8574 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
8575 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
8576 expression being the last expression evaluated.
8577
8578 @item =
8579 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
8580 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
8581
8582 @item @var{op}=
8583 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
8584 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
8585 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
8586 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
8587 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
8588
8589 @item ?:
8590 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
8591 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
8592 integral type.
8593
8594 @item ||
8595 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8596
8597 @item &&
8598 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8599
8600 @item |
8601 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8602
8603 @item ^
8604 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8605
8606 @item &
8607 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8608
8609 @item ==@r{, }!=
8610 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
8611 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
8612
8613 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
8614 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
8615 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
8616 and non-zero for true.
8617
8618 @item <<@r{, }>>
8619 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
8620
8621 @item @@
8622 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8623
8624 @item +@r{, }-
8625 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
8626 pointer types.
8627
8628 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
8629 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
8630 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
8631 integral types.
8632
8633 @item ++@r{, }--
8634 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
8635 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
8636 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
8637 operation takes place.
8638
8639 @item *
8640 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
8641 @code{++}.
8642
8643 @item &
8644 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
8645
8646 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
8647 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
8648 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
8649 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
8650 stored.
8651
8652 @item -
8653 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
8654 precedence as @code{++}.
8655
8656 @item !
8657 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8658 @code{++}.
8659
8660 @item ~
8661 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8662 @code{++}.
8663
8664
8665 @item .@r{, }->
8666 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
8667 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
8668 pointer based on the stored type information.
8669 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
8670
8671 @item .*@r{, }->*
8672 Dereferences of pointers to members.
8673
8674 @item []
8675 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
8676 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8677
8678 @item ()
8679 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8680
8681 @item ::
8682 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
8683 and @code{class} types.
8684
8685 @item ::
8686 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
8687 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
8688 above.
8689 @end table
8690
8691 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
8692 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
8693 predefined meaning.
8694
8695 @menu
8696 * C Constants::
8697 @end menu
8698
8699 @node C Constants
8700 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
8701
8702 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
8703
8704 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
8705 following ways:
8706
8707 @itemize @bullet
8708 @item
8709 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
8710 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8711 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
8712 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8713 @code{long} value.
8714
8715 @item
8716 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8717 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8718 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8719 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8720 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
8721 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8722 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8723 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8724 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8725 constant.
8726
8727 @item
8728 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8729 integral equivalents.
8730
8731 @item
8732 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8733 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
8734 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
8735 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8736 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8737 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8738 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8739 @samp{\n} for newline.
8740
8741 @item
8742 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8743 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8744 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8745 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8746 characters.
8747
8748 @item
8749 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8750 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8751
8752 @item
8753 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8754 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8755 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8756 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8757 @end itemize
8758
8759 @menu
8760 * C plus plus expressions::
8761 * C Defaults::
8762 * C Checks::
8763
8764 * Debugging C::
8765 @end menu
8766
8767 @node C plus plus expressions
8768 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8769
8770 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8771 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8772
8773 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8774 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
8775 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8776 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
8777 @quotation
8778 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8779 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8780 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8781 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8782 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8783 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8784 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8785 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8786 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8787 C@t{++} code.
8788 @end quotation
8789
8790 @enumerate
8791
8792 @cindex member functions
8793 @item
8794 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8795
8796 @smallexample
8797 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
8798 @end smallexample
8799
8800 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
8801 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
8802 @item
8803 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8804 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8805 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
8806 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
8807
8808 @cindex call overloaded functions
8809 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
8810 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
8811 @item
8812 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
8813 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
8814 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8815 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8816 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8817 default arguments.
8818
8819 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8820 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8821 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8822 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8823 number of function arguments.
8824
8825 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8826 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
8827 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
8828
8829 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
8830 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8831 @smallexample
8832 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8833 @end smallexample
8834
8835 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
8836 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
8837
8838 @cindex reference declarations
8839 @item
8840 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8841 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
8842 dereferenced.
8843
8844 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8845 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8846 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8847 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8848 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8849
8850 @item
8851 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
8852 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8853 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8854 necessary, for example in an expression like
8855 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
8856 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
8857 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8858 @end enumerate
8859
8860 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
8861 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8862 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8863 invoking user-defined operators.
8864
8865 @node C Defaults
8866 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
8867
8868 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
8869
8870 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8871 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
8872 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8873 selects the working language.
8874
8875 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8876 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8877 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
8878 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
8879 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8880 for further details.
8881
8882 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8883 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8884 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
8885
8886 @node C Checks
8887 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8888
8889 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
8890
8891 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
8892 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8893 considers two variables type equivalent if:
8894
8895 @itemize @bullet
8896 @item
8897 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8898 enumerated tag.
8899
8900 @item
8901 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8902 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8903
8904 @ignore
8905 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8906 @c FIXME--beers?
8907 @item
8908 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8909 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8910 compilers.)
8911 @end ignore
8912 @end itemize
8913
8914 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8915 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8916 that is not itself an array.
8917
8918 @node Debugging C
8919 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
8920
8921 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8922 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
8923 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8924 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
8925
8926 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8927 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8928 ,Expressions}.
8929
8930 @menu
8931 * Debugging C plus plus::
8932 @end menu
8933
8934 @node Debugging C plus plus
8935 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8936
8937 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
8938
8939 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8940 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
8941
8942 @table @code
8943 @cindex break in overloaded functions
8944 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
8945 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8946 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8947 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8948
8949 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
8950 @item rbreak @var{regex}
8951 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8952 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8953 classes.
8954 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8955
8956 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
8957 @item catch throw
8958 @itemx catch catch
8959 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
8960 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8961
8962 @cindex inheritance
8963 @item ptype @var{typename}
8964 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8965 @var{typename}.
8966 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8967
8968 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
8969 @item set print demangle
8970 @itemx show print demangle
8971 @itemx set print asm-demangle
8972 @itemx show print asm-demangle
8973 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8974 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
8975 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8976
8977 @item set print object
8978 @itemx show print object
8979 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8980 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8981
8982 @item set print vtbl
8983 @itemx show print vtbl
8984 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8985 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8986 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8987 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8988
8989 @kindex set overload-resolution
8990 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
8991 @item set overload-resolution on
8992 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
8993 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8994 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
8995 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
8996 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
8997 message.
8998
8999 @item set overload-resolution off
9000 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9001 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9002 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9003 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9004 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9005 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9006 argument types.
9007
9008 @kindex show overload-resolution
9009 @item show overload-resolution
9010 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9011
9012 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9013 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9014 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9015 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9016 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9017 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9018 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9019 @end table
9020
9021 @node Objective-C
9022 @subsection Objective-C
9023
9024 @cindex Objective-C
9025 This section provides information about some commands and command
9026 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9027 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9028 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9029
9030 @menu
9031 * Method Names in Commands::
9032 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9033 @end menu
9034
9035 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9036 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9037
9038 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9039 names as line specifications:
9040
9041 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9042 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9043 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9044 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9045 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9046 @itemize
9047 @item @code{clear}
9048 @item @code{break}
9049 @item @code{info line}
9050 @item @code{jump}
9051 @item @code{list}
9052 @end itemize
9053
9054 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9055
9056 @smallexample
9057 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9058 @end smallexample
9059
9060 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9061 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9062 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9063 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9064 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9065 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9066 debugged, enter:
9067
9068 @smallexample
9069 break -[Fruit create]
9070 @end smallexample
9071
9072 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9073 enter:
9074
9075 @smallexample
9076 list +[NSText initialize]
9077 @end smallexample
9078
9079 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9080 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9081 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9082 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9083
9084 @smallexample
9085 break create
9086 @end smallexample
9087
9088 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9089 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9090 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9091 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9092 none apply.
9093
9094 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9095 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9096
9097 @smallexample
9098 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9099 @end smallexample
9100
9101 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9102 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9103 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9104 @kindex print-object
9105 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9106
9107 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9108
9109 @smallexample
9110 print -[@var{object} hash]
9111 @end smallexample
9112
9113 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9114 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9115 @noindent
9116 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9117 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9118 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9119 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9120 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9121 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9122
9123 @node Fortran
9124 @subsection Fortran
9125 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9126
9127 @table @code
9128 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9129 @kindex info common
9130 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9131 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9132 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9133 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9134 printed.
9135 @end table
9136
9137 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9138 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9139 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9140 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9141
9142 @node Pascal
9143 @subsection Pascal
9144
9145 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9146 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9147 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9148 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9149 syntax.
9150
9151 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9152 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9153 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9154
9155 @node Modula-2
9156 @subsection Modula-2
9157
9158 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9159
9160 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9161 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9162 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9163 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9164 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9165 table.
9166
9167 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9168 @menu
9169 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9170 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9171 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9172 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9173 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9174 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9175 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9176 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9177 @end menu
9178
9179 @node M2 Operators
9180 @subsubsection Operators
9181 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9182
9183 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9184 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9185 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9186 following definitions hold:
9187
9188 @itemize @bullet
9189
9190 @item
9191 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9192 their subranges.
9193
9194 @item
9195 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9196
9197 @item
9198 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9199
9200 @item
9201 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9202 @var{type}}.
9203
9204 @item
9205 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9206
9207 @item
9208 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9209
9210 @item
9211 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9212 @end itemize
9213
9214 @noindent
9215 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9216 increasing precedence:
9217
9218 @table @code
9219 @item ,
9220 Function argument or array index separator.
9221
9222 @item :=
9223 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9224 @var{value}.
9225
9226 @item <@r{, }>
9227 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9228 types.
9229
9230 @item <=@r{, }>=
9231 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9232 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9233 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9234
9235 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9236 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9237 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9238 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9239 comment character.
9240
9241 @item IN
9242 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9243 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9244
9245 @item OR
9246 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9247
9248 @item AND@r{, }&
9249 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9250
9251 @item @@
9252 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9253
9254 @item +@r{, }-
9255 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9256 and difference on set types.
9257
9258 @item *
9259 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9260 on set types.
9261
9262 @item /
9263 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9264 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9265
9266 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9267 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9268 precedence as @code{*}.
9269
9270 @item -
9271 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9272
9273 @item ^
9274 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9275
9276 @item NOT
9277 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9278 @code{^}.
9279
9280 @item .
9281 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9282 precedence as @code{^}.
9283
9284 @item []
9285 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9286
9287 @item ()
9288 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9289 as @code{^}.
9290
9291 @item ::@r{, }.
9292 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9293 @end table
9294
9295 @quotation
9296 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9297 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9298 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9299 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9300 @end quotation
9301
9302
9303 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9304 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9305 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9306
9307 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9308 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9309
9310 @table @var
9311
9312 @item a
9313 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9314
9315 @item c
9316 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9317
9318 @item i
9319 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9320
9321 @item m
9322 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9323 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9324 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9325
9326 @item n
9327 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9328
9329 @item r
9330 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9331
9332 @item t
9333 represents a type.
9334
9335 @item v
9336 represents a variable.
9337
9338 @item x
9339 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9340 explanation of the function for details.
9341 @end table
9342
9343 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9344
9345 @table @code
9346 @item ABS(@var{n})
9347 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9348
9349 @item CAP(@var{c})
9350 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9351 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9352
9353 @item CHR(@var{i})
9354 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9355
9356 @item DEC(@var{v})
9357 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9358
9359 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9360 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9361 new value.
9362
9363 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9364 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9365 set.
9366
9367 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9368 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9369
9370 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9371 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9372
9373 @item INC(@var{v})
9374 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9375
9376 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9377 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9378 new value.
9379
9380 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9381 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9382 there. Returns the new set.
9383
9384 @item MAX(@var{t})
9385 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9386
9387 @item MIN(@var{t})
9388 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9389
9390 @item ODD(@var{i})
9391 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9392
9393 @item ORD(@var{x})
9394 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9395 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9396 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9397 integral, character and enumerated types.
9398
9399 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9400 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9401
9402 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9403 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9404
9405 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9406 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9407 @end table
9408
9409 @quotation
9410 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9411 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9412 an error.
9413 @end quotation
9414
9415 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9416 @node M2 Constants
9417 @subsubsection Constants
9418
9419 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9420 ways:
9421
9422 @itemize @bullet
9423
9424 @item
9425 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9426 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9427 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9428 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9429
9430 @item
9431 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9432 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9433 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9434 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9435 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9436 digits.
9437
9438 @item
9439 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9440 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9441 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9442 followed by a @samp{C}.
9443
9444 @item
9445 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9446 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9447 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9448 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9449 sequences.
9450
9451 @item
9452 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9453
9454 @item
9455 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9456 @code{FALSE}.
9457
9458 @item
9459 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9460
9461 @item
9462 Set constants are not yet supported.
9463 @end itemize
9464
9465 @node M2 Defaults
9466 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
9467 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
9468
9469 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
9470 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
9471 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9472 selected the working language.
9473
9474 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
9475 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
9476 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
9477 the language automatically}, for further details.
9478
9479 @node Deviations
9480 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
9481 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
9482
9483 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
9484 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
9485
9486 @itemize @bullet
9487 @item
9488 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
9489 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
9490 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
9491 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
9492 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
9493 returned a pointer.)
9494
9495 @item
9496 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
9497 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
9498 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
9499 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
9500
9501 @item
9502 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
9503 argument.
9504
9505 @item
9506 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
9507 @end itemize
9508
9509 @node M2 Checks
9510 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
9511 @cindex Modula-2 checks
9512
9513 @quotation
9514 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
9515 range checking.
9516 @end quotation
9517 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
9518
9519 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
9520
9521 @itemize @bullet
9522 @item
9523 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
9524 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
9525
9526 @item
9527 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
9528 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
9529 @end itemize
9530
9531 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
9532 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
9533
9534 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
9535 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
9536
9537 @node M2 Scope
9538 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9539 @cindex scope
9540 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
9541 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
9542 @ifinfo
9543 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
9544 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
9545 @end ifinfo
9546 @iftex
9547 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
9548 @end iftex
9549
9550 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
9551 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
9552 similar syntax:
9553
9554 @smallexample
9555
9556 @var{module} . @var{id}
9557 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
9558 @end smallexample
9559
9560 @noindent
9561 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
9562 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
9563 identifier within your program, except another module.
9564
9565 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
9566 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
9567 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
9568 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
9569
9570 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
9571 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
9572 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
9573 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
9574 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
9575 @var{module}.
9576
9577 @node GDB/M2
9578 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9579
9580 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
9581 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
9582 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
9583 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
9584 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
9585 analogue in Modula-2.
9586
9587 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
9588 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
9589 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
9590 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
9591 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
9592 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
9593
9594 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
9595 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
9596 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
9597
9598 @node Ada
9599 @subsection Ada
9600 @cindex Ada
9601
9602 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
9603 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
9604 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
9605 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9606 to be difficult.
9607
9608
9609 @cindex expressions in Ada
9610 @menu
9611 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
9612 and semantics supported by Ada mode
9613 in @value{GDBN}.
9614 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
9615 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
9616 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
9617 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
9618 @end menu
9619
9620 @node Ada Mode Intro
9621 @subsubsection Introduction
9622 @cindex Ada mode, general
9623
9624 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
9625 syntax, with some extensions.
9626 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
9627
9628 @itemize @bullet
9629 @item
9630 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
9631 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
9632 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
9633 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
9634
9635 @item
9636 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
9637 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
9638
9639 @item
9640 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
9641 @end itemize
9642
9643 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
9644 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
9645 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
9646 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
9647 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
9648
9649 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
9650 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
9651 was translated from an Ada source file.
9652
9653 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
9654 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
9655 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
9656 middle (to allow based literals).
9657
9658 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
9659 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
9660 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
9661 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
9662 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
9663 functions to procedures elsewhere.
9664
9665 @node Omissions from Ada
9666 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
9667 @cindex Ada, omissions from
9668
9669 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
9670
9671 @itemize @bullet
9672 @item
9673 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
9674
9675 @itemize @minus
9676 @item
9677 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
9678 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
9679
9680 @item
9681 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
9682
9683 @item
9684 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
9685
9686 @item
9687 @t{'Tag}.
9688
9689 @item
9690 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
9691 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
9692
9693 @item
9694 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
9695 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
9696
9697 @item
9698 @t{'Address}.
9699 @end itemize
9700
9701 @item
9702 The names in
9703 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
9704 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
9705 not currently available.
9706
9707 @item
9708 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
9709 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
9710 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
9711 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
9712 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
9713 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
9714 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
9715 indeterminate values.
9716
9717 @item
9718 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
9719 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
9720 are not implemented.
9721
9722 @item
9723 There are no record or array aggregates.
9724
9725 @item
9726 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
9727
9728 @item
9729 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
9730 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
9731 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
9732 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
9733 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
9734
9735 @item
9736 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
9737
9738 @item
9739 Entry calls are not implemented.
9740
9741 @item
9742 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
9743 formats are not supported.
9744
9745 @item
9746 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
9747 @end itemize
9748
9749 @node Additions to Ada
9750 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
9751 @cindex Ada, deviations from
9752
9753 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
9754 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
9755
9756 @itemize @bullet
9757 @item
9758 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
9759 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
9760 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
9761 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
9762 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
9763 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
9764 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
9765 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
9766
9767 @item
9768 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
9769 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
9770 surround it in single quotes.
9771
9772 @item
9773 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
9774 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
9775
9776 @item
9777 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
9778 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
9779 @end itemize
9780
9781 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
9782 to Ada:
9783
9784 @itemize @bullet
9785 @item
9786 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
9787 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
9788
9789 @smallexample
9790 set x := y + 3
9791 print A(tmp := y + 1)
9792 @end smallexample
9793
9794 @item
9795 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
9796 the value of its right-hand operand.
9797 This allows, for example,
9798 complex conditional breaks:
9799
9800 @smallexample
9801 break f
9802 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
9803 @end smallexample
9804
9805 @item
9806 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
9807 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
9808 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
9809 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
9810 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
9811 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
9812 in strings. For example,
9813 @smallexample
9814 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
9815 @end smallexample
9816 @noindent
9817 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
9818 period.
9819
9820 @item
9821 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
9822 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
9823 to write
9824
9825 @smallexample
9826 print 'max(x, y)
9827 @end smallexample
9828
9829 @item
9830 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
9831 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
9832 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
9833
9834 @smallexample
9835 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
9836 @end smallexample
9837
9838 @noindent
9839 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
9840 clause.
9841
9842 @item
9843 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
9844 multi-character subsequence of
9845 their names (an exact match gets preference).
9846 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
9847 in place of @t{a'length}.
9848
9849 @item
9850 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
9851 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
9852 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
9853 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
9854 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
9855 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
9856 For example,
9857 @smallexample
9858 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
9859 @end smallexample
9860
9861 @item
9862 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
9863 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
9864 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
9865 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
9866 object.
9867
9868 @end itemize
9869
9870 @node Stopping Before Main Program
9871 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
9872
9873 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
9874 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
9875 before reaching the main procedure.
9876 As defined in the Ada Reference
9877 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
9878 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
9879 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
9880 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
9881
9882 @node Ada Glitches
9883 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
9884 @cindex Ada, problems
9885
9886 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
9887 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
9888 @value{GDBN},
9889 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
9890 and the GNU Ada compiler.
9891
9892 @itemize @bullet
9893 @item
9894 Currently, the debugger
9895 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
9896 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
9897 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
9898 to get it printed properly.
9899
9900 @item
9901 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
9902 storage are invisible to the debugger.
9903
9904 @item
9905 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
9906 argument lists are treated as positional).
9907
9908 @item
9909 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
9910
9911 @item
9912 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
9913 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
9914 the host machine.
9915
9916 @item
9917 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
9918
9919 @item
9920 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
9921 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
9922 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
9923 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
9924 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
9925 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
9926 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
9927 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
9928 you can usually resolve the confusion
9929 by qualifying the problematic names with package
9930 @code{Standard} explicitly.
9931 @end itemize
9932
9933 @node Unsupported languages
9934 @section Unsupported languages
9935
9936 @cindex unsupported languages
9937 @cindex minimal language
9938 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
9939 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
9940 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
9941 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
9942 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
9943 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
9944
9945 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
9946 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
9947 language.
9948
9949 @node Symbols
9950 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
9951
9952 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
9953 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
9954 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
9955 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
9956 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
9957 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
9958 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9959
9960 @cindex symbol names
9961 @cindex names of symbols
9962 @cindex quoting names
9963 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
9964 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
9965 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
9966 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
9967 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
9968 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
9969 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
9970 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
9971
9972 @smallexample
9973 p 'foo.c'::x
9974 @end smallexample
9975
9976 @noindent
9977 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
9978
9979 @table @code
9980 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
9981 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
9982 @kindex set case-sensitive
9983 @item set case-sensitive on
9984 @itemx set case-sensitive off
9985 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
9986 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
9987 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
9988 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
9989 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
9990 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
9991 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
9992 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
9993 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
9994 case-insensitive matches.
9995
9996 @kindex show case-sensitive
9997 @item show case-sensitive
9998 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
9999 lookups.
10000
10001 @kindex info address
10002 @cindex address of a symbol
10003 @item info address @var{symbol}
10004 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10005 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10006 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10007 is always stored.
10008
10009 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10010 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10011 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10012
10013 @kindex info symbol
10014 @cindex symbol from address
10015 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10016 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10017 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10018 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10019 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10020
10021 @smallexample
10022 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10023 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10024 @end smallexample
10025
10026 @noindent
10027 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10028 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10029
10030 @kindex whatis
10031 @item whatis @var{expr}
10032 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
10033 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10034 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
10035 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10036
10037 @item whatis
10038 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10039
10040 @kindex ptype
10041 @item ptype @var{typename}
10042 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
10043 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
10044 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
10045 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10046
10047 @item ptype @var{expr}
10048 @itemx ptype
10049 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
10050 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
10051 of just the name of the type.
10052
10053 For example, for this variable declaration:
10054
10055 @smallexample
10056 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10057 @end smallexample
10058
10059 @noindent
10060 the two commands give this output:
10061
10062 @smallexample
10063 @group
10064 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10065 type = struct complex
10066 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10067 type = struct complex @{
10068 double real;
10069 double imag;
10070 @}
10071 @end group
10072 @end smallexample
10073
10074 @noindent
10075 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10076 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10077
10078 @cindex incomplete type
10079 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10080 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10081 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10082 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10083 given these declarations:
10084
10085 @smallexample
10086 struct foo;
10087 struct foo *fooptr;
10088 @end smallexample
10089
10090 @noindent
10091 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10092
10093 @smallexample
10094 (gdb) ptype foo
10095 $1 = <incomplete type>
10096 @end smallexample
10097
10098 @noindent
10099 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10100 completely specified.
10101
10102 @kindex info types
10103 @item info types @var{regexp}
10104 @itemx info types
10105 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10106 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10107 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10108 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10109 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10110 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10111 name is @code{value}.
10112
10113 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10114 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10115 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10116
10117 @kindex info scope
10118 @cindex local variables
10119 @item info scope @var{location}
10120 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10121 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10122 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10123 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10124
10125 @smallexample
10126 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10127 Scope for command_line_handler:
10128 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10129 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10130 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10131 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10132 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10133 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10134 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10135 @end smallexample
10136
10137 @noindent
10138 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10139 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10140 collect}.
10141
10142 @kindex info source
10143 @item info source
10144 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10145 the function containing the current point of execution:
10146 @itemize @bullet
10147 @item
10148 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10149 @item
10150 the directory it was compiled in,
10151 @item
10152 its length, in lines,
10153 @item
10154 which programming language it is written in,
10155 @item
10156 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10157 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10158 @item
10159 whether the debugging information includes information about
10160 preprocessor macros.
10161 @end itemize
10162
10163
10164 @kindex info sources
10165 @item info sources
10166 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10167 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10168 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10169
10170 @kindex info functions
10171 @item info functions
10172 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10173
10174 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10175 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10176 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10177 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10178 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10179 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10180 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
10181 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10182
10183 @kindex info variables
10184 @item info variables
10185 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10186 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10187
10188 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10189 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10190 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10191 @var{regexp}.
10192
10193 @kindex info classes
10194 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10195 @item info classes
10196 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10197 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10198 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10199 expression.
10200
10201 @kindex info selectors
10202 @item info selectors
10203 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10204 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10205 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10206 expression.
10207
10208 @ignore
10209 This was never implemented.
10210 @kindex info methods
10211 @item info methods
10212 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10213 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10214 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10215 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10216 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10217 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10218 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10219 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10220 @end ignore
10221
10222 @cindex reloading symbols
10223 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10224 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10225 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10226 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10227 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10228
10229 @table @code
10230 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10231 @item set symbol-reloading on
10232 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10233 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10234
10235 @item set symbol-reloading off
10236 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10237 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10238 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10239 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10240 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10241 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10242 name.
10243
10244 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10245 @item show symbol-reloading
10246 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10247 @end table
10248
10249 @cindex opaque data types
10250 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10251 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10252 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10253 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10254 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10255 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10256 another source file. The default is on.
10257
10258 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10259 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10260
10261 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10262 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10263 is printed as follows:
10264 @smallexample
10265 @{<no data fields>@}
10266 @end smallexample
10267
10268 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10269 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10270 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10271
10272 @kindex maint print symbols
10273 @cindex symbol dump
10274 @kindex maint print psymbols
10275 @cindex partial symbol dump
10276 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10277 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10278 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10279 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10280 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10281 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10282 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10283 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10284 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10285 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10286 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10287 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10288 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10289 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
10290 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
10291 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
10292 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
10293
10294 @kindex maint info symtabs
10295 @kindex maint info psymtabs
10296 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
10297 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10298 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10299 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10300 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10301 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10302
10303 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
10304 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
10305 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
10306 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
10307 structure in more detail. For example:
10308
10309 @smallexample
10310 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
10311 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10312 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10313 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10314 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
10315 readin no
10316 fullname (null)
10317 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
10318 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
10319 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
10320 dependencies (none)
10321 @}
10322 @}
10323 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10324 (@value{GDBP})
10325 @end smallexample
10326 @noindent
10327 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
10328 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
10329 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
10330 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
10331 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
10332
10333 @smallexample
10334 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
10335 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
10336 line 1574.
10337 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10338 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10339 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10340 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10341 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
10342 dirname (null)
10343 fullname (null)
10344 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
10345 debugformat DWARF 2
10346 @}
10347 @}
10348 (@value{GDBP})
10349 @end smallexample
10350 @end table
10351
10352
10353 @node Altering
10354 @chapter Altering Execution
10355
10356 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
10357 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
10358 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
10359 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
10360 program.
10361
10362 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
10363 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
10364 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
10365
10366 @menu
10367 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
10368 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
10369 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
10370 * Returning:: Returning from a function
10371 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
10372 * Patching:: Patching your program
10373 @end menu
10374
10375 @node Assignment
10376 @section Assignment to variables
10377
10378 @cindex assignment
10379 @cindex setting variables
10380 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
10381 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
10382
10383 @smallexample
10384 print x=4
10385 @end smallexample
10386
10387 @noindent
10388 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
10389 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
10390 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
10391 information on operators in supported languages.
10392
10393 @kindex set variable
10394 @cindex variables, setting
10395 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
10396 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
10397 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
10398 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
10399 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
10400
10401 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
10402 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
10403 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
10404 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
10405 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
10406 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
10407 command @code{set width}:
10408
10409 @smallexample
10410 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
10411 type = double
10412 (@value{GDBP}) p width
10413 $4 = 13
10414 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
10415 Invalid syntax in expression.
10416 @end smallexample
10417
10418 @noindent
10419 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
10420 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
10421
10422 @smallexample
10423 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
10424 @end smallexample
10425
10426 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
10427 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
10428 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
10429 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
10430 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
10431 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
10432
10433 @smallexample
10434 @group
10435 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
10436 type = double
10437 (@value{GDBP}) p g
10438 $1 = 1
10439 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
10440 (@value{GDBP}) p g
10441 $2 = 1
10442 (@value{GDBP}) r
10443 The program being debugged has been started already.
10444 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
10445 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
10446 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
10447 Invalid bfd target.
10448 (@value{GDBP}) show g
10449 The current BFD target is "=4".
10450 @end group
10451 @end smallexample
10452
10453 @noindent
10454 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
10455 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
10456 @code{g}, use
10457
10458 @smallexample
10459 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
10460 @end smallexample
10461
10462 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
10463 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
10464 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
10465 same length or shorter.
10466 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
10467 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
10468
10469 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
10470 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
10471 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
10472 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
10473 and representation in memory), and
10474
10475 @smallexample
10476 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
10477 @end smallexample
10478
10479 @noindent
10480 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
10481
10482 @node Jumping
10483 @section Continuing at a different address
10484
10485 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
10486 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
10487 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
10488
10489 @table @code
10490 @kindex jump
10491 @item jump @var{linespec}
10492 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
10493 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
10494 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
10495 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
10496 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
10497 breakpoints}.
10498
10499 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
10500 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
10501 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
10502 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
10503 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
10504 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
10505 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
10506 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
10507 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
10508
10509 @item jump *@var{address}
10510 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
10511 @end table
10512
10513 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
10514 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
10515 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
10516 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
10517 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
10518 example,
10519
10520 @smallexample
10521 set $pc = 0x485
10522 @end smallexample
10523
10524 @noindent
10525 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
10526 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
10527 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
10528
10529 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
10530 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
10531 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
10532 detail.
10533
10534 @c @group
10535 @node Signaling
10536 @section Giving your program a signal
10537 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
10538
10539 @table @code
10540 @kindex signal
10541 @item signal @var{signal}
10542 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
10543 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
10544 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
10545 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
10546
10547 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
10548 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
10549 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
10550 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
10551 signal.
10552
10553 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
10554 after executing the command.
10555 @end table
10556 @c @end group
10557
10558 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
10559 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
10560 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
10561 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
10562 passes the signal directly to your program.
10563
10564
10565 @node Returning
10566 @section Returning from a function
10567
10568 @table @code
10569 @cindex returning from a function
10570 @kindex return
10571 @item return
10572 @itemx return @var{expression}
10573 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
10574 command. If you give an
10575 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
10576 value.
10577 @end table
10578
10579 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
10580 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
10581 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
10582 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
10583
10584 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
10585 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
10586 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
10587 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
10588 of functions.
10589
10590 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
10591 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
10592 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
10593 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
10594 selected stack frame returns naturally.
10595
10596 @node Calling
10597 @section Calling program functions
10598
10599 @table @code
10600 @cindex calling functions
10601 @cindex inferior functions, calling
10602 @item print @var{expr}
10603 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
10604 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
10605 debugged.
10606
10607 @kindex call
10608 @item call @var{expr}
10609 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
10610 returned values.
10611
10612 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
10613 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
10614 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
10615 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
10616 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
10617 value history.
10618 @end table
10619
10620 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
10621 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
10622 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
10623 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
10624
10625 @table @code
10626 @item set unwindonsignal
10627 @kindex set unwindonsignal
10628 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
10629 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
10630 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
10631 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
10632 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
10633 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
10634 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
10635 received.
10636
10637 @item show unwindonsignal
10638 @kindex show unwindonsignal
10639 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
10640 @value{GDBN}.
10641 @end table
10642
10643 @cindex weak alias functions
10644 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
10645 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
10646 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
10647 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
10648 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
10649 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
10650 function instead.
10651
10652 @node Patching
10653 @section Patching programs
10654
10655 @cindex patching binaries
10656 @cindex writing into executables
10657 @cindex writing into corefiles
10658
10659 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
10660 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
10661 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
10662 patching your program's binary.
10663
10664 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
10665 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
10666 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
10667 repairs.
10668
10669 @table @code
10670 @kindex set write
10671 @item set write on
10672 @itemx set write off
10673 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
10674 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
10675 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
10676
10677 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
10678 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
10679 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
10680
10681 @item show write
10682 @kindex show write
10683 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
10684 as well as reading.
10685 @end table
10686
10687 @node GDB Files
10688 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
10689
10690 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
10691 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
10692 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
10693 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
10694
10695 @menu
10696 * Files:: Commands to specify files
10697 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
10698 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
10699 @end menu
10700
10701 @node Files
10702 @section Commands to specify files
10703
10704 @cindex symbol table
10705 @cindex core dump file
10706
10707 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
10708 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
10709 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
10710 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
10711
10712 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
10713 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
10714 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
10715 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
10716 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
10717
10718 @table @code
10719 @cindex executable file
10720 @kindex file
10721 @item file @var{filename}
10722 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
10723 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
10724 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
10725 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
10726 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
10727 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
10728 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
10729 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
10730
10731 @cindex unlinked object files
10732 @cindex patching object files
10733 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
10734 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
10735 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
10736 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
10737 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
10738 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
10739 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
10740 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
10741
10742 @item file
10743 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
10744 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
10745
10746 @kindex exec-file
10747 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
10748 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
10749 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
10750 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
10751 discard information on the executable file.
10752
10753 @kindex symbol-file
10754 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
10755 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
10756 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
10757 table and program to run from the same file.
10758
10759 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
10760 program's symbol table.
10761
10762 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
10763 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
10764 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
10765 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
10766 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
10767
10768 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
10769 executing it once.
10770
10771 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
10772 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
10773 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
10774 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
10775 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
10776 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
10777 optimized code.
10778
10779 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
10780 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
10781 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
10782 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
10783 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
10784
10785 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
10786 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
10787 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
10788 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
10789 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
10790 warnings and messages}.)
10791
10792 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
10793 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
10794 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
10795 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
10796 in stabs format.
10797
10798 @kindex readnow
10799 @cindex reading symbols immediately
10800 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
10801 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
10802 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
10803 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
10804 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
10805 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
10806 entire symbol table available.
10807
10808 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
10809 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
10810 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
10811 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
10812 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
10813 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
10814 @c files.
10815
10816 @kindex core-file
10817 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
10818 @itemx core
10819 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
10820 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
10821 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
10822 executable file itself for other parts.
10823
10824 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
10825 to be used.
10826
10827 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
10828 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
10829 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
10830 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
10831 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
10832
10833 @kindex add-symbol-file
10834 @cindex dynamic linking
10835 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
10836 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
10837 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
10838 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
10839 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
10840 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
10841 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
10842 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
10843 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
10844 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
10845 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
10846 @var{address} as an expression.
10847
10848 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
10849 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
10850 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
10851 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
10852 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
10853
10854 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
10855 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
10856 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
10857 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
10858 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
10859 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
10860 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
10861 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
10862 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
10863
10864 @itemize @bullet
10865 @item
10866 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
10867 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
10868 @item
10869 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
10870 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
10871 @item
10872 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
10873 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10874 @end itemize
10875
10876 @noindent
10877 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
10878 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
10879 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
10880 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
10881 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
10882 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
10883 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
10884 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
10885 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
10886 way.
10887
10888 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10889
10890 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
10891 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
10892 @cindex load symbols from memory
10893 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
10894 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
10895 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
10896 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
10897 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
10898 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
10899 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
10900 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
10901 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
10902
10903 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
10904 @kindex assf
10905 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
10906 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
10907 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
10908 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
10909 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
10910 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
10911 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
10912 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
10913 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
10914 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
10915
10916 @kindex section
10917 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
10918 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
10919 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
10920 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
10921 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
10922 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
10923 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
10924 their addresses.
10925
10926 @kindex info files
10927 @kindex info target
10928 @item info files
10929 @itemx info target
10930 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
10931 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
10932 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
10933 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
10934 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
10935 current ones.
10936
10937 @kindex maint info sections
10938 @item maint info sections
10939 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
10940 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
10941 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
10942 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
10943 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
10944 may be arbitrarily combined):
10945
10946 @table @code
10947 @item ALLOBJ
10948 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
10949 @item @var{sections}
10950 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
10951 @item @var{section-flags}
10952 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
10953 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
10954 @table @code
10955 @item ALLOC
10956 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
10957 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
10958 @item LOAD
10959 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
10960 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
10961 @item RELOC
10962 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
10963 @item READONLY
10964 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
10965 @item CODE
10966 Section contains executable code only.
10967 @item DATA
10968 Section contains data only (no executable code).
10969 @item ROM
10970 Section will reside in ROM.
10971 @item CONSTRUCTOR
10972 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
10973 @item HAS_CONTENTS
10974 Section is not empty.
10975 @item NEVER_LOAD
10976 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
10977 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
10978 A notification to the linker that the section contains
10979 COFF shared library information.
10980 @item IS_COMMON
10981 Section contains common symbols.
10982 @end table
10983 @end table
10984 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
10985 @cindex read-only sections
10986 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
10987 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
10988 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
10989 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
10990 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
10991 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
10992 enhancement to debugging performance.
10993
10994 The default is off.
10995
10996 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
10997 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
10998 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
10999 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11000
11001 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11002 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11003 @end table
11004
11005 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11006 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11007 name and remembers it that way.
11008
11009 @cindex shared libraries
11010 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11011 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11012
11013 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11014 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11015 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11016 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11017 debugging a core file).
11018
11019 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11020 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11021
11022 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11023 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11024 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11025
11026 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11027 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11028 particularly large or there are many of them.
11029
11030 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11031 commands:
11032
11033 @table @code
11034 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11035 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11036 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11037 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11038 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11039 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11040 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11041 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11042
11043 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11044 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11045 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11046 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11047 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11048 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11049 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11050 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11051 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11052
11053 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11054 @item show auto-solib-add
11055 Display the current autoloading mode.
11056 @end table
11057
11058 @cindex load shared library
11059 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11060 command:
11061
11062 @table @code
11063 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11064 @kindex info share
11065 @item info share
11066 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11067 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11068
11069 @kindex sharedlibrary
11070 @kindex share
11071 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11072 @itemx share @var{regex}
11073 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11074 Unix regular expression.
11075 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11076 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11077 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11078 loaded.
11079
11080 @item nosharedlibrary
11081 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11082 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11083 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11084 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11085 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11086 discarded.
11087 @end table
11088
11089 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11090 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11091 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11092
11093 @table @code
11094 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11095 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11096 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11097 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11098 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11099 shared library.
11100
11101 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11102 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11103 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11104 library events happen.
11105 @end table
11106
11107 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11108 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11109 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11110 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11111 not.
11112
11113 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11114 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11115 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11116 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11117 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11118
11119 @table @code
11120 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11121 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11122 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
11123 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
11124 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
11125 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
11126 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
11127 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
11128 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
11129
11130 @cindex default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
11131 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11132 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
11133 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
11134
11135 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
11136 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
11137 Display the current shared library prefix.
11138
11139 @kindex set solib-search-path
11140 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11141 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
11142 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
11143 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
11144 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
11145 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
11146 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
11147 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
11148
11149 @kindex show solib-search-path
11150 @item show solib-search-path
11151 Display the current shared library search path.
11152 @end table
11153
11154
11155 @node Separate Debug Files
11156 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11157 @cindex separate debugging information files
11158 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11159 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11160 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11161 @cindex global debugging information directory
11162
11163 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11164 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11165 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11166 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11167 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11168 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11169 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11170
11171 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11172 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11173 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11174 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11175 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11176 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11177 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11178 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11179 places:
11180
11181 @itemize @bullet
11182 @item
11183 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11184 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11185 @item
11186 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11187 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11188 @item
11189 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11190 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11191 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11192 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11193 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11194 @end itemize
11195 @noindent
11196 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11197 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11198 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11199
11200 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11201 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11202 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11203 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11204 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11205 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11206
11207 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11208 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11209
11210 @table @code
11211
11212 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11213 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11214 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11215 information files to @var{directory}.
11216
11217 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11218 @item show debug-file-directory
11219 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11220 information files.
11221
11222 @end table
11223
11224 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11225 @cindex debug links
11226 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11227 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11228
11229 @itemize
11230 @item
11231 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11232 a zero byte,
11233 @item
11234 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11235 boundary within the section, and
11236 @item
11237 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11238 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11239 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11240 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11241 @end itemize
11242
11243 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11244 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11245 described above.
11246
11247 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11248 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11249 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11250 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11251 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11252 in an ordinary executable.
11253
11254 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11255 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11256 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11257 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11258 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11259 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11260 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11261
11262 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11263 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11264 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11265 complete code for a function that computes it:
11266
11267 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11268 @smallexample
11269 unsigned long
11270 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11271 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11272 @{
11273 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11274 @{
11275 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11276 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
11277 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
11278 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
11279 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
11280 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
11281 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
11282 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
11283 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
11284 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
11285 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
11286 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
11287 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
11288 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
11289 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
11290 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
11291 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
11292 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
11293 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
11294 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
11295 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
11296 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
11297 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
11298 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
11299 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
11300 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
11301 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
11302 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
11303 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
11304 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
11305 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
11306 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
11307 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
11308 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
11309 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
11310 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
11311 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
11312 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
11313 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
11314 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
11315 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
11316 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
11317 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
11318 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
11319 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
11320 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
11321 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
11322 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
11323 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
11324 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
11325 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
11326 0x2d02ef8d
11327 @};
11328 unsigned char *end;
11329
11330 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11331 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
11332 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
11333 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11334 @}
11335 @end smallexample
11336
11337
11338 @node Symbol Errors
11339 @section Errors reading symbol files
11340
11341 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
11342 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
11343 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
11344 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
11345 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
11346 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
11347 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
11348 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
11349 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
11350 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11351 messages}).
11352
11353 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
11354
11355 @table @code
11356 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
11357
11358 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
11359 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
11360 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
11361 in its outer scope blocks.
11362
11363 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
11364 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
11365 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
11366 function.
11367
11368 @item block at @var{address} out of order
11369
11370 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
11371 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
11372 do so.
11373
11374 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
11375 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
11376 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
11377 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11378 messages}.)
11379
11380 @item bad block start address patched
11381
11382 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
11383 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
11384 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
11385
11386 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
11387 starting on the previous source line.
11388
11389 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
11390
11391 @cindex foo
11392 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
11393 larger than the size of the string table.
11394
11395 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
11396 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
11397 with this name.
11398
11399 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
11400
11401 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
11402 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
11403 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
11404
11405 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
11406 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
11407 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
11408 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
11409 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
11410 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
11411
11412 @item stub type has NULL name
11413
11414 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
11415
11416 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
11417 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
11418 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
11419 it.
11420
11421 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
11422
11423 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
11424
11425 @end table
11426
11427 @node Targets
11428 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
11429
11430 @cindex debugging target
11431 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
11432
11433 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
11434 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
11435 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
11436 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
11437 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
11438 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
11439 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
11440 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11441
11442 @cindex target architecture
11443 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
11444 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
11445 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
11446 command.
11447
11448 @table @code
11449 @kindex set architecture
11450 @kindex show architecture
11451 @item set architecture @var{arch}
11452 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
11453 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
11454 supported architectures.
11455
11456 @item show architecture
11457 Show the current target architecture.
11458
11459 @item set processor
11460 @itemx processor
11461 @kindex set processor
11462 @kindex show processor
11463 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
11464 and @code{show architecture}.
11465 @end table
11466
11467 @menu
11468 * Active Targets:: Active targets
11469 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
11470 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
11471 * Remote:: Remote debugging
11472 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
11473
11474 @end menu
11475
11476 @node Active Targets
11477 @section Active targets
11478
11479 @cindex stacking targets
11480 @cindex active targets
11481 @cindex multiple targets
11482
11483 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
11484 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
11485 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
11486 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
11487 a core file.
11488
11489 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
11490 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
11491 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
11492 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
11493 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
11494 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
11495 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
11496 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
11497 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
11498
11499 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
11500 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
11501 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
11502 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
11503 process target is active.
11504
11505 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
11506 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
11507 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
11508 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
11509 process}).
11510
11511 @node Target Commands
11512 @section Commands for managing targets
11513
11514 @table @code
11515 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
11516 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
11517 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
11518 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
11519 protocol of the target machine.
11520
11521 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
11522 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
11523 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
11524
11525 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
11526 after executing the command.
11527
11528 @kindex help target
11529 @item help target
11530 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
11531 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
11532 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
11533
11534 @item help target @var{name}
11535 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
11536 select it.
11537
11538 @kindex set gnutarget
11539 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
11540 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
11541 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
11542 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
11543 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
11544 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
11545
11546 @quotation
11547 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
11548 you must know the actual BFD name.
11549 @end quotation
11550
11551 @noindent
11552 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
11553
11554 @kindex show gnutarget
11555 @item show gnutarget
11556 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
11557 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
11558 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
11559 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
11560 @end table
11561
11562 @cindex common targets
11563 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
11564 configuration):
11565
11566 @table @code
11567 @kindex target
11568 @item target exec @var{program}
11569 @cindex executable file target
11570 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
11571 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
11572
11573 @item target core @var{filename}
11574 @cindex core dump file target
11575 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
11576 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
11577
11578 @item target remote @var{dev}
11579 @cindex remote target
11580 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
11581 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
11582 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
11583 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
11584 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
11585 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
11586
11587 @item target sim
11588 @cindex built-in simulator target
11589 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
11590 In general,
11591 @smallexample
11592 target sim
11593 load
11594 run
11595 @end smallexample
11596 @noindent
11597 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
11598 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
11599 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
11600 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
11601 Processors}.
11602
11603 @end table
11604
11605 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
11606
11607 @table @code
11608
11609 @item target nrom @var{dev}
11610 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
11611 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
11612
11613 @end table
11614
11615 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
11616 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
11617
11618 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
11619 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
11620 various aspects of this process, such as the size of the data chunks
11621 used by @value{GDBN} to download program parts to the remote target.
11622
11623 @table @code
11624 @kindex set download-write-size
11625 @item set download-write-size @var{size}
11626 Set the write size used when downloading a program. Only used when
11627 downloading a program onto a remote target. Specify zero or a
11628 negative value to disable blocked writes. The actual size of each
11629 transfer is also limited by the size of the target packet and the
11630 memory cache.
11631
11632 @kindex show download-write-size
11633 @item show download-write-size
11634 @kindex show download-write-size
11635 Show the current value of the write size.
11636
11637 @item set hash
11638 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
11639 @cindex hash mark while downloading
11640 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
11641 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
11642 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
11643 monitor.
11644
11645 @item show hash
11646 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
11647 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
11648
11649 @item set debug monitor
11650 @kindex set debug monitor
11651 @cindex display remote monitor communications
11652 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
11653 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
11654
11655 @item show debug monitor
11656 @kindex show debug monitor
11657 Show the current status of displaying communications between
11658 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
11659 @end table
11660
11661 @table @code
11662
11663 @kindex load @var{filename}
11664 @item load @var{filename}
11665 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
11666 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
11667 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
11668 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
11669 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
11670 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11671
11672 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
11673 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
11674 target is @dots{}}''
11675
11676 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
11677 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
11678 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
11679 specifies a fixed address.
11680 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
11681
11682 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
11683 @end table
11684
11685 @node Byte Order
11686 @section Choosing target byte order
11687
11688 @cindex choosing target byte order
11689 @cindex target byte order
11690
11691 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
11692 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
11693 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
11694 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
11695 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
11696 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
11697
11698 @table @code
11699 @kindex set endian
11700 @item set endian big
11701 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
11702
11703 @item set endian little
11704 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
11705
11706 @item set endian auto
11707 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
11708 executable.
11709
11710 @item show endian
11711 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
11712
11713 @end table
11714
11715 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
11716 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
11717 target system.
11718
11719 @node Remote
11720 @section Remote debugging
11721 @cindex remote debugging
11722
11723 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
11724 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
11725 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
11726 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
11727 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
11728
11729 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
11730 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
11731 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
11732 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
11733 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
11734 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
11735
11736 Other remote targets may be available in your
11737 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
11738
11739 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
11740 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
11741
11742 @table @code
11743 @item remote @var{command}
11744 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
11745 @cindex send command to remote monitor
11746 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
11747 @end table
11748
11749
11750 @node KOD
11751 @section Kernel Object Display
11752 @cindex kernel object display
11753 @cindex KOD
11754
11755 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
11756 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
11757 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
11758 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
11759 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
11760
11761 @kindex set os
11762 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
11763 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
11764
11765 @smallexample
11766 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
11767 @end smallexample
11768
11769 @kindex show os
11770 The associated command @code{show os} displays the operating system
11771 set with the @code{set os} command; if no operating system has been
11772 set, @code{show os} will display an empty string @samp{""}.
11773
11774 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
11775 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
11776 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
11777 after the operating system:
11778
11779 @kindex info cisco
11780 @smallexample
11781 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
11782 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
11783 Object Description
11784 any Any and all objects
11785 @end smallexample
11786
11787 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
11788 by the kernel.
11789
11790 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating
11791 system is supported other than to try setting it with @kbd{set os
11792 @var{name}}, where @var{name} is the name of the operating system you
11793 want to try.
11794
11795
11796 @node Remote Debugging
11797 @chapter Debugging remote programs
11798
11799 @menu
11800 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
11801 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
11802 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
11803 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
11804 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
11805 @end menu
11806
11807 @node Connecting
11808 @section Connecting to a remote target
11809
11810 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
11811 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
11812 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
11813 program as the first argument.
11814
11815 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
11816 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
11817 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
11818 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
11819 @code{target} command.
11820
11821 After that, use @code{target remote} to establish communications with
11822 the target machine. Its argument specifies how to communicate---either
11823 via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a TCP or UDP port
11824 (possibly to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
11825 target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the device
11826 named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
11827
11828 @smallexample
11829 target remote /dev/ttyb
11830 @end smallexample
11831
11832 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
11833 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
11834 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
11835 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
11836 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
11837
11838 @smallexample
11839 target remote manyfarms:2828
11840 @end smallexample
11841
11842 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
11843 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
11844 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
11845 to port 1234 on your local machine:
11846
11847 @smallexample
11848 target remote :1234
11849 @end smallexample
11850 @noindent
11851
11852 Note that the colon is still required here.
11853
11854 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
11855 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
11856 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
11857 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
11858
11859 @smallexample
11860 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
11861 @end smallexample
11862
11863 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
11864 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
11865 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
11866 session.
11867
11868 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
11869 step and continue the remote program.
11870
11871 @cindex interrupting remote programs
11872 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
11873 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
11874 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
11875 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
11876 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
11877 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
11878
11879 @smallexample
11880 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
11881 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
11882 @end smallexample
11883
11884 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
11885 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
11886 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
11887 goes back to waiting.
11888
11889 @table @code
11890 @kindex detach (remote)
11891 @item detach
11892 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
11893 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
11894 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
11895 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
11896 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
11897
11898 @kindex disconnect
11899 @item disconnect
11900 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
11901 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
11902 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
11903 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
11904 another target.
11905
11906 @cindex send command to remote monitor
11907 @kindex monitor
11908 @item monitor @var{cmd}
11909 This command allows you to send commands directly to the remote
11910 monitor.
11911 @end table
11912
11913 @node Server
11914 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
11915
11916 @kindex gdbserver
11917 @cindex remote connection without stubs
11918 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
11919 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
11920 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
11921
11922 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
11923 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
11924 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
11925 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
11926 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
11927 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
11928 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
11929 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
11930 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
11931 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
11932 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
11933 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
11934 choice for debugging.
11935
11936 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
11937 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
11938 protocol.
11939
11940 @table @emph
11941 @item On the target machine,
11942 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
11943 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
11944 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
11945 system does all the symbol handling.
11946
11947 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
11948 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
11949 syntax is:
11950
11951 @smallexample
11952 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
11953 @end smallexample
11954
11955 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
11956 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
11957 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
11958 @file{/dev/com1}:
11959
11960 @smallexample
11961 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
11962 @end smallexample
11963
11964 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
11965 with it.
11966
11967 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
11968
11969 @smallexample
11970 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
11971 @end smallexample
11972
11973 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
11974 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
11975 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
11976 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
11977 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
11978 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
11979 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
11980 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
11981 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
11982 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
11983 @code{target remote} command.
11984
11985 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
11986 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
11987
11988 @smallexample
11989 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
11990 @end smallexample
11991
11992 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
11993 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
11994
11995 @pindex pidof
11996 @cindex attach to a program by name
11997 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
11998 @code{pidof} utility:
11999
12000 @smallexample
12001 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
12002 @end smallexample
12003
12004 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
12005 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12006 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12007
12008 @item On the host machine,
12009 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12010 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12011 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12012 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12013 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12014 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12015 already on the target. However, if you want to load the symbols (as
12016 you normally would), do that with the @code{file} command, and issue
12017 it @emph{before} connecting to the server; otherwise, you will get an
12018 error message saying @code{"Program is already running"}, since the
12019 program is considered running after the connection.
12020
12021 @end table
12022
12023 @node NetWare
12024 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
12025
12026 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
12027 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
12028 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12029 @code{target remote}.
12030
12031 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
12032 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
12033
12034 @table @emph
12035 @item On the target machine,
12036 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12037 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
12038 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
12039 host system does all the symbol handling.
12040
12041 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
12042 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
12043 program. The syntax is:
12044
12045 @smallexample
12046 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
12047 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12048 @end smallexample
12049
12050 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
12051 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
12052 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
12053
12054 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
12055 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
12056 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
12057
12058 @smallexample
12059 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
12060 @end smallexample
12061
12062 @item
12063 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,
12064 Connecting to a remote target}).
12065
12066 @end table
12067
12068 @node Remote configuration
12069 @section Remote configuration
12070
12071 @kindex set remote
12072 @kindex show remote
12073 This section documents the configuration options available when
12074 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12075 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{The system call,
12076 system-call-allowed}.
12077
12078 @table @code
12079 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12080 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12081 @cindex bits in remote address
12082 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12083 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12084 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12085 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12086
12087 @item show remoteaddresssize
12088 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12089
12090 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12091 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12092 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12093 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12094 remote targets.
12095
12096 @item show remotebaud
12097 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12098
12099 @item set remotebreak
12100 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12101 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12102 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12103 when you press the @key{Ctrl-C} key to interrupt the program running
12104 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Strl-C}
12105 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12106 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12107
12108 @item show remotebreak
12109 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12110 interrupt the remote program.
12111
12112 @item set remotedebug
12113 @cindex debug remote protocol
12114 @cindex remote protocol debugging
12115 @cindex display remote packets
12116 Control the debugging of the remote protocol. When enabled, each
12117 packet sent to or received from the remote target is displayed. The
12118 defaults is off.
12119
12120 @item show remotedebug
12121 Show the current setting of the remote protocol debugging.
12122
12123 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12124 @cindex serial port name
12125 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12126 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12127 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12128 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12129 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12130 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12131 arguments.)
12132
12133 @item show remotedevice
12134 Show the current name of the serial port.
12135
12136 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12137 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12138 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12139 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12140 @code{ascii}.
12141
12142 @item show remotelogbase
12143 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12144 protocol.
12145
12146 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12147 @cindex record serial communications on file
12148 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12149 default is not to record at all.
12150
12151 @item show remotelogfile.
12152 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12153 serial communications.
12154
12155 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12156 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12157 @cindex remote timeout
12158 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12159 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12160
12161 @item show remotetimeout
12162 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12163 responses.
12164
12165 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12166 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12167 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12168 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12169 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12170 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12171 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12172 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12173
12174 @item set remote fetch-register-packet
12175 @itemx set remote set-register-packet
12176 @itemx set remote P-packet
12177 @itemx set remote p-packet
12178 @cindex P-packet
12179 @cindex fetch registers from remote targets
12180 @cindex set registers in remote targets
12181 Determine whether @value{GDBN} can set and fetch registers from the
12182 remote target using the @samp{P} packets. The default depends on the
12183 remote stub's support of the @samp{P} packets (@value{GDBN} queries
12184 the stub when this packet is first required).
12185
12186 @item show remote fetch-register-packet
12187 @itemx show remote set-register-packet
12188 @itemx show remote P-packet
12189 @itemx show remote p-packet
12190 Show the current setting of using the @samp{P} packets for setting and
12191 fetching registers from the remote target.
12192
12193 @cindex binary downloads
12194 @cindex X-packet
12195 @item set remote binary-download-packet
12196 @itemx set remote X-packet
12197 Determine whether @value{GDBN} sends downloads in binary mode using
12198 the @samp{X} packets. The default is on.
12199
12200 @item show remote binary-download-packet
12201 @itemx show remote X-packet
12202 Show the current setting of using the @samp{X} packets for binary
12203 downloads.
12204
12205 @item set remote read-aux-vector-packet
12206 @cindex auxiliary vector of remote target
12207 @cindex @code{auxv}, and remote targets
12208 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qPart:auxv:read} (target
12209 auxiliary vector read) request. This request is used to fetch the
12210 remote target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}, see @ref{OS Information,
12211 Auxiliary Vector}. The default setting depends on the remote stub's
12212 support of this request (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this
12213 request is first required). @xref{General Query Packets, qPart}, for
12214 more information about this request.
12215
12216 @item show remote read-aux-vector-packet
12217 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qPart:auxv:read} request.
12218
12219 @item set remote symbol-lookup-packet
12220 @cindex remote symbol lookup request
12221 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qSymbol} (target symbol
12222 lookup) request. This request is used to communicate symbol
12223 information to the remote target, e.g., whenever a new shared library
12224 is loaded by the remote (@pxref{Files, shared libraries}). The
12225 default setting depends on the remote stub's support of this request
12226 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this request is first required).
12227 @xref{General Query Packets, qSymbol}, for more information about this
12228 request.
12229
12230 @item show remote symbol-lookup-packet
12231 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qSymbol} request.
12232
12233 @item set remote verbose-resume-packet
12234 @cindex resume remote target
12235 @cindex signal thread, and remote targets
12236 @cindex single-step thread, and remote targets
12237 @cindex thread-specific operations on remote targets
12238 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{vCont} (descriptive resume)
12239 request. This request is used to resume specific threads in the
12240 remote target, and to single-step or signal them. The default setting
12241 depends on the remote stub's support of this request (@value{GDBN}
12242 queries the stub when this request is first required). This setting
12243 affects debugging of multithreaded programs: if @samp{vCont} cannot be
12244 used, @value{GDBN} might be unable to single-step a specific thread,
12245 especially under @code{set scheduler-locking off}; it is also
12246 impossible to pause a specific thread. @xref{Packets, vCont}, for
12247 more details.
12248
12249 @item show remote verbose-resume-packet
12250 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{vCont} request
12251
12252 @item set remote software-breakpoint-packet
12253 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12254 @itemx set remote write-watchpoint-packet
12255 @itemx set remote read-watchpoint-packet
12256 @itemx set remote access-watchpoint-packet
12257 @itemx set remote Z-packet
12258 @cindex Z-packet
12259 @cindex remote hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12260 These commands enable or disable the use of @samp{Z} packets for
12261 setting breakpoints and watchpoints in the remote target. The default
12262 depends on the remote stub's support of the @samp{Z} packets
12263 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when each packet is first required).
12264 The command @code{set remote Z-packet}, kept for back-compatibility,
12265 turns on or off all the features that require the use of @samp{Z}
12266 packets.
12267
12268 @item show remote software-breakpoint-packet
12269 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12270 @itemx show remote write-watchpoint-packet
12271 @itemx show remote read-watchpoint-packet
12272 @itemx show remote access-watchpoint-packet
12273 @itemx show remote Z-packet
12274 Show the current setting of @samp{Z} packets usage.
12275
12276 @item set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12277 @kindex set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12278 @cindex thread local storage of remote targets
12279 This command enables or disables the use of the @samp{qGetTLSAddr}
12280 (Get Thread Local Storage Address) request packet. The default
12281 depends on whether the remote stub supports this request.
12282 @xref{General Query Packets, qGetTLSAddr}, for more details about this
12283 packet.
12284
12285 @item show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12286 @kindex show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12287 Show the current setting of @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet usage.
12288 @end table
12289
12290 @node remote stub
12291 @section Implementing a remote stub
12292
12293 @cindex debugging stub, example
12294 @cindex remote stub, example
12295 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12296 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12297 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12298 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12299 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12300 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12301 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12302 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12303
12304 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12305 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12306 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12307 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12308 program, you need:
12309
12310 @enumerate
12311 @item
12312 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12313 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12314 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12315
12316 @item
12317 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12318 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12319
12320 @item
12321 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12322 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12323 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12324 documentation.
12325 @end enumerate
12326
12327 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12328 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12329 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12330
12331 @table @emph
12332 @item On the host,
12333 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12334 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12335 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12336
12337 @item On the target,
12338 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12339 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12340 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12341
12342 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12343 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12344 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12345 @end table
12346
12347 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12348 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12349 @sc{sparc} boards.
12350
12351 @cindex remote serial stub list
12352 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12353
12354 @table @code
12355
12356 @item i386-stub.c
12357 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12358 @cindex Intel
12359 @cindex i386
12360 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12361
12362 @item m68k-stub.c
12363 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12364 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12365 @cindex m680x0
12366 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12367
12368 @item sh-stub.c
12369 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12370 @cindex Renesas
12371 @cindex SH
12372 For Renesas SH architectures.
12373
12374 @item sparc-stub.c
12375 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
12376 @cindex Sparc
12377 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
12378
12379 @item sparcl-stub.c
12380 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
12381 @cindex Fujitsu
12382 @cindex SparcLite
12383 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
12384
12385 @end table
12386
12387 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
12388 recently added stubs.
12389
12390 @menu
12391 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
12392 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
12393 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
12394 @end menu
12395
12396 @node Stub Contents
12397 @subsection What the stub can do for you
12398
12399 @cindex remote serial stub
12400 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
12401 subroutines:
12402
12403 @table @code
12404 @item set_debug_traps
12405 @findex set_debug_traps
12406 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
12407 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
12408 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
12409 beginning of your program.
12410
12411 @item handle_exception
12412 @findex handle_exception
12413 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
12414 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
12415 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
12416 run when a trap is triggered.
12417
12418 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
12419 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
12420 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
12421 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
12422 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
12423 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
12424 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
12425 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
12426 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
12427 machine.
12428
12429 @item breakpoint
12430 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
12431 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
12432 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
12433 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
12434 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
12435 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
12436 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
12437 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
12438 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
12439 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
12440 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
12441
12442 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
12443 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
12444 start of your debugging session.
12445 @end table
12446
12447 @node Bootstrapping
12448 @subsection What you must do for the stub
12449
12450 @cindex remote stub, support routines
12451 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
12452 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
12453 debugging target machine.
12454
12455 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
12456 serial port.
12457
12458 @table @code
12459 @item int getDebugChar()
12460 @findex getDebugChar
12461 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
12462 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
12463 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
12464
12465 @item void putDebugChar(int)
12466 @findex putDebugChar
12467 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
12468 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
12469 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
12470 @end table
12471
12472 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
12473 @cindex interrupting remote targets
12474 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
12475 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
12476 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
12477 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
12478 remote system to stop.
12479
12480 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
12481 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
12482 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
12483 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
12484
12485 Other routines you need to supply are:
12486
12487 @table @code
12488 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
12489 @findex exceptionHandler
12490 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
12491 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
12492 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
12493 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
12494 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
12495 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
12496 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
12497 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
12498 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
12499 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
12500 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
12501 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
12502 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
12503
12504 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
12505 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
12506 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
12507 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
12508 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
12509
12510 @item void flush_i_cache()
12511 @findex flush_i_cache
12512 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
12513 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
12514 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
12515
12516 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
12517 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
12518 @end table
12519
12520 @noindent
12521 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
12522
12523 @table @code
12524 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
12525 @findex memset
12526 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
12527 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
12528 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
12529 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
12530 @end table
12531
12532 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
12533 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
12534 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
12535 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
12536
12537
12538 @node Debug Session
12539 @subsection Putting it all together
12540
12541 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
12542 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
12543 steps.
12544
12545 @enumerate
12546 @item
12547 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
12548 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
12549 @display
12550 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
12551 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
12552 @end display
12553
12554 @item
12555 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
12556
12557 @smallexample
12558 set_debug_traps();
12559 breakpoint();
12560 @end smallexample
12561
12562 @item
12563 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
12564 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
12565
12566 @smallexample
12567 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
12568 @end smallexample
12569
12570 @noindent
12571 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
12572 function in your program, that function is called when
12573 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
12574 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
12575 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
12576
12577 @item
12578 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
12579 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
12580
12581 @item
12582 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
12583 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
12584
12585 @item
12586 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
12587 @c document that. FIXME.
12588 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
12589 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
12590
12591 @item
12592 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
12593 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12594
12595 @end enumerate
12596
12597 @node Configurations
12598 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
12599
12600 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
12601 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
12602 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
12603
12604 There are three major categories of configurations: native
12605 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
12606 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
12607 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
12608 are quite different from each other.
12609
12610 @menu
12611 * Native::
12612 * Embedded OS::
12613 * Embedded Processors::
12614 * Architectures::
12615 @end menu
12616
12617 @node Native
12618 @section Native
12619
12620 This section describes details specific to particular native
12621 configurations.
12622
12623 @menu
12624 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
12625 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
12626 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
12627 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
12628 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
12629 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
12630 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
12631 @end menu
12632
12633 @node HP-UX
12634 @subsection HP-UX
12635
12636 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
12637 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
12638 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
12639
12640
12641 @node BSD libkvm Interface
12642 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
12643
12644 @cindex libkvm
12645 @cindex kernel memory image
12646 @cindex kernel crash dump
12647
12648 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
12649 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
12650 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
12651 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
12652 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
12653 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
12654 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
12655 @code{kvm} target:
12656
12657 @smallexample
12658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
12659 @end smallexample
12660
12661 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
12662 argument:
12663
12664 @smallexample
12665 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
12666 @end smallexample
12667
12668 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
12669 available:
12670
12671 @table @code
12672 @kindex kvm
12673 @item kvm pcb
12674 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
12675
12676 @item kvm proc
12677 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
12678 modern FreeBSD systems.
12679 @end table
12680
12681 @node SVR4 Process Information
12682 @subsection SVR4 process information
12683 @cindex /proc
12684 @cindex examine process image
12685 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
12686
12687 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
12688 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
12689 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
12690 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
12691 proc} is available to report information about the process running
12692 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
12693 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
12694 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
12695 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
12696
12697 @table @code
12698 @kindex info proc
12699 @cindex process ID
12700 @item info proc
12701 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
12702 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
12703 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
12704 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
12705 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
12706 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
12707 executable file's absolute file name.
12708
12709 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
12710 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
12711 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
12712 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
12713 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
12714 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
12715
12716 @item info proc mappings
12717 @cindex memory address space mappings
12718 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
12719 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
12720 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
12721 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
12722 memory access rights to that range.
12723
12724 @item info proc stat
12725 @itemx info proc status
12726 @cindex process detailed status information
12727 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
12728 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
12729 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
12730 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
12731 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
12732 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
12733 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
12734
12735 @item info proc all
12736 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
12737 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
12738
12739 @ignore
12740 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
12741 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
12742 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
12743 @kindex info proc times
12744 @item info proc times
12745 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
12746 its children.
12747
12748 @kindex info proc id
12749 @item info proc id
12750 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
12751 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
12752 @end ignore
12753
12754 @item set procfs-trace
12755 @kindex set procfs-trace
12756 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
12757 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
12758
12759 @item show procfs-trace
12760 @kindex show procfs-trace
12761 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
12762
12763 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
12764 @kindex set procfs-file
12765 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
12766 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
12767 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
12768 standard output.
12769
12770 @item show procfs-file
12771 @kindex show procfs-file
12772 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
12773
12774 @item proc-trace-entry
12775 @itemx proc-trace-exit
12776 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
12777 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
12778 @kindex proc-trace-entry
12779 @kindex proc-trace-exit
12780 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
12781 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
12782 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
12783 from the @code{syscall} interface.
12784
12785 @item info pidlist
12786 @kindex info pidlist
12787 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
12788 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
12789 processes and all the threads within each process.
12790
12791 @item info meminfo
12792 @kindex info meminfo
12793 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
12794 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
12795 @end table
12796
12797 @node DJGPP Native
12798 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
12799 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
12800 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
12801 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
12802
12803 @cindex DPMI
12804 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
12805 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
12806 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
12807 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
12808
12809 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
12810 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
12811 subsection describes those commands.
12812
12813 @table @code
12814 @kindex info dos
12815 @item info dos
12816 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
12817 information about the target system and important OS structures.
12818
12819 @kindex sysinfo
12820 @cindex MS-DOS system info
12821 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
12822 @item info dos sysinfo
12823 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
12824 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
12825 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
12826
12827 @cindex GDT
12828 @cindex LDT
12829 @cindex IDT
12830 @cindex segment descriptor tables
12831 @cindex descriptor tables display
12832 @item info dos gdt
12833 @itemx info dos ldt
12834 @itemx info dos idt
12835 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
12836 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
12837 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
12838 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
12839 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
12840 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
12841 rights.
12842
12843 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
12844 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
12845 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
12846 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
12847 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
12848
12849 @cindex garbled pointers
12850 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
12851 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
12852 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
12853 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
12854 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
12855 debugged program's data segment:
12856
12857 @smallexample
12858 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
12859 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
12860 @end smallexample
12861
12862 @noindent
12863 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
12864 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
12865
12866 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
12867 @item info dos pde
12868 @itemx info dos pte
12869 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
12870 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
12871 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
12872 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
12873 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
12874 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
12875 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
12876 that is currently in use.
12877
12878 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
12879 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
12880 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
12881 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
12882 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
12883 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
12884 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
12885
12886 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
12887 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
12888 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
12889 controller.
12890
12891 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
12892
12893 @cindex physical address from linear address
12894 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
12895 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
12896 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
12897 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
12898 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
12899 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
12900 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
12901
12902 @smallexample
12903 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
12904 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
12905 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
12906 @end smallexample
12907
12908 @noindent
12909 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
12910 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
12911 attributes of that page.
12912
12913 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
12914 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
12915 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
12916 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
12917 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
12918 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
12919
12920 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
12921 transfer buffer:
12922
12923 @smallexample
12924 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
12925 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
12926 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
12927 @end smallexample
12928
12929 @noindent
12930 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
12931 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
12932 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
12933 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
12934 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
12935
12936 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
12937 @end table
12938
12939 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
12940 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
12941 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
12942 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
12943
12944 @table @code
12945 @kindex set com1base
12946 @kindex set com1irq
12947 @kindex set com2base
12948 @kindex set com2irq
12949 @kindex set com3base
12950 @kindex set com3irq
12951 @kindex set com4base
12952 @kindex set com4irq
12953 @item set com1base @var{addr}
12954 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
12955 port.
12956
12957 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
12958 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
12959 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
12960
12961 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
12962 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
12963 other 3 COM ports.
12964
12965 @kindex show com1base
12966 @kindex show com1irq
12967 @kindex show com2base
12968 @kindex show com2irq
12969 @kindex show com3base
12970 @kindex show com3irq
12971 @kindex show com4base
12972 @kindex show com4irq
12973 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
12974 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
12975 lines used by the COM ports.
12976
12977 @item info serial
12978 @kindex info serial
12979 @cindex DOS serial port status
12980 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
12981 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
12982 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
12983 counts of various errors encountered so far.
12984 @end table
12985
12986
12987 @node Cygwin Native
12988 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
12989 @cindex MS Windows debugging
12990 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
12991 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
12992
12993 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
12994 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
12995 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
12996 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
12997 that have no debugging symbols.
12998
12999
13000 @table @code
13001 @kindex info w32
13002 @item info w32
13003 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13004 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13005
13006 @item info w32 selector
13007 This command displays information returned by
13008 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13009 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13010 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13011 Without argument, this command displays information
13012 about the the six segment registers.
13013
13014 @kindex info dll
13015 @item info dll
13016 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13017
13018 @kindex dll-symbols
13019 @item dll-symbols
13020 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13021 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13022
13023 @kindex set new-console
13024 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13025 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13026 be started in a new console on next start.
13027 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13028 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13029
13030 @kindex show new-console
13031 @item show new-console
13032 Displays whether a new console is used
13033 when the debuggee is started.
13034
13035 @kindex set new-group
13036 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13037 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13038 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13039 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13040 Ctrl-C.
13041
13042 @kindex show new-group
13043 @item show new-group
13044 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13045
13046 @kindex set debugevents
13047 @item set debugevents
13048 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
13049
13050 @kindex set debugexec
13051 @item set debugexec
13052 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13053 seen by the debugger.
13054
13055 @kindex set debugexceptions
13056 @item set debugexceptions
13057 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
13058 seen by the debugger.
13059
13060 @kindex set debugmemory
13061 @item set debugmemory
13062 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
13063 seen by the debugger.
13064
13065 @kindex set shell
13066 @item set shell
13067 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13068 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13069
13070 @kindex show shell
13071 @item show shell
13072 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13073
13074 @end table
13075
13076 @menu
13077 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13078 @end menu
13079
13080 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13081 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13082 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13083 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13084
13085 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13086 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13087 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13088 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13089 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13090 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13091 ``minimal symbols''.
13092
13093 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13094 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13095 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13096 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13097 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13098 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13099 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13100 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13101 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13102 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13103
13104 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13105
13106 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13107 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13108 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13109 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13110 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13111 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13112 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13113 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13114 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13115
13116 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13117 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13118 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13119 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13120 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13121 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13122
13123 @smallexample
13124 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13125 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13126
13127 Non-debugging symbols:
13128 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13129 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13130 @end smallexample
13131
13132 @smallexample
13133 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13134 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13135
13136 Non-debugging symbols:
13137 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13138 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13139 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13140 [etc...]
13141 @end smallexample
13142
13143 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13144
13145 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13146 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13147 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13148 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13149 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13150 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13151 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13152
13153 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13154 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13155 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13156 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13157 problem:
13158
13159 @smallexample
13160 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13161 $1 = 268572168
13162 @end smallexample
13163
13164 @smallexample
13165 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13166 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13167 @end smallexample
13168
13169 And two possible solutions:
13170
13171 @smallexample
13172 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13173 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13174 @end smallexample
13175
13176 @smallexample
13177 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13178 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13179 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13180 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13181 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13182 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13183 @end smallexample
13184
13185 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13186 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13187 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13188 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13189 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13190
13191 @smallexample
13192 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13193 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13194 @end smallexample
13195
13196 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13197 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13198 safe.
13199
13200 @node Hurd Native
13201 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13202 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13203
13204 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13205 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13206
13207 @table @code
13208 @item set signals
13209 @itemx set sigs
13210 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13211 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13212 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13213 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13214 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13215 @code{signals}.
13216
13217 @item show signals
13218 @itemx show sigs
13219 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13220 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13221 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13222
13223 @item set signal-thread
13224 @itemx set sigthread
13225 @kindex set signal-thread
13226 @kindex set sigthread
13227 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13228 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13229 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13230 signal-thread}.
13231
13232 @item show signal-thread
13233 @itemx show sigthread
13234 @kindex show signal-thread
13235 @kindex show sigthread
13236 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13237 delivered a signal.
13238
13239 @item set stopped
13240 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13241 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13242 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13243 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13244
13245 @item show stopped
13246 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13247 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13248 stopped.
13249
13250 @item set exceptions
13251 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13252 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13253 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13254 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13255 trapping on.
13256
13257 @item show exceptions
13258 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13259 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13260
13261 @item set task pause
13262 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13263 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13264 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13265 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13266 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13267 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13268 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13269 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13270 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13271
13272 @item show task pause
13273 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13274 Show the current state of task suspension.
13275
13276 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13277 @cindex task suspend count
13278 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13279 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13280 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13281
13282 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13283 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13284
13285 @item set task exception-port
13286 @itemx set task excp
13287 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13288 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13289 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13290 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13291
13292 @item set noninvasive
13293 @cindex noninvasive task options
13294 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13295 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13296 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13297 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13298
13299 @item info send-rights
13300 @itemx info receive-rights
13301 @itemx info port-rights
13302 @itemx info port-sets
13303 @itemx info dead-names
13304 @itemx info ports
13305 @itemx info psets
13306 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13307 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13308 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13309 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13310 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13311 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13312 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13313 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13314 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13315
13316 @item set thread pause
13317 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13318 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13319 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13320 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13321 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13322 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13323 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13324 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13325 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13326 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13327 only the current thread.
13328
13329 @item show thread pause
13330 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13331 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13332
13333 @item set thread run
13334 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13335
13336 @item show thread run
13337 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13338
13339 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13340 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13341 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13342 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13343 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13344 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13345 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13346
13347 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13348 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13349 detaching.
13350
13351 @item set thread exception-port
13352 @itemx set thread excp
13353 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13354 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13355 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
13356
13357 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
13358 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
13359 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
13360 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
13361
13362 @item set thread default
13363 @itemx show thread default
13364 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13365 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
13366 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
13367 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
13368 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
13369 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
13370 the non-default commands.
13371 @end table
13372
13373
13374 @node Neutrino
13375 @subsection QNX Neutrino
13376 @cindex QNX Neutrino
13377
13378 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
13379 Neutrino target:
13380
13381 @table @code
13382 @item set debug nto-debug
13383 @kindex set debug nto-debug
13384 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
13385 Neutrino support.
13386
13387 @item show debug nto-debug
13388 @kindex show debug nto-debug
13389 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
13390 @end table
13391
13392
13393 @node Embedded OS
13394 @section Embedded Operating Systems
13395
13396 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
13397 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
13398 architectures.
13399
13400 @menu
13401 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13402 @end menu
13403
13404 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
13405 various real-time operating systems.
13406
13407 @node VxWorks
13408 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13409
13410 @cindex VxWorks
13411
13412 @table @code
13413
13414 @kindex target vxworks
13415 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
13416 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
13417 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
13418
13419 @end table
13420
13421 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
13422 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
13423
13424 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
13425 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
13426 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
13427 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
13428 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
13429 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
13430 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
13431
13432 @table @code
13433 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
13434 @kindex vxworks-timeout
13435 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
13436 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
13437 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
13438 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
13439 of a thin network line.
13440 @end table
13441
13442 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
13443 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
13444 procedures.
13445
13446 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
13447 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
13448 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
13449 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
13450 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
13451 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
13452 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
13453 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
13454 manual.
13455 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
13456
13457 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
13458 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
13459 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
13460 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
13461
13462 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
13463
13464 @smallexample
13465 (vxgdb)
13466 @end smallexample
13467
13468 @menu
13469 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
13470 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
13471 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
13472 @end menu
13473
13474 @node VxWorks Connection
13475 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
13476
13477 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
13478 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
13479
13480 @smallexample
13481 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
13482 @end smallexample
13483
13484 @need 750
13485 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
13486
13487 @smallexample
13488 Attaching remote machine across net...
13489 Connected to tt.
13490 @end smallexample
13491
13492 @need 1000
13493 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
13494 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
13495 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
13496 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
13497 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
13498
13499 @smallexample
13500 prog.o: No such file or directory.
13501 @end smallexample
13502
13503 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
13504 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
13505 command again.
13506
13507 @node VxWorks Download
13508 @subsubsection VxWorks download
13509
13510 @cindex download to VxWorks
13511 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
13512 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
13513 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
13514 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
13515 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
13516 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
13517 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
13518 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
13519 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
13520 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
13521 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
13522 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
13523 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
13524 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
13525 program, type this on VxWorks:
13526
13527 @smallexample
13528 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
13529 @end smallexample
13530
13531 @noindent
13532 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
13533
13534 @smallexample
13535 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
13536 (vxgdb) load prog.o
13537 @end smallexample
13538
13539 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
13540
13541 @smallexample
13542 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
13543 @end smallexample
13544
13545 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
13546 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
13547 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
13548 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
13549 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
13550 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
13551 table.)
13552
13553 @node VxWorks Attach
13554 @subsubsection Running tasks
13555
13556 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
13557 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
13558 follows:
13559
13560 @smallexample
13561 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
13562 @end smallexample
13563
13564 @noindent
13565 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
13566 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
13567 the time of attachment.
13568
13569 @node Embedded Processors
13570 @section Embedded Processors
13571
13572 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
13573 configurations.
13574
13575 @cindex send command to simulator
13576 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
13577 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
13578
13579 @table @code
13580 @item sim @var{command}
13581 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
13582 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
13583 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
13584 acceptable commands.
13585 @end table
13586
13587
13588 @menu
13589 * ARM:: ARM RDI
13590 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
13591 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
13592 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
13593 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
13594 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
13595 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
13596 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
13597 * PowerPC: PowerPC
13598 * SH:: Renesas SH
13599 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
13600 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
13601 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
13602 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
13603 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
13604 * CRIS:: CRIS
13605 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
13606 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
13607 @end menu
13608
13609 @node ARM
13610 @subsection ARM
13611 @cindex ARM RDI
13612
13613 @table @code
13614 @kindex target rdi
13615 @item target rdi @var{dev}
13616 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
13617 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
13618 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
13619
13620 @kindex target rdp
13621 @item target rdp @var{dev}
13622 ARM Demon monitor.
13623
13624 @end table
13625
13626 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
13627
13628 @table @code
13629 @item set arm disassembler
13630 @kindex set arm
13631 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
13632 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
13633
13634 @item show arm disassembler
13635 @kindex show arm
13636 Show the current disassembly style.
13637
13638 @item set arm apcs32
13639 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
13640 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
13641
13642 @item show arm apcs32
13643 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
13644
13645 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
13646 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
13647 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
13648
13649 @table @code
13650 @item auto
13651 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
13652 @item softfpa
13653 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
13654 processors.
13655 @item fpa
13656 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
13657 @item softvfp
13658 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
13659 @item vfp
13660 VFP co-processor.
13661 @end table
13662
13663 @item show arm fpu
13664 Show the current type of the FPU.
13665
13666 @item set arm abi
13667 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
13668
13669 @item show arm abi
13670 Show the currently used ABI.
13671
13672 @item set debug arm
13673 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
13674 target support subsystem.
13675
13676 @item show debug arm
13677 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
13678 @end table
13679
13680 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
13681 using the RDI interface:
13682
13683 @table @code
13684 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
13685 @kindex rdilogfile
13686 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
13687 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
13688 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
13689 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
13690 @file{rdi.log}.
13691
13692 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
13693 @kindex rdilogenable
13694 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
13695 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
13696 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
13697 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
13698 are logged to a file.
13699
13700 @item set rdiromatzero
13701 @kindex set rdiromatzero
13702 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
13703 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
13704 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
13705 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
13706 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
13707
13708 @item show rdiromatzero
13709 @kindex show rdiromatzero
13710 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
13711
13712 @item set rdiheartbeat
13713 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
13714 @cindex RDI heartbeat
13715 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
13716 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
13717 well as the Angel monitor.
13718
13719 @item show rdiheartbeat
13720 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
13721 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
13722 @end table
13723
13724
13725 @node H8/300
13726 @subsection Renesas H8/300
13727
13728 @table @code
13729
13730 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
13731 @item target hms @var{dev}
13732 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
13733 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
13734 line and the communications speed used.
13735
13736 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
13737 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
13738 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
13739
13740 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
13741 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
13742 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
13743 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
13744 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
13745
13746 @end table
13747
13748 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
13749 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
13750 @cindex download to Renesas SH
13751 @cindex Renesas SH download
13752 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
13753 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
13754 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
13755 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
13756
13757 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
13758 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
13759
13760 @enumerate
13761 @item
13762 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
13763 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
13764 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
13765 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
13766 H8/300, or H8/500.)
13767
13768 @item
13769 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
13770 serial device available on your host is the default).
13771
13772 @item
13773 what speed to use over the serial device.
13774 @end enumerate
13775
13776 @menu
13777 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
13778 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
13779 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
13780 @end menu
13781
13782 @node Renesas Boards
13783 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
13784
13785 @c only for Unix hosts
13786 @kindex device
13787 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
13788 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
13789 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
13790 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
13791 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
13792
13793 @kindex speed
13794 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
13795 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
13796 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
13797 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
13798 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
13799 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
13800
13801 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
13802 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
13803 use a DOS host,
13804 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
13805 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
13806 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
13807 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
13808
13809 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
13810 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
13811 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
13812 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
13813
13814 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
13815 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
13816 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
13817 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
13818 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
13819 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
13820 @code{COM2}.
13821
13822 @smallexample
13823 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
13824 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
13825
13826 Resident portion of MODE loaded
13827
13828 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
13829
13830 @end smallexample
13831
13832 @quotation
13833 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
13834 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
13835 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
13836 your development board.
13837 @end quotation
13838
13839 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
13840 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
13841 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
13842 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
13843 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
13844 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
13845 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
13846 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
13847 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
13848 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
13849 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
13850 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
13851 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
13852
13853 @smallexample
13854 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
13855 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
13856 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
13857 the conditions.
13858 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
13859 for details.
13860 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
13861 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
13862 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
13863 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
13864 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
13865 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
13866 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
13867 @end smallexample
13868
13869 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
13870 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
13871 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
13872 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
13873 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
13874 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
13875
13876 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
13877 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
13878 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
13879
13880 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
13881 @itemize @bullet
13882 @item
13883 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
13884 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
13885
13886 @item
13887 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
13888 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
13889 to detect program completion.
13890 @end itemize
13891
13892 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
13893 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
13894
13895 @node Renesas ICE
13896 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
13897
13898 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
13899 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
13900 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
13901 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
13902
13903 @table @code
13904 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
13905 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
13906 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
13907 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
13908 (for example, @samp{9600}).
13909
13910 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
13911 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
13912 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
13913 @end table
13914
13915 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
13916 Renesas E7000 ICE:
13917
13918 @table @code
13919 @item e7000 @var{command}
13920 @kindex e7000
13921 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
13922 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
13923
13924 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
13925 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
13926 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
13927 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
13928 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
13929 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
13930
13931 @item ftpload @var{file}
13932 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
13933 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
13934 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
13935
13936 @item drain
13937 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
13938 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
13939
13940 @item set usehardbreakpoints
13941 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
13942 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
13943 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
13944 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
13945 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
13946 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
13947 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
13948 @end table
13949
13950 @node Renesas Special
13951 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
13952
13953 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
13954
13955 @table @code
13956
13957 @kindex set machine
13958 @kindex show machine
13959 @item set machine h8300
13960 @itemx set machine h8300h
13961 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
13962 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
13963 to check which variant is currently in effect.
13964
13965 @end table
13966
13967 @node H8/500
13968 @subsection H8/500
13969
13970 @table @code
13971
13972 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
13973 @cindex memory models, H8/500
13974 @item set memory @var{mod}
13975 @itemx show memory
13976 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
13977 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
13978 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
13979 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
13980
13981 @end table
13982
13983 @node M32R/D
13984 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
13985
13986 @table @code
13987 @kindex target m32r
13988 @item target m32r @var{dev}
13989 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
13990
13991 @kindex target m32rsdi
13992 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
13993 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
13994 @end table
13995
13996 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
13997
13998 @table @code
13999 @item set download-path @var{path}
14000 @kindex set download-path
14001 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14002 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14003
14004 @item show download-path
14005 @kindex show download-path
14006 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14007
14008 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14009 @kindex set board-address
14010 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14011 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14012
14013 @item show board-address
14014 @kindex show board-address
14015 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14016
14017 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14018 @kindex set server-address
14019 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14020 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14021 host machine.
14022
14023 @item show server-address
14024 @kindex show server-address
14025 Display the IP address of the download server.
14026
14027 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14028 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14029 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14030 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14031 executable file is uploaded.
14032
14033 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14034 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14035 Test the @code{upload} command.
14036 @end table
14037
14038 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14039
14040 @table @code
14041 @item sdireset
14042 @kindex sdireset
14043 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14044 This command resets the SDI connection.
14045
14046 @item sdistatus
14047 @kindex sdistatus
14048 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14049
14050 @item debug_chaos
14051 @kindex debug_chaos
14052 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14053 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14054
14055 @item use_debug_dma
14056 @kindex use_debug_dma
14057 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14058
14059 @item use_mon_code
14060 @kindex use_mon_code
14061 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14062
14063 @item use_ib_break
14064 @kindex use_ib_break
14065 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14066
14067 @item use_dbt_break
14068 @kindex use_dbt_break
14069 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14070 @end table
14071
14072 @node M68K
14073 @subsection M68k
14074
14075 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14076 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14077
14078 @table @code
14079
14080 @kindex target abug
14081 @item target abug @var{dev}
14082 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14083
14084 @kindex target cpu32bug
14085 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14086 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14087
14088 @kindex target dbug
14089 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14090 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14091
14092 @kindex target est
14093 @item target est @var{dev}
14094 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14095
14096 @kindex target rom68k
14097 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14098 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14099
14100 @end table
14101
14102 @table @code
14103
14104 @kindex target rombug
14105 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14106 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14107
14108 @end table
14109
14110 @node MIPS Embedded
14111 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14112
14113 @cindex MIPS boards
14114 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14115 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14116 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14117
14118 @need 1000
14119 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14120
14121 @table @code
14122 @item target mips @var{port}
14123 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14124 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14125 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14126 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14127 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14128 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14129 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14130
14131 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14132 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14133 debugger:
14134
14135 @smallexample
14136 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14137 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14138 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14139 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14140 (@value{GDBP}) run
14141 @end smallexample
14142
14143 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14144 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14145 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14146 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14147 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14148
14149 @item target pmon @var{port}
14150 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14151 PMON ROM monitor.
14152
14153 @item target ddb @var{port}
14154 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14155 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14156
14157 @item target lsi @var{port}
14158 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14159 LSI variant of PMON.
14160
14161 @kindex target r3900
14162 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14163 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14164
14165 @kindex target array
14166 @item target array @var{dev}
14167 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14168
14169 @end table
14170
14171
14172 @noindent
14173 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14174
14175 @table @code
14176 @item set mipsfpu double
14177 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14178 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14179 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14180 @itemx show mipsfpu
14181 @kindex set mipsfpu
14182 @kindex show mipsfpu
14183 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14184 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14185 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14186 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14187 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14188 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14189 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14190 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14191 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14192 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14193 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14194 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14195 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14196
14197 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14198 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14199 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14200
14201 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14202 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14203
14204 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14205 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14206 @itemx show timeout
14207 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14208 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14209 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14210 @kindex set timeout
14211 @kindex show timeout
14212 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14213 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14214 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14215 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14216 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14217 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14218 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14219 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14220 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14221 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14222
14223 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14224 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14225 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14226 to run before stopping.
14227
14228 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14229 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14230 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14231 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14232 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14233 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14234
14235 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14236 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14237 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14238 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14239
14240 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14241 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14242 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14243 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14244 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14245 @table @asis
14246 @item pmon target
14247 @samp{PMON}
14248 @item ddb target
14249 @samp{NEC010}
14250 @item lsi target
14251 @samp{PMON>}
14252 @end table
14253
14254 @item show monitor-prompt
14255 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14256 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14257 remote monitor.
14258
14259 @item set monitor-warnings
14260 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14261 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14262 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14263 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14264 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14265
14266 @item show monitor-warnings
14267 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14268 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14269
14270 @item pmon @var{command}
14271 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14272 @cindex send PMON command
14273 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14274 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14275 @end table
14276
14277 @node OpenRISC 1000
14278 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14279 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14280
14281 @cindex or1k boards
14282 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14283 about platform and commands.
14284
14285 @table @code
14286
14287 @kindex target jtag
14288 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14289
14290 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14291 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14292 connected via parallel port to the board.
14293
14294 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14295
14296 @kindex or1ksim
14297 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14298 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14299 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14300
14301 @kindex info or1k spr
14302 @item info or1k spr
14303 Displays spr groups.
14304
14305 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14306 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14307 Displays register names in selected group.
14308
14309 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14310 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14311 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14312 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14313 Shows information about specified spr register.
14314
14315 @kindex spr
14316 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14317 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14318 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14319 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14320 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14321 @end table
14322
14323 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14324 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14325 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14326 triggers can be set using:
14327 @table @code
14328 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14329 Load effective address/data
14330 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14331 Store effective address/data
14332 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14333 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14334 @item $FETCH
14335 Fetch data
14336 @end table
14337
14338 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14339 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14340
14341 @code{htrace} commands:
14342 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14343 @table @code
14344 @kindex hwatch
14345 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14346 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
14347 or Data. For example:
14348
14349 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14350
14351 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14352
14353 @kindex htrace
14354 @item htrace info
14355 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14356
14357 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14358 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14359
14360 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14361 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14362
14363 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14364 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14365
14366 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14367 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14368 triggered.
14369
14370 @item htrace enable
14371 @itemx htrace disable
14372 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14373
14374 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14375 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14376
14377 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14378 will be written there.
14379
14380 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14381 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14382
14383 @item htrace mode continuous
14384 Set continuous trace mode.
14385
14386 @item htrace mode suspend
14387 Set suspend trace mode.
14388
14389 @end table
14390
14391 @node PowerPC
14392 @subsection PowerPC
14393
14394 @table @code
14395 @kindex target dink32
14396 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14397 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14398
14399 @kindex target ppcbug
14400 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14401 @kindex target ppcbug1
14402 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14403 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14404
14405 @kindex target sds
14406 @item target sds @var{dev}
14407 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14408 @end table
14409
14410 @cindex SDS protocol
14411 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
14412 by@value{GDBN}:
14413
14414 @table @code
14415 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14416 @kindex set sdstimeout
14417 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14418 default is 2 seconds.
14419
14420 @item show sdstimeout
14421 @kindex show sdstimeout
14422 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
14423
14424 @item sds @var{command}
14425 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
14426 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
14427 @end table
14428
14429
14430 @node PA
14431 @subsection HP PA Embedded
14432
14433 @table @code
14434
14435 @kindex target op50n
14436 @item target op50n @var{dev}
14437 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
14438
14439 @kindex target w89k
14440 @item target w89k @var{dev}
14441 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
14442
14443 @end table
14444
14445 @node SH
14446 @subsection Renesas SH
14447
14448 @table @code
14449
14450 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
14451 @item target hms @var{dev}
14452 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
14453 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
14454 the communications speed used.
14455
14456 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
14457 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14458 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
14459
14460 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
14461 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
14462 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14463 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
14464 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14465
14466 @end table
14467
14468 @node Sparclet
14469 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
14470
14471 @cindex Sparclet
14472
14473 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
14474 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
14475 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14476 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
14477 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
14478
14479 @table @code
14480 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
14481 @kindex remotetimeout
14482 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
14483 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14484 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
14485 @end table
14486
14487 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
14488 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
14489 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
14490 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
14491 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
14492
14493 @smallexample
14494 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
14495 @end smallexample
14496
14497 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
14498
14499 @smallexample
14500 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
14501 @end smallexample
14502
14503 @cindex running, on Sparclet
14504 Once you have set
14505 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14506 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
14507 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
14508
14509 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14510
14511 @smallexample
14512 (gdbslet)
14513 @end smallexample
14514
14515 @menu
14516 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
14517 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
14518 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
14519 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
14520 @end menu
14521
14522 @node Sparclet File
14523 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
14524
14525 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
14526
14527 @smallexample
14528 (gdbslet) file prog
14529 @end smallexample
14530
14531 @need 1000
14532 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
14533 @value{GDBN} locates
14534 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
14535 path.
14536 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
14537 files will be searched as well.
14538 @value{GDBN} locates
14539 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
14540 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
14541 If it fails
14542 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
14543
14544 @smallexample
14545 prog: No such file or directory.
14546 @end smallexample
14547
14548 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
14549 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
14550 @code{target} command again.
14551
14552 @node Sparclet Connection
14553 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
14554
14555 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
14556 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
14557
14558 @smallexample
14559 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
14560 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
14561 main () at ../prog.c:3
14562 @end smallexample
14563
14564 @need 750
14565 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14566
14567 @smallexample
14568 Connected to ttya.
14569 @end smallexample
14570
14571 @node Sparclet Download
14572 @subsubsection Sparclet download
14573
14574 @cindex download to Sparclet
14575 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
14576 you can use the @value{GDBN}
14577 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
14578 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
14579 command.
14580 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
14581 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
14582 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
14583 of each of the file's sections.
14584 For instance, if the program
14585 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
14586 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14587
14588 @smallexample
14589 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
14590 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
14591 @end smallexample
14592
14593 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
14594 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
14595 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
14596
14597 @node Sparclet Execution
14598 @subsubsection Running and debugging
14599
14600 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
14601 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
14602 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
14603 manual for the list of commands.
14604
14605 @smallexample
14606 (gdbslet) b main
14607 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
14608 (gdbslet) run
14609 Starting program: prog
14610 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
14611 3 char *symarg = 0;
14612 (gdbslet) step
14613 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
14614 (gdbslet)
14615 @end smallexample
14616
14617 @node Sparclite
14618 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
14619
14620 @table @code
14621
14622 @kindex target sparclite
14623 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
14624 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
14625 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
14626 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
14627 remote protocol.
14628
14629 @end table
14630
14631 @node ST2000
14632 @subsection Tandem ST2000
14633
14634 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
14635 STDBUG protocol.
14636
14637 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
14638 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
14639
14640 @smallexample
14641 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
14642 @end smallexample
14643
14644 @noindent
14645 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
14646 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
14647 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
14648 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
14649 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14650
14651 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
14652 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
14653 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
14654 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
14655 available on your host computer.
14656 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
14657 @c basically hearsay.
14658
14659 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
14660 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
14661 environment:
14662
14663 @table @code
14664 @item st2000 @var{command}
14665 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
14666 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
14667 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
14668 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
14669 manual for available commands.
14670
14671 @item connect
14672 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
14673 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
14674 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
14675 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
14676 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
14677 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
14678 @end table
14679
14680 @node Z8000
14681 @subsection Zilog Z8000
14682
14683 @cindex Z8000
14684 @cindex simulator, Z8000
14685 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
14686
14687 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
14688 a Z8000 simulator.
14689
14690 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
14691 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
14692 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
14693 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
14694
14695 @table @code
14696 @item target sim @var{args}
14697 @kindex sim
14698 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
14699 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
14700 options, specify them via @var{args}.
14701 @end table
14702
14703 @noindent
14704 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
14705 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
14706 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
14707 to run your program, and so on.
14708
14709 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
14710 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
14711 additional items of information as specially named registers:
14712
14713 @table @code
14714
14715 @item cycles
14716 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
14717
14718 @item insts
14719 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
14720
14721 @item time
14722 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
14723
14724 @end table
14725
14726 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
14727 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
14728 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
14729 simulated clock ticks.
14730
14731 @node AVR
14732 @subsection Atmel AVR
14733 @cindex AVR
14734
14735 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
14736 following AVR-specific commands:
14737
14738 @table @code
14739 @item info io_registers
14740 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
14741 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
14742 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
14743 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
14744 @end table
14745
14746 @node CRIS
14747 @subsection CRIS
14748 @cindex CRIS
14749
14750 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
14751 following CRIS-specific commands:
14752
14753 @table @code
14754 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
14755 @cindex CRIS version
14756 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
14757 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
14758 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
14759
14760 @item show cris-version
14761 Show the current CRIS version.
14762
14763 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
14764 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
14765 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
14766 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
14767 @code{R59}.
14768
14769 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
14770 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
14771
14772 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
14773 @cindex CRIS mode
14774 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
14775 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
14776 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
14777
14778 @item show cris-mode
14779 Show the current CRIS mode.
14780 @end table
14781
14782 @node Super-H
14783 @subsection Renesas Super-H
14784 @cindex Super-H
14785
14786 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
14787 commands:
14788
14789 @table @code
14790 @item regs
14791 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
14792 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
14793 @end table
14794
14795 @node WinCE
14796 @subsection Windows CE
14797 @cindex Windows CE
14798
14799 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
14800
14801 @table @code
14802 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
14803 @kindex set remotedirectory
14804 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
14805 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
14806 drive.
14807
14808 @item show remotedirectory
14809 @kindex show remotedirectory
14810 Show the current value of the upload directory.
14811
14812 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
14813 @kindex set remoteupload
14814 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
14815 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
14816 The default is @samp{newer}.
14817
14818 @item show remoteupload
14819 @kindex show remoteupload
14820 Show the current setting of the upload method.
14821
14822 @item set remoteaddhost
14823 @kindex set remoteaddhost
14824 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
14825 arguments when you debug over a network.
14826
14827 @item show remoteaddhost
14828 @kindex show remoteaddhost
14829 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
14830 debugging over a network.
14831 @end table
14832
14833
14834 @node Architectures
14835 @section Architectures
14836
14837 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
14838 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
14839
14840 @menu
14841 * i386::
14842 * A29K::
14843 * Alpha::
14844 * MIPS::
14845 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
14846 @end menu
14847
14848 @node i386
14849 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
14850
14851 @table @code
14852 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
14853 @kindex set struct-convention
14854 @cindex struct return convention
14855 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
14856 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
14857 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
14858 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
14859 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
14860 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
14861 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
14862 be returned in a register.
14863
14864 @item show struct-convention
14865 @kindex show struct-convention
14866 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
14867 from functions.
14868 @end table
14869
14870 @node A29K
14871 @subsection A29K
14872
14873 @table @code
14874
14875 @kindex set rstack_high_address
14876 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
14877 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
14878 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
14879 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
14880 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
14881 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
14882 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
14883 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
14884 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
14885 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
14886 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
14887 hexadecimal.
14888
14889 @kindex show rstack_high_address
14890 @item show rstack_high_address
14891 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
14892 processors.
14893
14894 @end table
14895
14896 @node Alpha
14897 @subsection Alpha
14898
14899 See the following section.
14900
14901 @node MIPS
14902 @subsection MIPS
14903
14904 @cindex stack on Alpha
14905 @cindex stack on MIPS
14906 @cindex Alpha stack
14907 @cindex MIPS stack
14908 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
14909 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
14910 find the beginning of a function.
14911
14912 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
14913 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
14914 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
14915 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
14916 commands:
14917
14918 @table @code
14919 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
14920 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
14921 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
14922 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
14923 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
14924 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
14925 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
14926 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
14927
14928 @item show heuristic-fence-post
14929 Display the current limit.
14930 @end table
14931
14932 @noindent
14933 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
14934 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
14935
14936 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
14937 programs:
14938
14939 @table @code
14940 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
14941 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
14942 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
14943 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
14944 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
14945
14946 @table @samp
14947 @item 32
14948 32-bit GP registers
14949 @item 64
14950 64-bit GP registers
14951 @item auto
14952 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
14953 information contained in the executable. This is the default
14954 @end table
14955
14956 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
14957 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
14958 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
14959
14960 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
14961 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
14962 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
14963 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
14964 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
14965 (the default).
14966
14967 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
14968 @kindex set mips abi
14969 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
14970 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
14971 values of @var{arg} are:
14972
14973 @table @samp
14974 @item auto
14975 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
14976 default).
14977 @item o32
14978 @item o64
14979 @item n32
14980 @item n64
14981 @item eabi32
14982 @item eabi64
14983 @item auto
14984 @end table
14985
14986 @item show mips abi
14987 @kindex show mips abi
14988 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
14989
14990 @item set mipsfpu
14991 @itemx show mipsfpu
14992 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
14993
14994 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
14995 @kindex set mips mask-address
14996 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
14997 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
14998 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
14999 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15000 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15001
15002 @item show mips mask-address
15003 @kindex show mips mask-address
15004 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15005 not.
15006
15007 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15008 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15009 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15010 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15011 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15012 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15013
15014 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15015 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15016 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15017
15018 @item set debug mips
15019 @kindex set debug mips
15020 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15021 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15022
15023 @item show debug mips
15024 @kindex show debug mips
15025 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15026 @end table
15027
15028
15029 @node HPPA
15030 @subsection HPPA
15031 @cindex HPPA support
15032
15033 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15034 following special commands:
15035
15036 @table @code
15037 @item set debug hppa
15038 @kindex set debug hppa
15039 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15040 messages are to be displayed.
15041
15042 @item show debug hppa
15043 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15044
15045 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15046 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15047 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15048 given @var{address}.
15049
15050 @end table
15051
15052
15053 @node Controlling GDB
15054 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15055
15056 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15057 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15058 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15059 described here.
15060
15061 @menu
15062 * Prompt:: Prompt
15063 * Editing:: Command editing
15064 * Command History:: Command history
15065 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15066 * Numbers:: Numbers
15067 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15068 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15069 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15070 @end menu
15071
15072 @node Prompt
15073 @section Prompt
15074
15075 @cindex prompt
15076
15077 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15078 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15079 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15080 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15081 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15082 which one you are talking to.
15083
15084 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15085 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15086 or a prompt that does not.
15087
15088 @table @code
15089 @kindex set prompt
15090 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15091 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15092
15093 @kindex show prompt
15094 @item show prompt
15095 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15096 @end table
15097
15098 @node Editing
15099 @section Command editing
15100 @cindex readline
15101 @cindex command line editing
15102
15103 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15104 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15105 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15106 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15107 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15108 debugging sessions.
15109
15110 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15111 command @code{set}.
15112
15113 @table @code
15114 @kindex set editing
15115 @cindex editing
15116 @item set editing
15117 @itemx set editing on
15118 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15119
15120 @item set editing off
15121 Disable command line editing.
15122
15123 @kindex show editing
15124 @item show editing
15125 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15126 @end table
15127
15128 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15129 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15130 encouraged to read that chapter.
15131
15132 @node Command History
15133 @section Command history
15134 @cindex command history
15135
15136 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15137 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15138 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15139 history facility.
15140
15141 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15142 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15143 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15144
15145 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15146 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15147 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15148 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15149 pressed on a line by itself.
15150
15151 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15152 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15153 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15154 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15155
15156 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15157 history.
15158
15159 @table @code
15160 @cindex history substitution
15161 @cindex history file
15162 @kindex set history filename
15163 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15164 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15165 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15166 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15167 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15168 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15169 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15170 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15171 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15172 is not set.
15173
15174 @cindex save command history
15175 @kindex set history save
15176 @item set history save
15177 @itemx set history save on
15178 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15179 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15180
15181 @item set history save off
15182 Stop recording command history in a file.
15183
15184 @cindex history size
15185 @kindex set history size
15186 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15187 @item set history size @var{size}
15188 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15189 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15190 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15191 @end table
15192
15193 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15194 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15195
15196 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15197 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15198 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15199 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15200 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15201 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15202 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15203 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15204
15205 The commands to control history expansion are:
15206
15207 @table @code
15208 @item set history expansion on
15209 @itemx set history expansion
15210 @kindex set history expansion
15211 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15212
15213 @item set history expansion off
15214 Disable history expansion.
15215
15216 @c @group
15217 @kindex show history
15218 @item show history
15219 @itemx show history filename
15220 @itemx show history save
15221 @itemx show history size
15222 @itemx show history expansion
15223 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15224 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15225 @c @end group
15226 @end table
15227
15228 @table @code
15229 @kindex show commands
15230 @cindex show last commands
15231 @cindex display command history
15232 @item show commands
15233 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15234
15235 @item show commands @var{n}
15236 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15237
15238 @item show commands +
15239 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15240 @end table
15241
15242 @node Screen Size
15243 @section Screen size
15244 @cindex size of screen
15245 @cindex pauses in output
15246
15247 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15248 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15249 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15250 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15251 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15252 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15253 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15254 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15255
15256 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15257 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15258 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15259 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15260 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15261 width} commands:
15262
15263 @table @code
15264 @kindex set height
15265 @kindex set width
15266 @kindex show width
15267 @kindex show height
15268 @item set height @var{lpp}
15269 @itemx show height
15270 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15271 @itemx show width
15272 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15273 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15274 commands display the current settings.
15275
15276 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15277 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15278 file or to an editor buffer.
15279
15280 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15281 from wrapping its output.
15282
15283 @item set pagination on
15284 @itemx set pagination off
15285 @kindex set pagination
15286 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15287 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15288
15289 @item show pagination
15290 @kindex show pagination
15291 Show the current pagination mode.
15292 @end table
15293
15294 @node Numbers
15295 @section Numbers
15296 @cindex number representation
15297 @cindex entering numbers
15298
15299 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15300 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15301 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15302 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15303 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15304 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15305 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15306 both input and output with the commands described below.
15307
15308 @table @code
15309 @kindex set input-radix
15310 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15311 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15312 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15313 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15314 example, any of
15315
15316 @smallexample
15317 set input-radix 012
15318 set input-radix 10.
15319 set input-radix 0xa
15320 @end smallexample
15321
15322 @noindent
15323 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15324 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15325 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15326 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15327 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15328 change the radix.
15329
15330 @kindex set output-radix
15331 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15332 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15333 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15334 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15335
15336 @kindex show input-radix
15337 @item show input-radix
15338 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15339
15340 @kindex show output-radix
15341 @item show output-radix
15342 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15343
15344 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15345 @itemx show radix
15346 @kindex set radix
15347 @kindex show radix
15348 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15349 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15350 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15351 default value of 10.
15352
15353 @end table
15354
15355 @node ABI
15356 @section Configuring the current ABI
15357
15358 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15359 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15360 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15361 current ABI.
15362
15363 @cindex OS ABI
15364 @kindex set osabi
15365 @kindex show osabi
15366
15367 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15368 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15369 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15370 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15371 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15372 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15373 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15374 platform provides.
15375
15376 @table @code
15377 @item show osabi
15378 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15379
15380 @item set osabi
15381 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15382
15383 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15384 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15385 @end table
15386
15387 @cindex float promotion
15388
15389 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15390 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15391 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15392 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15393 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15394 @code{double} and then passed.
15395
15396 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15397 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15398 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15399
15400 @table @code
15401 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15402 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15403 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15404 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15405 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15406
15407 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15408 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15409 functions.
15410
15411 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15412 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15413 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15414 @end table
15415
15416 @kindex set cp-abi
15417 @kindex show cp-abi
15418 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15419 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15420 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15421 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15422 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15423 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15424 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15425 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15426 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15427 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15428 ``auto''.
15429
15430 @table @code
15431 @item show cp-abi
15432 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15433
15434 @item set cp-abi
15435 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15436
15437 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15438 @itemx set cp-abi auto
15439 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15440 @end table
15441
15442 @node Messages/Warnings
15443 @section Optional warnings and messages
15444
15445 @cindex verbose operation
15446 @cindex optional warnings
15447 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15448 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15449 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15450 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15451
15452 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15453 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15454 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
15455
15456 @table @code
15457 @kindex set verbose
15458 @item set verbose on
15459 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15460
15461 @item set verbose off
15462 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15463
15464 @kindex show verbose
15465 @item show verbose
15466 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15467 @end table
15468
15469 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15470 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15471 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
15472 symbol files}).
15473
15474 @table @code
15475
15476 @kindex set complaints
15477 @item set complaints @var{limit}
15478 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
15479 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
15480 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
15481 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
15482
15483 @kindex show complaints
15484 @item show complaints
15485 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
15486
15487 @end table
15488
15489 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
15490 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
15491 you try to run a program which is already running:
15492
15493 @smallexample
15494 (@value{GDBP}) run
15495 The program being debugged has been started already.
15496 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
15497 @end smallexample
15498
15499 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
15500 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
15501
15502 @table @code
15503
15504 @kindex set confirm
15505 @cindex flinching
15506 @cindex confirmation
15507 @cindex stupid questions
15508 @item set confirm off
15509 Disables confirmation requests.
15510
15511 @item set confirm on
15512 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
15513
15514 @kindex show confirm
15515 @item show confirm
15516 Displays state of confirmation requests.
15517
15518 @end table
15519
15520 @node Debugging Output
15521 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
15522 @cindex optional debugging messages
15523
15524 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
15525 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
15526 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
15527 section documents those commands.
15528
15529 @table @code
15530 @kindex set exec-done-display
15531 @item set exec-done-display
15532 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
15533 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
15534 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
15535 @kindex show exec-done-display
15536 @item show exec-done-display
15537 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
15538 notification.
15539 @kindex set debug
15540 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
15541 @cindex architecture debugging info
15542 @item set debug arch
15543 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
15544 @kindex show debug
15545 @item show debug arch
15546 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
15547 @item set debug aix-thread
15548 @cindex AIX threads
15549 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
15550 module.
15551 @item show debug aix-thread
15552 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
15553 @item set debug event
15554 @cindex event debugging info
15555 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
15556 default is off.
15557 @item show debug event
15558 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
15559 info.
15560 @item set debug expression
15561 @cindex expression debugging info
15562 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
15563 expression parsing. The default is off.
15564 @item show debug expression
15565 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
15566 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
15567 @item set debug frame
15568 @cindex frame debugging info
15569 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
15570 default is off.
15571 @item show debug frame
15572 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
15573 info.
15574 @item set debug infrun
15575 @cindex inferior debugging info
15576 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
15577 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
15578 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
15579 @item show debug infrun
15580 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
15581 @item set debug lin-lwp
15582 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
15583 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
15584 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
15585 @item show debug lin-lwp
15586 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
15587 @item set debug observer
15588 @cindex observer debugging info
15589 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
15590 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
15591 @item show debug observer
15592 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
15593 @item set debug overload
15594 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
15595 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
15596 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
15597 is off.
15598 @item show debug overload
15599 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
15600 debugging info.
15601 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
15602 @cindex serial connections, debugging
15603 @item set debug remote
15604 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
15605 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
15606 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
15607 @item show debug remote
15608 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
15609 @item set debug serial
15610 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
15611 default is off.
15612 @item show debug serial
15613 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
15614 info.
15615 @item set debug solib-frv
15616 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
15617 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
15618 @item show debug solib-frv
15619 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
15620 messages.
15621 @item set debug target
15622 @cindex target debugging info
15623 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
15624 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
15625 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
15626 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
15627 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
15628 @item show debug target
15629 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
15630 info.
15631 @item set debugvarobj
15632 @cindex variable object debugging info
15633 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
15634 info. The default is off.
15635 @item show debugvarobj
15636 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
15637 debugging info.
15638 @end table
15639
15640 @node Sequences
15641 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
15642
15643 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
15644 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
15645 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
15646 files.
15647
15648 @menu
15649 * Define:: User-defined commands
15650 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
15651 * Command Files:: Command files
15652 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
15653 @end menu
15654
15655 @node Define
15656 @section User-defined commands
15657
15658 @cindex user-defined command
15659 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
15660 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
15661 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
15662 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
15663 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
15664
15665 @smallexample
15666 define adder
15667 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
15668 @end smallexample
15669
15670 @noindent
15671 To execute the command use:
15672
15673 @smallexample
15674 adder 1 2 3
15675 @end smallexample
15676
15677 @noindent
15678 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
15679 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
15680 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
15681 functions calls.
15682
15683 @table @code
15684
15685 @kindex define
15686 @item define @var{commandname}
15687 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
15688 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
15689
15690 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
15691 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
15692 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
15693
15694 @kindex if
15695 @kindex else
15696 @item if
15697 @itemx else
15698 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
15699 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
15700 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
15701 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
15702 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
15703 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
15704
15705 @kindex while
15706 @item while
15707 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
15708 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
15709 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
15710 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
15711 evaluates to true.
15712
15713 @kindex document
15714 @item document @var{commandname}
15715 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
15716 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
15717 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
15718 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
15719 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
15720 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
15721
15722 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
15723 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
15724 does not change the documentation.
15725
15726 @kindex dont-repeat
15727 @cindex don't repeat command
15728 @item dont-repeat
15729 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
15730 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
15731 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
15732
15733 @kindex help user-defined
15734 @item help user-defined
15735 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
15736 (if any) for each.
15737
15738 @kindex show user
15739 @item show user
15740 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
15741 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
15742 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
15743 definitions for all user-defined commands.
15744
15745 @cindex infinite recusrion in user-defined commands
15746 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
15747 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
15748 @item show max-user-call-depth
15749 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
15750 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
15751 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
15752 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
15753
15754 @end table
15755
15756 When user-defined commands are executed, the
15757 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
15758 stops execution of the user-defined command.
15759
15760 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
15761 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
15762 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
15763 messages when used in a user-defined command.
15764
15765 @node Hooks
15766 @section User-defined command hooks
15767 @cindex command hooks
15768 @cindex hooks, for commands
15769 @cindex hooks, pre-command
15770
15771 @kindex hook
15772 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
15773 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
15774 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
15775 before that command.
15776
15777 @cindex hooks, post-command
15778 @kindex hookpost
15779 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
15780 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
15781 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
15782 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
15783 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
15784
15785 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
15786 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
15787
15788 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
15789 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
15790
15791 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
15792 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
15793 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
15794 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
15795 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
15796
15797 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
15798 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
15799 you could define:
15800
15801 @smallexample
15802 define hook-stop
15803 handle SIGALRM nopass
15804 end
15805
15806 define hook-run
15807 handle SIGALRM pass
15808 end
15809
15810 define hook-continue
15811 handle SIGLARM pass
15812 end
15813 @end smallexample
15814
15815 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
15816 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
15817 you could define:
15818
15819 @smallexample
15820 define hook-echo
15821 echo <<<---
15822 end
15823
15824 define hookpost-echo
15825 echo --->>>\n
15826 end
15827
15828 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
15829 <<<---Hello World--->>>
15830 (@value{GDBP})
15831
15832 @end smallexample
15833
15834 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
15835 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
15836 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
15837 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
15838 @c or not?
15839 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
15840 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
15841 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
15842
15843 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
15844 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
15845
15846 @node Command Files
15847 @section Command files
15848
15849 @cindex command files
15850 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
15851 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
15852 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
15853 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
15854 terminal.
15855
15856 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
15857 command:
15858
15859 @table @code
15860 @kindex source
15861 @item source @var{filename}
15862 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
15863 @end table
15864
15865 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
15866 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
15867 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
15868
15869 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
15870 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
15871 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
15872 when called from command files.
15873
15874 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
15875 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
15876 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
15877 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
15878 the next command.
15879
15880 @smallexample
15881 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
15882 @end smallexample
15883
15884 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
15885 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
15886 would be directed to @file{log}.
15887
15888 @node Output
15889 @section Commands for controlled output
15890
15891 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
15892 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
15893 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
15894 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
15895 want.
15896
15897 @table @code
15898 @kindex echo
15899 @item echo @var{text}
15900 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
15901 @c because it is not in ANSI.
15902 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
15903 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
15904 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
15905 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
15906 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
15907 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
15908 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
15909 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
15910 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
15911
15912 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
15913 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
15914
15915 @smallexample
15916 echo This is some text\n\
15917 which is continued\n\
15918 onto several lines.\n
15919 @end smallexample
15920
15921 produces the same output as
15922
15923 @smallexample
15924 echo This is some text\n
15925 echo which is continued\n
15926 echo onto several lines.\n
15927 @end smallexample
15928
15929 @kindex output
15930 @item output @var{expression}
15931 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
15932 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
15933 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
15934 on expressions.
15935
15936 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
15937 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
15938 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
15939 formats}, for more information.
15940
15941 @kindex printf
15942 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
15943 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
15944 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
15945 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
15946 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
15947 subroutine
15948 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
15949 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
15950 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
15951 @c supported.
15952
15953 @smallexample
15954 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
15955 @end smallexample
15956
15957 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
15958
15959 @smallexample
15960 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
15961 @end smallexample
15962
15963 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
15964 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
15965 letter.
15966 @end table
15967
15968 @node Interpreters
15969 @chapter Command Interpreters
15970 @cindex command interpreters
15971
15972 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
15973 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
15974 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
15975
15976 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
15977 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
15978 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
15979 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
15980
15981 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
15982 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
15983 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
15984 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
15985
15986 @table @code
15987 @item console
15988 @cindex console interpreter
15989 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
15990 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
15991 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
15992
15993 @item mi
15994 @cindex mi interpreter
15995 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
15996 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
15997 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
15998 Interface}.
15999
16000 @item mi2
16001 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16002 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16003
16004 @item mi1
16005 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16006 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16007
16008 @end table
16009
16010 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16011 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16012 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16013 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16014 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16015 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16016 the IDE inoperable!
16017
16018 @kindex interpreter-exec
16019 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16020 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16021 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16022 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16023
16024 @smallexample
16025 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16026 @end smallexample
16027
16028 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16029 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16030
16031 @node TUI
16032 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16033 @cindex TUI
16034 @cindex Text User Interface
16035
16036 @menu
16037 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16038 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16039 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16040 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16041 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16042 @end menu
16043
16044 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16045 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16046 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16047 commands in separate text windows.
16048
16049 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16050 @pindex gdbtui
16051 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16052
16053 @node TUI Overview
16054 @section TUI overview
16055
16056 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16057 @value{GDBN} runs:
16058
16059 @itemize @bullet
16060 @item
16061 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16062 windows on the terminal.
16063
16064 @item
16065 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16066 the TUI.
16067 @end itemize
16068
16069 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16070 on the terminal:
16071
16072 @table @emph
16073 @item command
16074 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16075 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16076 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16077 window is always visible.
16078
16079 @item source
16080 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16081 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16082
16083 @item assembly
16084 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16085
16086 @item register
16087 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16088 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16089 changed are highlighted.
16090
16091 @end table
16092
16093 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16094 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16095 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16096 indicates the breakpoint type:
16097
16098 @table @code
16099 @item B
16100 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16101
16102 @item b
16103 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16104
16105 @item H
16106 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16107
16108 @item h
16109 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16110
16111 @end table
16112
16113 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16114
16115 @table @code
16116 @item +
16117 Breakpoint is enabled.
16118
16119 @item -
16120 Breakpoint is disabled.
16121
16122 @end table
16123
16124 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16125 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16126 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16127 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16128 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16129 The following layouts are available:
16130
16131 @itemize @bullet
16132 @item
16133 source
16134
16135 @item
16136 assembly
16137
16138 @item
16139 source and assembly
16140
16141 @item
16142 source and registers
16143
16144 @item
16145 assembly and registers
16146
16147 @end itemize
16148
16149 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16150 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16151 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16152 are displayed:
16153
16154 @table @emph
16155 @item target
16156 Indicates the current gdb target
16157 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16158
16159 @item process
16160 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16161 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16162
16163 @item function
16164 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16165 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16166 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16167 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16168
16169 @item line
16170 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16171 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16172
16173 @item pc
16174 Indicates the current program counter address.
16175
16176 @end table
16177
16178 @node TUI Keys
16179 @section TUI Key Bindings
16180 @cindex TUI key bindings
16181
16182 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16183 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16184 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16185 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16186 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16187 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16188 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16189
16190 @table @kbd
16191 @kindex C-x C-a
16192 @item C-x C-a
16193 @kindex C-x a
16194 @itemx C-x a
16195 @kindex C-x A
16196 @itemx C-x A
16197 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16198 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16199 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16200 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16201 The screen is then refreshed.
16202
16203 @kindex C-x 1
16204 @item C-x 1
16205 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16206 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16207 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16208
16209 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16210
16211 @kindex C-x 2
16212 @item C-x 2
16213 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16214 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16215 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16216 previous layout and the new one.
16217
16218 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16219
16220 @kindex C-x o
16221 @item C-x o
16222 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16223 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16224 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16225
16226 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16227
16228 @kindex C-x s
16229 @item C-x s
16230 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16231 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16232
16233 @end table
16234
16235 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16236
16237 @table @key
16238 @kindex PgUp
16239 @item PgUp
16240 Scroll the active window one page up.
16241
16242 @kindex PgDn
16243 @item PgDn
16244 Scroll the active window one page down.
16245
16246 @kindex Up
16247 @item Up
16248 Scroll the active window one line up.
16249
16250 @kindex Down
16251 @item Down
16252 Scroll the active window one line down.
16253
16254 @kindex Left
16255 @item Left
16256 Scroll the active window one column left.
16257
16258 @kindex Right
16259 @item Right
16260 Scroll the active window one column right.
16261
16262 @kindex C-L
16263 @item C-L
16264 Refresh the screen.
16265
16266 @end table
16267
16268 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16269 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16270 active window is the command window. When the command window
16271 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16272 key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n}, @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
16273
16274 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16275 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16276 @cindex TUI single key mode
16277
16278 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16279 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16280 some gdb commands.
16281
16282 @table @kbd
16283 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16284 @item c
16285 continue
16286
16287 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16288 @item d
16289 down
16290
16291 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16292 @item f
16293 finish
16294
16295 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16296 @item n
16297 next
16298
16299 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16300 @item q
16301 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16302
16303 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16304 @item r
16305 run
16306
16307 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16308 @item s
16309 step
16310
16311 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16312 @item u
16313 up
16314
16315 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16316 @item v
16317 info locals
16318
16319 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16320 @item w
16321 where
16322
16323 @end table
16324
16325 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16326 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16327 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16328 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16329 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16330 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
16331
16332
16333 @node TUI Commands
16334 @section TUI specific commands
16335 @cindex TUI commands
16336
16337 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16338 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
16339 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
16340 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
16341 in the TUI mode.
16342
16343 @table @code
16344 @item info win
16345 @kindex info win
16346 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16347
16348 @item layout next
16349 @kindex layout
16350 Display the next layout.
16351
16352 @item layout prev
16353 Display the previous layout.
16354
16355 @item layout src
16356 Display the source window only.
16357
16358 @item layout asm
16359 Display the assembly window only.
16360
16361 @item layout split
16362 Display the source and assembly window.
16363
16364 @item layout regs
16365 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
16366
16367 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
16368 @kindex focus
16369 Set the focus to the named window.
16370 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
16371 can be affected to another window.
16372
16373 @item refresh
16374 @kindex refresh
16375 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
16376
16377 @item tui reg float
16378 @kindex tui reg
16379 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
16380
16381 @item tui reg general
16382 Show the general registers in the register window.
16383
16384 @item tui reg next
16385 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
16386 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
16387 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
16388 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
16389
16390 @item tui reg system
16391 Show the system registers in the register window.
16392
16393 @item update
16394 @kindex update
16395 Update the source window and the current execution point.
16396
16397 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
16398 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
16399 @kindex winheight
16400 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
16401 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
16402 decrease it.
16403
16404 @item tabset
16405 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
16406 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
16407
16408 @end table
16409
16410 @node TUI Configuration
16411 @section TUI configuration variables
16412 @cindex TUI configuration variables
16413
16414 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
16415 appearance of windows on the terminal.
16416
16417 @table @code
16418 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
16419 @kindex set tui border-kind
16420 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
16421 The possible values are the following:
16422 @table @code
16423 @item space
16424 Use a space character to draw the border.
16425
16426 @item ascii
16427 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
16428
16429 @item acs
16430 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
16431 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
16432
16433 @end table
16434
16435 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
16436 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
16437 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
16438 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
16439 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
16440
16441 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
16442 @kindex set tui border-mode
16443 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
16444 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
16445 @table @code
16446 @item normal
16447 Use normal attributes to display the border.
16448
16449 @item standout
16450 Use standout mode.
16451
16452 @item reverse
16453 Use reverse video mode.
16454
16455 @item half
16456 Use half bright mode.
16457
16458 @item half-standout
16459 Use half bright and standout mode.
16460
16461 @item bold
16462 Use extra bright or bold mode.
16463
16464 @item bold-standout
16465 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
16466
16467 @end table
16468
16469 @end table
16470
16471 @node Emacs
16472 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
16473
16474 @cindex Emacs
16475 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
16476 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
16477 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
16478 @value{GDBN}.
16479
16480 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
16481 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
16482 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
16483 created Emacs buffer.
16484 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
16485
16486 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
16487 things:
16488
16489 @itemize @bullet
16490 @item
16491 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
16492 @end itemize
16493
16494 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
16495 and output done by the program you are debugging.
16496
16497 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
16498 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
16499 in this way.
16500
16501 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
16502 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
16503 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
16504 stop.
16505
16506 @itemize @bullet
16507 @item
16508 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
16509 @end itemize
16510
16511 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
16512 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
16513 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
16514 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
16515 and the source.
16516
16517 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
16518 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
16519
16520 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
16521 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
16522 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
16523 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
16524 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
16525 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
16526 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
16527 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
16528 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
16529
16530 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
16531 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
16532 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
16533 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16534
16535 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
16536 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
16537 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
16538 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
16539 one you want.
16540
16541 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
16542 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
16543
16544 @table @kbd
16545 @item C-h m
16546 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
16547
16548 @item C-c C-s
16549 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
16550 update the display window to show the current file and location.
16551
16552 @item C-c C-n
16553 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
16554 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
16555 to show the current file and location.
16556
16557 @item C-c C-i
16558 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
16559 display window accordingly.
16560
16561 @item C-c C-f
16562 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
16563 @code{finish} command.
16564
16565 @item C-c C-r
16566 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
16567 command.
16568
16569 @item C-c <
16570 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
16571 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
16572 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
16573
16574 @item C-c >
16575 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
16576 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
16577 @end table
16578
16579 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gud-break})
16580 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
16581
16582 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
16583 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
16584 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
16585 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
16586 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
16587 current one.
16588
16589 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
16590 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
16591 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
16592 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
16593 frame.
16594
16595 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
16596 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
16597 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
16598 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
16599 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
16600 to correspond properly with the code.
16601
16602 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
16603 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
16604 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
16605
16606 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
16607 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
16608 @ignore
16609 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
16610 @kindex Epoch
16611 @kindex inspect
16612
16613 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
16614 called the @code{epoch}
16615 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
16616 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
16617 each value is printed in its own window.
16618 @end ignore
16619
16620
16621 @node GDB/MI
16622 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
16623
16624 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
16625
16626 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
16627 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
16628 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
16629 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
16630 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
16631 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
16632
16633 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
16634 in the form of a reference manual.
16635
16636 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
16637 features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
16638
16639 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
16640
16641 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
16642 This chapter uses the following notation:
16643
16644 @itemize @bullet
16645 @item
16646 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
16647
16648 @item
16649 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
16650 it may or may not be given.
16651
16652 @item
16653 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
16654 may repeat zero or more times.
16655
16656 @item
16657 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
16658 may repeat one or more times.
16659
16660 @item
16661 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
16662 @end itemize
16663
16664 @ignore
16665 @heading Dependencies
16666 @end ignore
16667
16668 @heading Acknowledgments
16669
16670 In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
16671 Elena Zannoni.
16672
16673 @menu
16674 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
16675 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
16676 * GDB/MI Output Records::
16677 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
16678 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
16679 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
16680 * GDB/MI Program Control::
16681 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
16682 @ignore
16683 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
16684 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
16685 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
16686 @end ignore
16687 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
16688 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
16689 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
16690 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
16691 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
16692 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
16693 @end menu
16694
16695 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16696 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
16697 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
16698
16699 @menu
16700 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
16701 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
16702 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
16703 @end menu
16704
16705 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
16706 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
16707
16708 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
16709 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
16710 @table @code
16711 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
16712 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
16713
16714 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
16715 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
16716 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
16717
16718 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
16719 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
16720 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
16721
16722 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
16723 "any sequence of digits"
16724
16725 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
16726 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
16727
16728 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
16729 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
16730
16731 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
16732 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
16733
16734 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
16735 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
16736 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
16737
16738 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
16739 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
16740
16741 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
16742 @code{CR | CR-LF}
16743 @end table
16744
16745 @noindent
16746 Notes:
16747
16748 @itemize @bullet
16749 @item
16750 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
16751 output is described below.
16752
16753 @item
16754 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
16755 finishes.
16756
16757 @item
16758 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
16759 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
16760 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
16761 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
16762 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
16763 @end itemize
16764
16765 Pragmatics:
16766
16767 @itemize @bullet
16768 @item
16769 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
16770
16771 @item
16772 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
16773 @end itemize
16774
16775 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
16776 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
16777
16778 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
16779 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
16780 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
16781 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
16782 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
16783 terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
16784
16785 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
16786 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
16787 @var{token}.
16788
16789 @table @code
16790 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
16791 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(@value{GDBP})" @var{nl}}
16792
16793 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
16794 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
16795
16796 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
16797 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
16798
16799 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
16800 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
16801
16802 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
16803 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
16804
16805 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
16806 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
16807
16808 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
16809 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
16810
16811 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
16812 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
16813
16814 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
16815 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
16816
16817 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
16818 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
16819 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
16820
16821 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
16822 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
16823
16824 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
16825 @code{ @var{string} }
16826
16827 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
16828 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
16829
16830 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
16831 @code{@var{c-string}}
16832
16833 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
16834 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
16835
16836 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
16837 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
16838 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
16839
16840 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
16841 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
16842
16843 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
16844 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
16845
16846 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
16847 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
16848
16849 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
16850 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
16851
16852 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
16853 @code{CR | CR-LF}
16854
16855 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
16856 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
16857 @end table
16858
16859 @noindent
16860 Notes:
16861
16862 @itemize @bullet
16863 @item
16864 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
16865
16866 @item
16867 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
16868 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
16869 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
16870 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
16871
16872 @item
16873 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16874 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
16875 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
16876 prefixed by @samp{+}.
16877
16878 @item
16879 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16880 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
16881 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
16882 @samp{*}.
16883
16884 @item
16885 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16886 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
16887 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
16888 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
16889
16890 @item
16891 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16892 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
16893 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
16894 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
16895
16896 @item
16897 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16898 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
16899 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
16900
16901 @item
16902 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16903 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
16904 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
16905 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
16906
16907 @item
16908 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
16909 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
16910 @var{values}.
16911
16912
16913 @end itemize
16914
16915 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
16916 details about the various output records.
16917
16918 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
16919 @subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
16920 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
16921
16922 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
16923 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
16924 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
16925 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
16926
16927 @subsubheading Target Stop
16928 @c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
16929 Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
16930
16931 @smallexample
16932 -> -stop
16933 <- (@value{GDBP})
16934 @end smallexample
16935
16936 @noindent
16937 and later:
16938
16939 @smallexample
16940 <- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
16941 <- (@value{GDBP})
16942 @end smallexample
16943
16944 @subsubheading Simple CLI Command
16945
16946 Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
16947 @sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
16948
16949 @smallexample
16950 -> print 1+2
16951 <- &"print 1+2\n"
16952 <- ~"$1 = 3\n"
16953 <- ^done
16954 <- (@value{GDBP})
16955 @end smallexample
16956
16957 @subsubheading Command With Side Effects
16958
16959 @smallexample
16960 -> -symbol-file xyz.exe
16961 <- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
16962 <- (@value{GDBP})
16963 @end smallexample
16964
16965 @subsubheading A Bad Command
16966
16967 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
16968
16969 @smallexample
16970 -> -rubbish
16971 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
16972 <- (@value{GDBP})
16973 @end smallexample
16974
16975 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16976 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
16977 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
16978
16979 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
16980 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
16981 To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
16982 accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
16983 commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
16984 respond.
16985
16986 This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
16987 clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
16988 is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
16989 behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
16990 an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
16991
16992 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16993 @node GDB/MI Output Records
16994 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
16995
16996 @menu
16997 * GDB/MI Result Records::
16998 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
16999 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17000 @end menu
17001
17002 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17003 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17004
17005 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17006 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17007 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17008 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17009
17010 @table @code
17011 @findex ^done
17012 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17013 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17014 values.
17015
17016 @item "^running"
17017 @findex ^running
17018 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17019 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17020 running.
17021
17022 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17023 @findex ^error
17024 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17025 error message.
17026 @end table
17027
17028 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17029 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17030
17031 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17032 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17033 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17034 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17035 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17036
17037 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17038 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17039 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17040 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17041 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17042
17043 @table @code
17044 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17045 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17046 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17047
17048 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17049 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17050 target.
17051
17052 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17053 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17054 internals.
17055 @end table
17056
17057 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17058 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17059
17060 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17061 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17062 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17063 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17064 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17065 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17066
17067 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17068 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17069
17070 @table @code
17071 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17072 @end table
17073
17074 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17075
17076 @table @code
17077 @item breakpoint-hit
17078 A breakpoint was reached.
17079 @item watchpoint-trigger
17080 A watchpoint was triggered.
17081 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17082 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17083 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17084 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17085 @item function-finished
17086 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17087 @item location-reached
17088 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17089 @item watchpoint-scope
17090 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17091 @item end-stepping-range
17092 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17093 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17094 @item exited-signalled
17095 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17096 @item exited
17097 The inferior exited.
17098 @item exited-normally
17099 The inferior exited normally.
17100 @item signal-received
17101 A signal was received by the inferior.
17102 @end table
17103
17104
17105 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17106 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17107 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17108
17109 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17110 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17111
17112 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17113 readability. They don't appear in the real output.
17114 Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
17115 not yet implemented.
17116
17117 @subheading Motivation
17118
17119 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17120
17121 @subheading Introduction
17122
17123 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17124
17125 @subheading Commands
17126
17127 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17128
17129 @subsubheading Synopsis
17130
17131 @smallexample
17132 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17133 @end smallexample
17134
17135 @subsubheading Result
17136
17137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17138
17139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17140
17141 @subsubheading Example
17142
17143 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17144 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
17145 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
17146
17147 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17148 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17149 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17150 breakpoints.
17151
17152 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17153 @findex -break-after
17154
17155 @subsubheading Synopsis
17156
17157 @smallexample
17158 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17159 @end smallexample
17160
17161 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17162 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17163 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17164 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17165
17166 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17167
17168 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17169
17170 @subsubheading Example
17171
17172 @smallexample
17173 (@value{GDBP})
17174 -break-insert main
17175 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
17176 (@value{GDBP})
17177 -break-after 1 3
17178 ~
17179 ^done
17180 (@value{GDBP})
17181 -break-list
17182 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17183 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17184 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17185 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17186 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17187 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17188 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17189 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17190 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
17191 ignore="3"@}]@}
17192 (@value{GDBP})
17193 @end smallexample
17194
17195 @ignore
17196 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17197 @findex -break-catch
17198
17199 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17200 @findex -break-commands
17201 @end ignore
17202
17203
17204 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17205 @findex -break-condition
17206
17207 @subsubheading Synopsis
17208
17209 @smallexample
17210 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17211 @end smallexample
17212
17213 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17214 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17215 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17216 command below).
17217
17218 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17219
17220 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17221
17222 @subsubheading Example
17223
17224 @smallexample
17225 (@value{GDBP})
17226 -break-condition 1 1
17227 ^done
17228 (@value{GDBP})
17229 -break-list
17230 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17231 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17232 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17233 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17234 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17235 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17236 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17237 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17238 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
17239 times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17240 (@value{GDBP})
17241 @end smallexample
17242
17243 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17244 @findex -break-delete
17245
17246 @subsubheading Synopsis
17247
17248 @smallexample
17249 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17250 @end smallexample
17251
17252 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17253 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17254
17255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17256
17257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17258
17259 @subsubheading Example
17260
17261 @smallexample
17262 (@value{GDBP})
17263 -break-delete 1
17264 ^done
17265 (@value{GDBP})
17266 -break-list
17267 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17268 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17269 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17270 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17271 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17272 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17273 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17274 body=[]@}
17275 (@value{GDBP})
17276 @end smallexample
17277
17278 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
17279 @findex -break-disable
17280
17281 @subsubheading Synopsis
17282
17283 @smallexample
17284 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17285 @end smallexample
17286
17287 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
17288 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
17289
17290 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17291
17292 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
17293
17294 @subsubheading Example
17295
17296 @smallexample
17297 (@value{GDBP})
17298 -break-disable 2
17299 ^done
17300 (@value{GDBP})
17301 -break-list
17302 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17303 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17304 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17305 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17306 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17307 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17308 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17309 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
17310 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17311 (@value{GDBP})
17312 @end smallexample
17313
17314 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
17315 @findex -break-enable
17316
17317 @subsubheading Synopsis
17318
17319 @smallexample
17320 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17321 @end smallexample
17322
17323 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
17324
17325 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17326
17327 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
17328
17329 @subsubheading Example
17330
17331 @smallexample
17332 (@value{GDBP})
17333 -break-enable 2
17334 ^done
17335 (@value{GDBP})
17336 -break-list
17337 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17338 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17339 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17340 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17341 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17342 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17343 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17344 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17345 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17346 (@value{GDBP})
17347 @end smallexample
17348
17349 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
17350 @findex -break-info
17351
17352 @subsubheading Synopsis
17353
17354 @smallexample
17355 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
17356 @end smallexample
17357
17358 @c REDUNDANT???
17359 Get information about a single breakpoint.
17360
17361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17362
17363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
17364
17365 @subsubheading Example
17366 N.A.
17367
17368 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
17369 @findex -break-insert
17370
17371 @subsubheading Synopsis
17372
17373 @smallexample
17374 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
17375 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
17376 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
17377 @end smallexample
17378
17379 @noindent
17380 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
17381
17382 @itemize @bullet
17383 @item function
17384 @c @item +offset
17385 @c @item -offset
17386 @c @item linenum
17387 @item filename:linenum
17388 @item filename:function
17389 @item *address
17390 @end itemize
17391
17392 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
17393
17394 @table @samp
17395 @item -t
17396 Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
17397 @item -h
17398 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
17399 @item -c @var{condition}
17400 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
17401 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
17402 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
17403 @item -r
17404 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
17405 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
17406 expresson.
17407 @end table
17408
17409 @subsubheading Result
17410
17411 The result is in the form:
17412
17413 @smallexample
17414 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
17415 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
17416 @end smallexample
17417
17418 @noindent
17419 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
17420 is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
17421 @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
17422 function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
17423
17424 Note: this format is open to change.
17425 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
17426
17427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17428
17429 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
17430 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
17431
17432 @subsubheading Example
17433
17434 @smallexample
17435 (@value{GDBP})
17436 -break-insert main
17437 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
17438 (@value{GDBP})
17439 -break-insert -t foo
17440 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
17441 (@value{GDBP})
17442 -break-list
17443 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17444 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17445 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17446 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17447 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17448 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17449 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17450 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17451 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
17452 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
17453 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
17454 (@value{GDBP})
17455 -break-insert -r foo.*
17456 ~int foo(int, int);
17457 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
17458 (@value{GDBP})
17459 @end smallexample
17460
17461 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
17462 @findex -break-list
17463
17464 @subsubheading Synopsis
17465
17466 @smallexample
17467 -break-list
17468 @end smallexample
17469
17470 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
17471
17472 @table @samp
17473 @item Number
17474 number of the breakpoint
17475 @item Type
17476 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
17477 @item Disposition
17478 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
17479 or @samp{nokeep}
17480 @item Enabled
17481 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
17482 @item Address
17483 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
17484 @item What
17485 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
17486 name, line number
17487 @item Times
17488 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
17489 @end table
17490
17491 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
17492 @code{body} field is an empty list.
17493
17494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17495
17496 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
17497
17498 @subsubheading Example
17499
17500 @smallexample
17501 (@value{GDBP})
17502 -break-list
17503 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17504 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17505 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17506 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17507 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17508 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17509 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17510 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17511 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
17512 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17513 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
17514 (@value{GDBP})
17515 @end smallexample
17516
17517 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
17518
17519 @smallexample
17520 (@value{GDBP})
17521 -break-list
17522 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17523 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17524 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17525 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17526 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17527 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17528 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17529 body=[]@}
17530 (@value{GDBP})
17531 @end smallexample
17532
17533 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
17534 @findex -break-watch
17535
17536 @subsubheading Synopsis
17537
17538 @smallexample
17539 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
17540 @end smallexample
17541
17542 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
17543 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
17544 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
17545 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
17546 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
17547 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
17548 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
17549 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
17550
17551 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
17552 breakpoints inserted.
17553
17554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17555
17556 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
17557 @samp{rwatch}.
17558
17559 @subsubheading Example
17560
17561 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
17562
17563 @smallexample
17564 (@value{GDBP})
17565 -break-watch x
17566 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
17567 (@value{GDBP})
17568 -exec-continue
17569 ^running
17570 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
17571 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
17572 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
17573 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
17574 (@value{GDBP})
17575 @end smallexample
17576
17577 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
17578 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
17579 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
17580
17581 @smallexample
17582 (@value{GDBP})
17583 -break-watch C
17584 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
17585 (@value{GDBP})
17586 -exec-continue
17587 ^running
17588 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
17589 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
17590 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
17591 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17592 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
17593 (@value{GDBP})
17594 -exec-continue
17595 ^running
17596 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
17597 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
17598 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
17599 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17600 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
17601 (@value{GDBP})
17602 @end smallexample
17603
17604 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
17605 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
17606 deleted.
17607
17608 @smallexample
17609 (@value{GDBP})
17610 -break-watch C
17611 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
17612 (@value{GDBP})
17613 -break-list
17614 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17615 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17616 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17617 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17618 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17619 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17620 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17621 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17622 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
17623 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
17624 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
17625 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
17626 (@value{GDBP})
17627 -exec-continue
17628 ^running
17629 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
17630 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
17631 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
17632 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17633 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
17634 (@value{GDBP})
17635 -break-list
17636 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17637 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17638 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17639 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17640 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17641 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17642 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17643 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17644 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
17645 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
17646 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
17647 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
17648 (@value{GDBP})
17649 -exec-continue
17650 ^running
17651 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
17652 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
17653 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
17654 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
17655 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
17656 (@value{GDBP})
17657 -break-list
17658 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17659 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17660 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17661 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17662 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17663 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17664 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17665 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17666 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
17667 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
17668 (@value{GDBP})
17669 @end smallexample
17670
17671 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17672 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
17673 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
17674
17675 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
17676 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
17677 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
17678 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
17679
17680 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
17681 @c @subheading -data-assign
17682 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
17683 @c @subsubheading GDB command
17684 @c set variable
17685 @c @subsubheading Example
17686 @c N.A.
17687
17688 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
17689 @findex -data-disassemble
17690
17691 @subsubheading Synopsis
17692
17693 @smallexample
17694 -data-disassemble
17695 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
17696 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
17697 -- @var{mode}
17698 @end smallexample
17699
17700 @noindent
17701 Where:
17702
17703 @table @samp
17704 @item @var{start-addr}
17705 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
17706 @item @var{end-addr}
17707 is the end address
17708 @item @var{filename}
17709 is the name of the file to disassemble
17710 @item @var{linenum}
17711 is the line number to disassemble around
17712 @item @var{lines}
17713 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
17714 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
17715 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
17716 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
17717 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
17718 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
17719 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
17720 are displayed.
17721 @item @var{mode}
17722 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
17723 disassembly).
17724 @end table
17725
17726 @subsubheading Result
17727
17728 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
17729
17730 @itemize @bullet
17731 @item Address
17732 @item Func-name
17733 @item Offset
17734 @item Instruction
17735 @end itemize
17736
17737 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
17738 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
17739
17740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17741
17742 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
17743
17744 @subsubheading Example
17745
17746 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
17747
17748 @smallexample
17749 (@value{GDBP})
17750 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
17751 ^done,
17752 asm_insns=[
17753 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
17754 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
17755 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
17756 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
17757 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
17758 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
17759 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
17760 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
17761 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
17762 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
17763 (@value{GDBP})
17764 @end smallexample
17765
17766 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
17767 @code{main}.
17768
17769 @smallexample
17770 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
17771 ^done,asm_insns=[
17772 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
17773 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
17774 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
17775 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
17776 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
17777 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
17778 [@dots{}]
17779 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
17780 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
17781 (@value{GDBP})
17782 @end smallexample
17783
17784 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
17785
17786 @smallexample
17787 (@value{GDBP})
17788 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
17789 ^done,asm_insns=[
17790 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
17791 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
17792 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
17793 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
17794 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
17795 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
17796 (@value{GDBP})
17797 @end smallexample
17798
17799 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
17800
17801 @smallexample
17802 (@value{GDBP})
17803 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
17804 ^done,asm_insns=[
17805 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
17806 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
17807 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
17808 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
17809 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
17810 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
17811 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
17812 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
17813 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
17814 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
17815 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
17816 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
17817 (@value{GDBP})
17818 @end smallexample
17819
17820
17821 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
17822 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
17823
17824 @subsubheading Synopsis
17825
17826 @smallexample
17827 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
17828 @end smallexample
17829
17830 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
17831 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
17832 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
17833
17834 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17835
17836 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
17837 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
17838 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
17839
17840 @subsubheading Example
17841
17842 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
17843 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
17844 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
17845 output.
17846
17847 @smallexample
17848 211-data-evaluate-expression A
17849 211^done,value="1"
17850 (@value{GDBP})
17851 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
17852 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
17853 (@value{GDBP})
17854 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
17855 411^done,value="4"
17856 (@value{GDBP})
17857 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
17858 511^done,value="4"
17859 (@value{GDBP})
17860 @end smallexample
17861
17862
17863 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
17864 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
17865
17866 @subsubheading Synopsis
17867
17868 @smallexample
17869 -data-list-changed-registers
17870 @end smallexample
17871
17872 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
17873
17874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17875
17876 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
17877 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
17878
17879 @subsubheading Example
17880
17881 On a PPC MBX board:
17882
17883 @smallexample
17884 (@value{GDBP})
17885 -exec-continue
17886 ^running
17887
17888 (@value{GDBP})
17889 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
17890 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="5"@}
17891 (@value{GDBP})
17892 -data-list-changed-registers
17893 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
17894 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
17895 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
17896 (@value{GDBP})
17897 @end smallexample
17898
17899
17900 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
17901 @findex -data-list-register-names
17902
17903 @subsubheading Synopsis
17904
17905 @smallexample
17906 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
17907 @end smallexample
17908
17909 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
17910 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
17911 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
17912 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
17913 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
17914 include empty register names.
17915
17916 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17917
17918 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
17919 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
17920 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
17921
17922 @subsubheading Example
17923
17924 For the PPC MBX board:
17925 @smallexample
17926 (@value{GDBP})
17927 -data-list-register-names
17928 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
17929 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
17930 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
17931 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
17932 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
17933 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
17934 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
17935 (@value{GDBP})
17936 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
17937 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
17938 (@value{GDBP})
17939 @end smallexample
17940
17941 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
17942 @findex -data-list-register-values
17943
17944 @subsubheading Synopsis
17945
17946 @smallexample
17947 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
17948 @end smallexample
17949
17950 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
17951 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
17952 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
17953 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
17954
17955 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
17956
17957 @table @code
17958 @item x
17959 Hexadecimal
17960 @item o
17961 Octal
17962 @item t
17963 Binary
17964 @item d
17965 Decimal
17966 @item r
17967 Raw
17968 @item N
17969 Natural
17970 @end table
17971
17972 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17973
17974 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
17975 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
17976
17977 @subsubheading Example
17978
17979 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
17980 don't appear in the actual output):
17981
17982 @smallexample
17983 (@value{GDBP})
17984 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
17985 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
17986 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
17987 (@value{GDBP})
17988 -data-list-register-values x
17989 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
17990 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
17991 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
17992 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
17993 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
17994 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
17995 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
17996 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
17997 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
17998 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
17999 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
18000 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
18001 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
18002 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
18003 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
18004 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
18005 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
18006 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
18007 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
18008 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
18009 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
18010 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
18011 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
18012 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
18013 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
18014 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
18015 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
18016 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
18017 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
18018 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
18019 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
18020 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
18021 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
18022 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
18023 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
18024 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
18025 (@value{GDBP})
18026 @end smallexample
18027
18028
18029 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
18030 @findex -data-read-memory
18031
18032 @subsubheading Synopsis
18033
18034 @smallexample
18035 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
18036 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
18037 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
18038 @end smallexample
18039
18040 @noindent
18041 where:
18042
18043 @table @samp
18044 @item @var{address}
18045 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
18046 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
18047 quoted using the C convention.
18048
18049 @item @var{word-format}
18050 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
18051 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
18052 ,Output formats}).
18053
18054 @item @var{word-size}
18055 The size of each memory word in bytes.
18056
18057 @item @var{nr-rows}
18058 The number of rows in the output table.
18059
18060 @item @var{nr-cols}
18061 The number of columns in the output table.
18062
18063 @item @var{aschar}
18064 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
18065 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
18066 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
18067 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
18068
18069 @item @var{byte-offset}
18070 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
18071 @end table
18072
18073 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
18074 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
18075 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
18076 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
18077 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
18078 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
18079 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
18080 @samp{addr}.
18081
18082 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
18083 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
18084 @samp{prev-page}.
18085
18086 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18087
18088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
18089 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
18090
18091 @subsubheading Example
18092
18093 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
18094 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
18095 word. Display each word in hex.
18096
18097 @smallexample
18098 (@value{GDBP})
18099 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
18100 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
18101 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
18102 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
18103 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
18104 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
18105 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
18106 (@value{GDBP})
18107 @end smallexample
18108
18109 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
18110 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
18111
18112 @smallexample
18113 (@value{GDBP})
18114 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
18115 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
18116 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
18117 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
18118 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
18119 (@value{GDBP})
18120 @end smallexample
18121
18122 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
18123 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
18124 used as the non-printable character.
18125
18126 @smallexample
18127 (@value{GDBP})
18128 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
18129 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
18130 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
18131 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
18132 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18133 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18134 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18135 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
18136 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
18137 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
18138 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
18139 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
18140 (@value{GDBP})
18141 @end smallexample
18142
18143 @subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
18144 @findex -display-delete
18145
18146 @subsubheading Synopsis
18147
18148 @smallexample
18149 -display-delete @var{number}
18150 @end smallexample
18151
18152 Delete the display @var{number}.
18153
18154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18155
18156 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
18157
18158 @subsubheading Example
18159 N.A.
18160
18161
18162 @subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
18163 @findex -display-disable
18164
18165 @subsubheading Synopsis
18166
18167 @smallexample
18168 -display-disable @var{number}
18169 @end smallexample
18170
18171 Disable display @var{number}.
18172
18173 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18174
18175 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
18176
18177 @subsubheading Example
18178 N.A.
18179
18180
18181 @subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
18182 @findex -display-enable
18183
18184 @subsubheading Synopsis
18185
18186 @smallexample
18187 -display-enable @var{number}
18188 @end smallexample
18189
18190 Enable display @var{number}.
18191
18192 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18193
18194 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
18195
18196 @subsubheading Example
18197 N.A.
18198
18199
18200 @subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
18201 @findex -display-insert
18202
18203 @subsubheading Synopsis
18204
18205 @smallexample
18206 -display-insert @var{expression}
18207 @end smallexample
18208
18209 Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
18210
18211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18212
18213 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
18214
18215 @subsubheading Example
18216 N.A.
18217
18218
18219 @subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
18220 @findex -display-list
18221
18222 @subsubheading Synopsis
18223
18224 @smallexample
18225 -display-list
18226 @end smallexample
18227
18228 List the displays. Do not show the current values.
18229
18230 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18231
18232 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
18233
18234 @subsubheading Example
18235 N.A.
18236
18237
18238 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18239 @findex -environment-cd
18240
18241 @subsubheading Synopsis
18242
18243 @smallexample
18244 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18245 @end smallexample
18246
18247 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18248
18249 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18250
18251 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18252
18253 @subsubheading Example
18254
18255 @smallexample
18256 (@value{GDBP})
18257 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18258 ^done
18259 (@value{GDBP})
18260 @end smallexample
18261
18262
18263 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18264 @findex -environment-directory
18265
18266 @subsubheading Synopsis
18267
18268 @smallexample
18269 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18270 @end smallexample
18271
18272 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18273 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18274 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18275 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18276 occurs as normal.
18277 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18278 multiple directories in a single command
18279 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18280 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18281 If blanks are needed as
18282 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18283 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18284 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18285 character must not be used
18286 in any directory name.
18287 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18288
18289 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18290
18291 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18292
18293 @subsubheading Example
18294
18295 @smallexample
18296 (@value{GDBP})
18297 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18298 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18299 (@value{GDBP})
18300 -environment-directory ""
18301 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18302 (@value{GDBP})
18303 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18304 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18305 (@value{GDBP})
18306 -environment-directory -r
18307 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18308 (@value{GDBP})
18309 @end smallexample
18310
18311
18312 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18313 @findex -environment-path
18314
18315 @subsubheading Synopsis
18316
18317 @smallexample
18318 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18319 @end smallexample
18320
18321 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18322 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18323 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18324 supplied in addition to the
18325 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18326 occurs as normal.
18327 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18328 multiple directories in a single command
18329 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18330 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18331 If blanks are needed as
18332 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18333 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18334 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18335 character must not be used
18336 in any directory name.
18337 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18338
18339
18340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18341
18342 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18343
18344 @subsubheading Example
18345
18346 @smallexample
18347 (@value{GDBP})
18348 -environment-path
18349 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18350 (@value{GDBP})
18351 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18352 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18353 (@value{GDBP})
18354 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18355 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18356 (@value{GDBP})
18357 @end smallexample
18358
18359
18360 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18361 @findex -environment-pwd
18362
18363 @subsubheading Synopsis
18364
18365 @smallexample
18366 -environment-pwd
18367 @end smallexample
18368
18369 Show the current working directory.
18370
18371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18372
18373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18374
18375 @subsubheading Example
18376
18377 @smallexample
18378 (@value{GDBP})
18379 -environment-pwd
18380 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18381 (@value{GDBP})
18382 @end smallexample
18383
18384 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18385 @node GDB/MI Program Control
18386 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
18387
18388 @subsubheading Program termination
18389
18390 As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
18391 it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
18392 include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
18393
18394 @subsubheading Examples
18395
18396 @noindent
18397 Program exited normally:
18398
18399 @smallexample
18400 (@value{GDBP})
18401 -exec-run
18402 ^running
18403 (@value{GDBP})
18404 x = 55
18405 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18406 (@value{GDBP})
18407 @end smallexample
18408
18409 @noindent
18410 Program exited exceptionally:
18411
18412 @smallexample
18413 (@value{GDBP})
18414 -exec-run
18415 ^running
18416 (@value{GDBP})
18417 x = 55
18418 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
18419 (@value{GDBP})
18420 @end smallexample
18421
18422 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
18423 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
18424
18425 @smallexample
18426 (@value{GDBP})
18427 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
18428 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
18429 @end smallexample
18430
18431
18432 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
18433 @findex -exec-abort
18434
18435 @subsubheading Synopsis
18436
18437 @smallexample
18438 -exec-abort
18439 @end smallexample
18440
18441 Kill the inferior running program.
18442
18443 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18444
18445 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
18446
18447 @subsubheading Example
18448 N.A.
18449
18450
18451 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18452 @findex -exec-arguments
18453
18454 @subsubheading Synopsis
18455
18456 @smallexample
18457 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18458 @end smallexample
18459
18460 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18461 @samp{-exec-run}.
18462
18463 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18464
18465 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18466
18467 @subsubheading Example
18468
18469 @c FIXME!
18470 Don't have one around.
18471
18472
18473 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18474 @findex -exec-continue
18475
18476 @subsubheading Synopsis
18477
18478 @smallexample
18479 -exec-continue
18480 @end smallexample
18481
18482 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
18483 until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18484
18485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18486
18487 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18488
18489 @subsubheading Example
18490
18491 @smallexample
18492 -exec-continue
18493 ^running
18494 (@value{GDBP})
18495 @@Hello world
18496 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18497 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/hello.c",line="13"@}
18498 (@value{GDBP})
18499 @end smallexample
18500
18501
18502 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18503 @findex -exec-finish
18504
18505 @subsubheading Synopsis
18506
18507 @smallexample
18508 -exec-finish
18509 @end smallexample
18510
18511 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
18512 until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
18513 the function.
18514
18515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18516
18517 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18518
18519 @subsubheading Example
18520
18521 Function returning @code{void}.
18522
18523 @smallexample
18524 -exec-finish
18525 ^running
18526 (@value{GDBP})
18527 @@hello from foo
18528 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18529 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/hello.c",line="7"@}
18530 (@value{GDBP})
18531 @end smallexample
18532
18533 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18534 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18535 value itself.
18536
18537 @smallexample
18538 -exec-finish
18539 ^running
18540 (@value{GDBP})
18541 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18542 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18543 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18544 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18545 (@value{GDBP})
18546 @end smallexample
18547
18548
18549 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18550 @findex -exec-interrupt
18551
18552 @subsubheading Synopsis
18553
18554 @smallexample
18555 -exec-interrupt
18556 @end smallexample
18557
18558 Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
18559 Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
18560 execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
18561 itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18562 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18563
18564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18565
18566 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18567
18568 @subsubheading Example
18569
18570 @smallexample
18571 (@value{GDBP})
18572 111-exec-continue
18573 111^running
18574
18575 (@value{GDBP})
18576 222-exec-interrupt
18577 222^done
18578 (@value{GDBP})
18579 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18580 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18581 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="13"@}
18582 (@value{GDBP})
18583
18584 (@value{GDBP})
18585 -exec-interrupt
18586 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18587 (@value{GDBP})
18588 @end smallexample
18589
18590
18591 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18592 @findex -exec-next
18593
18594 @subsubheading Synopsis
18595
18596 @smallexample
18597 -exec-next
18598 @end smallexample
18599
18600 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
18601 when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
18602
18603 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18604
18605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18606
18607 @subsubheading Example
18608
18609 @smallexample
18610 -exec-next
18611 ^running
18612 (@value{GDBP})
18613 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18614 (@value{GDBP})
18615 @end smallexample
18616
18617
18618 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18619 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18620
18621 @subsubheading Synopsis
18622
18623 @smallexample
18624 -exec-next-instruction
18625 @end smallexample
18626
18627 Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
18628 instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
18629 the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
18630 address will be printed as well.
18631
18632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18633
18634 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18635
18636 @subsubheading Example
18637
18638 @smallexample
18639 (@value{GDBP})
18640 -exec-next-instruction
18641 ^running
18642
18643 (@value{GDBP})
18644 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18645 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18646 (@value{GDBP})
18647 @end smallexample
18648
18649
18650 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18651 @findex -exec-return
18652
18653 @subsubheading Synopsis
18654
18655 @smallexample
18656 -exec-return
18657 @end smallexample
18658
18659 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18660 Displays the new current frame.
18661
18662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18663
18664 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18665
18666 @subsubheading Example
18667
18668 @smallexample
18669 (@value{GDBP})
18670 200-break-insert callee4
18671 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18672 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18673 (@value{GDBP})
18674 000-exec-run
18675 000^running
18676 (@value{GDBP})
18677 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18678 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18679 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18680 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18681 (@value{GDBP})
18682 205-break-delete
18683 205^done
18684 (@value{GDBP})
18685 111-exec-return
18686 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18687 args=[@{name="strarg",
18688 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18689 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18690 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18691 (@value{GDBP})
18692 @end smallexample
18693
18694
18695 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18696 @findex -exec-run
18697
18698 @subsubheading Synopsis
18699
18700 @smallexample
18701 -exec-run
18702 @end smallexample
18703
18704 Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
18705 beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
18706 encountered or the program exits.
18707
18708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18709
18710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18711
18712 @subsubheading Example
18713
18714 @smallexample
18715 (@value{GDBP})
18716 -break-insert main
18717 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18718 (@value{GDBP})
18719 -exec-run
18720 ^running
18721 (@value{GDBP})
18722 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18723 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18724 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18725 (@value{GDBP})
18726 @end smallexample
18727
18728
18729 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18730 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18731
18732 @subsubheading Synopsis
18733
18734 @smallexample
18735 -exec-show-arguments
18736 @end smallexample
18737
18738 Print the arguments of the program.
18739
18740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18741
18742 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18743
18744 @subsubheading Example
18745 N.A.
18746
18747 @c @subheading -exec-signal
18748
18749 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
18750 @findex -exec-step
18751
18752 @subsubheading Synopsis
18753
18754 @smallexample
18755 -exec-step
18756 @end smallexample
18757
18758 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
18759 when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
18760 source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
18761 instruction of the called function.
18762
18763 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18764
18765 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
18766
18767 @subsubheading Example
18768
18769 Stepping into a function:
18770
18771 @smallexample
18772 -exec-step
18773 ^running
18774 (@value{GDBP})
18775 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18776 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
18777 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
18778 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
18779 (@value{GDBP})
18780 @end smallexample
18781
18782 Regular stepping:
18783
18784 @smallexample
18785 -exec-step
18786 ^running
18787 (@value{GDBP})
18788 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
18789 (@value{GDBP})
18790 @end smallexample
18791
18792
18793 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
18794 @findex -exec-step-instruction
18795
18796 @subsubheading Synopsis
18797
18798 @smallexample
18799 -exec-step-instruction
18800 @end smallexample
18801
18802 Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
18803 instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
18804 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
18805 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
18806 well.
18807
18808 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18809
18810 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
18811
18812 @subsubheading Example
18813
18814 @smallexample
18815 (@value{GDBP})
18816 -exec-step-instruction
18817 ^running
18818
18819 (@value{GDBP})
18820 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18821 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18822 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="10"@}
18823 (@value{GDBP})
18824 -exec-step-instruction
18825 ^running
18826
18827 (@value{GDBP})
18828 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18829 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18830 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/try.c",line="10"@}
18831 (@value{GDBP})
18832 @end smallexample
18833
18834
18835 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
18836 @findex -exec-until
18837
18838 @subsubheading Synopsis
18839
18840 @smallexample
18841 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
18842 @end smallexample
18843
18844 Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
18845 specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
18846 executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
18847 The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
18848
18849 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18850
18851 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
18852
18853 @subsubheading Example
18854
18855 @smallexample
18856 (@value{GDBP})
18857 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
18858 ^running
18859 (@value{GDBP})
18860 x = 55
18861 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18862 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
18863 (@value{GDBP})
18864 @end smallexample
18865
18866 @ignore
18867 @subheading -file-clear
18868 Is this going away????
18869 @end ignore
18870
18871
18872 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
18873 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
18874
18875 @subsubheading Synopsis
18876
18877 @smallexample
18878 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
18879 @end smallexample
18880
18881 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
18882 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
18883 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
18884 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
18885 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
18886 notification.
18887
18888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18889
18890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
18891
18892 @subsubheading Example
18893
18894 @smallexample
18895 (@value{GDBP})
18896 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
18897 ^done
18898 (@value{GDBP})
18899 @end smallexample
18900
18901
18902 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
18903 @findex -file-exec-file
18904
18905 @subsubheading Synopsis
18906
18907 @smallexample
18908 -file-exec-file @var{file}
18909 @end smallexample
18910
18911 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
18912 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
18913 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
18914 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
18915 notification.
18916
18917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18918
18919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
18920
18921 @subsubheading Example
18922
18923 @smallexample
18924 (@value{GDBP})
18925 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
18926 ^done
18927 (@value{GDBP})
18928 @end smallexample
18929
18930
18931 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
18932 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
18933
18934 @subsubheading Synopsis
18935
18936 @smallexample
18937 -file-list-exec-sections
18938 @end smallexample
18939
18940 List the sections of the current executable file.
18941
18942 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18943
18944 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
18945 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
18946 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
18947
18948 @subsubheading Example
18949 N.A.
18950
18951
18952 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
18953 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
18954
18955 @subsubheading Synopsis
18956
18957 @smallexample
18958 -file-list-exec-source-file
18959 @end smallexample
18960
18961 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
18962 to the current source file for the current executable.
18963
18964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18965
18966 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
18967
18968 @subsubheading Example
18969
18970 @smallexample
18971 (@value{GDBP})
18972 123-file-list-exec-source-file
18973 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
18974 (@value{GDBP})
18975 @end smallexample
18976
18977
18978 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
18979 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
18980
18981 @subsubheading Synopsis
18982
18983 @smallexample
18984 -file-list-exec-source-files
18985 @end smallexample
18986
18987 List the source files for the current executable.
18988
18989 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
18990 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
18991
18992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18993
18994 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
18995 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
18996
18997 @subsubheading Example
18998 @smallexample
18999 (@value{GDBP})
19000 -file-list-exec-source-files
19001 ^done,files=[
19002 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
19003 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
19004 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
19005 (@value{GDBP})
19006 @end smallexample
19007
19008 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
19009 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
19010
19011 @subsubheading Synopsis
19012
19013 @smallexample
19014 -file-list-shared-libraries
19015 @end smallexample
19016
19017 List the shared libraries in the program.
19018
19019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19020
19021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
19022
19023 @subsubheading Example
19024 N.A.
19025
19026
19027 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
19028 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
19029
19030 @subsubheading Synopsis
19031
19032 @smallexample
19033 -file-list-symbol-files
19034 @end smallexample
19035
19036 List symbol files.
19037
19038 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19039
19040 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
19041
19042 @subsubheading Example
19043 N.A.
19044
19045
19046 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
19047 @findex -file-symbol-file
19048
19049 @subsubheading Synopsis
19050
19051 @smallexample
19052 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
19053 @end smallexample
19054
19055 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
19056 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
19057 produced, except for a completion notification.
19058
19059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19060
19061 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
19062
19063 @subsubheading Example
19064
19065 @smallexample
19066 (@value{GDBP})
19067 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
19068 ^done
19069 (@value{GDBP})
19070 @end smallexample
19071
19072 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19073 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
19074 @section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
19075
19076 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
19077
19078 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
19079 @findex -gdb-exit
19080
19081 @subsubheading Synopsis
19082
19083 @smallexample
19084 -gdb-exit
19085 @end smallexample
19086
19087 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
19088
19089 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19090
19091 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
19092
19093 @subsubheading Example
19094
19095 @smallexample
19096 (@value{GDBP})
19097 -gdb-exit
19098 @end smallexample
19099
19100 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
19101 @findex -gdb-set
19102
19103 @subsubheading Synopsis
19104
19105 @smallexample
19106 -gdb-set
19107 @end smallexample
19108
19109 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
19110 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
19111
19112 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19113
19114 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
19115
19116 @subsubheading Example
19117
19118 @smallexample
19119 (@value{GDBP})
19120 -gdb-set $foo=3
19121 ^done
19122 (@value{GDBP})
19123 @end smallexample
19124
19125
19126 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
19127 @findex -gdb-show
19128
19129 @subsubheading Synopsis
19130
19131 @smallexample
19132 -gdb-show
19133 @end smallexample
19134
19135 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
19136
19137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
19138
19139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
19140
19141 @subsubheading Example
19142
19143 @smallexample
19144 (@value{GDBP})
19145 -gdb-show annotate
19146 ^done,value="0"
19147 (@value{GDBP})
19148 @end smallexample
19149
19150 @c @subheading -gdb-source
19151
19152
19153 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
19154 @findex -gdb-version
19155
19156 @subsubheading Synopsis
19157
19158 @smallexample
19159 -gdb-version
19160 @end smallexample
19161
19162 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
19163
19164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19165
19166 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
19167 information when you start an interactive session.
19168
19169 @subsubheading Example
19170
19171 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
19172 @c box in TeX.
19173 @smallexample
19174 (@value{GDBP})
19175 -gdb-version
19176 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
19177 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
19178 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
19179 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
19180 ~ certain conditions.
19181 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
19182 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
19183 ~ details.
19184 ~This GDB was configured as
19185 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
19186 ^done
19187 (@value{GDBP})
19188 @end smallexample
19189
19190 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
19191 @findex -interpreter-exec
19192
19193 @subheading Synopsis
19194
19195 @smallexample
19196 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
19197 @end smallexample
19198
19199 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
19200
19201 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
19202
19203 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
19204
19205 @subheading Example
19206
19207 @smallexample
19208 (@value{GDBP})
19209 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
19210 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
19211 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
19212 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
19213 ^done
19214 (@value{GDBP})
19215 @end smallexample
19216
19217 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
19218 @findex -inferior-tty-set
19219
19220 @subheading Synopsis
19221
19222 @smallexample
19223 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
19224 @end smallexample
19225
19226 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
19227
19228 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
19229
19230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty /dev/pts/1}.
19231
19232 @subheading Example
19233
19234 @smallexample
19235 (@value{GDBP})
19236 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
19237 ^done
19238 (@value{GDBP})
19239 @end smallexample
19240
19241 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
19242 @findex -inferior-tty-show
19243
19244 @subheading Synopsis
19245
19246 @smallexample
19247 -inferior-tty-show
19248 @end smallexample
19249
19250 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
19251
19252 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
19253
19254 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
19255
19256 @subheading Example
19257
19258 @smallexample
19259 (@value{GDBP})
19260 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
19261 ^done
19262 (@value{GDBP})
19263 -inferior-tty-show
19264 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
19265 (@value{GDBP})
19266 @end smallexample
19267
19268 @ignore
19269 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19270 @node GDB/MI Kod Commands
19271 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
19272
19273 The Kod commands are not implemented.
19274
19275 @c @subheading -kod-info
19276
19277 @c @subheading -kod-list
19278
19279 @c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
19280
19281 @c @subheading -kod-show
19282
19283 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19284 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
19285 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
19286
19287 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
19288
19289 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
19290
19291 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
19292
19293 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
19294
19295 @c @subheading -overlay-map
19296
19297 @c @subheading -overlay-off
19298
19299 @c @subheading -overlay-on
19300
19301 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
19302
19303 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19304 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
19305 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
19306
19307 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
19308
19309 @c @subheading -signal-handle
19310
19311 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
19312
19313 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
19314 @end ignore
19315
19316
19317 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19318 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19319 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19320
19321
19322 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19323 @findex -stack-info-frame
19324
19325 @subsubheading Synopsis
19326
19327 @smallexample
19328 -stack-info-frame
19329 @end smallexample
19330
19331 Get info on the selected frame.
19332
19333 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19334
19335 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19336 (without arguments).
19337
19338 @subsubheading Example
19339
19340 @smallexample
19341 (@value{GDBP})
19342 -stack-info-frame
19343 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19344 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19345 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19346 (@value{GDBP})
19347 @end smallexample
19348
19349 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19350 @findex -stack-info-depth
19351
19352 @subsubheading Synopsis
19353
19354 @smallexample
19355 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19356 @end smallexample
19357
19358 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19359 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19360
19361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19362
19363 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19364
19365 @subsubheading Example
19366
19367 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19368
19369 @smallexample
19370 (@value{GDBP})
19371 -stack-info-depth
19372 ^done,depth="12"
19373 (@value{GDBP})
19374 -stack-info-depth 4
19375 ^done,depth="4"
19376 (@value{GDBP})
19377 -stack-info-depth 12
19378 ^done,depth="12"
19379 (@value{GDBP})
19380 -stack-info-depth 11
19381 ^done,depth="11"
19382 (@value{GDBP})
19383 -stack-info-depth 13
19384 ^done,depth="12"
19385 (@value{GDBP})
19386 @end smallexample
19387
19388 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19389 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19390
19391 @subsubheading Synopsis
19392
19393 @smallexample
19394 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19395 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19396 @end smallexample
19397
19398 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19399 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19400 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
19401 stack.
19402
19403 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19404 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19405 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19406
19407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19408
19409 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19410 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19411 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19412
19413 @subsubheading Example
19414
19415 @smallexample
19416 (@value{GDBP})
19417 -stack-list-frames
19418 ^done,
19419 stack=[
19420 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19421 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19422 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19423 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19424 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19425 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19426 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19427 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19428 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19429 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19430 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19431 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19432 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19433 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19434 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19435 (@value{GDBP})
19436 -stack-list-arguments 0
19437 ^done,
19438 stack-args=[
19439 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19440 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19441 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19442 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19443 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19444 (@value{GDBP})
19445 -stack-list-arguments 1
19446 ^done,
19447 stack-args=[
19448 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19449 frame=@{level="1",
19450 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19451 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19452 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19453 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19454 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19455 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19456 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19457 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19458 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19459 (@value{GDBP})
19460 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19461 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19462 (@value{GDBP})
19463 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19464 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19465 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19466 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19467 (@value{GDBP})
19468 @end smallexample
19469
19470 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19471
19472
19473 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19474 @findex -stack-list-frames
19475
19476 @subsubheading Synopsis
19477
19478 @smallexample
19479 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19480 @end smallexample
19481
19482 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19483 following info:
19484
19485 @table @samp
19486 @item @var{level}
19487 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19488 @item @var{addr}
19489 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19490 @item @var{func}
19491 Function name.
19492 @item @var{file}
19493 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19494 @item @var{line}
19495 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19496 @end table
19497
19498 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19499 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19500 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19501 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
19502
19503 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19504
19505 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19506
19507 @subsubheading Example
19508
19509 Full stack backtrace:
19510
19511 @smallexample
19512 (@value{GDBP})
19513 -stack-list-frames
19514 ^done,stack=
19515 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19516 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19517 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19518 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19519 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19520 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19521 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19522 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19523 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19524 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19525 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19526 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19527 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19528 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19529 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19530 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19531 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19532 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19533 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19534 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19535 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19536 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19537 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19538 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19539 (@value{GDBP})
19540 @end smallexample
19541
19542 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19543
19544 @smallexample
19545 (@value{GDBP})
19546 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19547 ^done,stack=
19548 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19549 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19550 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19551 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19552 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19553 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19554 (@value{GDBP})
19555 @end smallexample
19556
19557 Show a single frame:
19558
19559 @smallexample
19560 (@value{GDBP})
19561 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19562 ^done,stack=
19563 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19564 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/myproject/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19565 (@value{GDBP})
19566 @end smallexample
19567
19568
19569 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19570 @findex -stack-list-locals
19571
19572 @subsubheading Synopsis
19573
19574 @smallexample
19575 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19576 @end smallexample
19577
19578 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19579 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19580 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19581 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19582 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19583 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19584 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19585 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19586 more detail.
19587
19588 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19589
19590 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19591
19592 @subsubheading Example
19593
19594 @smallexample
19595 (@value{GDBP})
19596 -stack-list-locals 0
19597 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19598 (@value{GDBP})
19599 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19600 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19601 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19602 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19603 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19604 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19605 (@value{GDBP})
19606 @end smallexample
19607
19608
19609 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19610 @findex -stack-select-frame
19611
19612 @subsubheading Synopsis
19613
19614 @smallexample
19615 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19616 @end smallexample
19617
19618 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19619 the stack.
19620
19621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19622
19623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19624 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19625
19626 @subsubheading Example
19627
19628 @smallexample
19629 (@value{GDBP})
19630 -stack-select-frame 2
19631 ^done
19632 (@value{GDBP})
19633 @end smallexample
19634
19635 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19636 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
19637 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
19638
19639
19640 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
19641 @findex -symbol-info-address
19642
19643 @subsubheading Synopsis
19644
19645 @smallexample
19646 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
19647 @end smallexample
19648
19649 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
19650
19651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19652
19653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
19654
19655 @subsubheading Example
19656 N.A.
19657
19658
19659 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
19660 @findex -symbol-info-file
19661
19662 @subsubheading Synopsis
19663
19664 @smallexample
19665 -symbol-info-file
19666 @end smallexample
19667
19668 Show the file for the symbol.
19669
19670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19671
19672 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
19673 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
19674
19675 @subsubheading Example
19676 N.A.
19677
19678
19679 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
19680 @findex -symbol-info-function
19681
19682 @subsubheading Synopsis
19683
19684 @smallexample
19685 -symbol-info-function
19686 @end smallexample
19687
19688 Show which function the symbol lives in.
19689
19690 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19691
19692 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
19693
19694 @subsubheading Example
19695 N.A.
19696
19697
19698 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
19699 @findex -symbol-info-line
19700
19701 @subsubheading Synopsis
19702
19703 @smallexample
19704 -symbol-info-line
19705 @end smallexample
19706
19707 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
19708
19709 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19710
19711 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
19712 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
19713
19714 @subsubheading Example
19715 N.A.
19716
19717
19718 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
19719 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
19720
19721 @subsubheading Synopsis
19722
19723 @smallexample
19724 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
19725 @end smallexample
19726
19727 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
19728
19729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19730
19731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
19732
19733 @subsubheading Example
19734 N.A.
19735
19736
19737 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
19738 @findex -symbol-list-functions
19739
19740 @subsubheading Synopsis
19741
19742 @smallexample
19743 -symbol-list-functions
19744 @end smallexample
19745
19746 List the functions in the executable.
19747
19748 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19749
19750 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
19751 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
19752
19753 @subsubheading Example
19754 N.A.
19755
19756
19757 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
19758 @findex -symbol-list-lines
19759
19760 @subsubheading Synopsis
19761
19762 @smallexample
19763 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
19764 @end smallexample
19765
19766 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
19767 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
19768 ascending PC order.
19769
19770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19771
19772 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
19773
19774 @subsubheading Example
19775 @smallexample
19776 (@value{GDBP})
19777 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
19778 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
19779 (@value{GDBP})
19780 @end smallexample
19781
19782
19783 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
19784 @findex -symbol-list-types
19785
19786 @subsubheading Synopsis
19787
19788 @smallexample
19789 -symbol-list-types
19790 @end smallexample
19791
19792 List all the type names.
19793
19794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19795
19796 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
19797 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
19798
19799 @subsubheading Example
19800 N.A.
19801
19802
19803 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
19804 @findex -symbol-list-variables
19805
19806 @subsubheading Synopsis
19807
19808 @smallexample
19809 -symbol-list-variables
19810 @end smallexample
19811
19812 List all the global and static variable names.
19813
19814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19815
19816 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
19817
19818 @subsubheading Example
19819 N.A.
19820
19821
19822 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
19823 @findex -symbol-locate
19824
19825 @subsubheading Synopsis
19826
19827 @smallexample
19828 -symbol-locate
19829 @end smallexample
19830
19831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19832
19833 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
19834
19835 @subsubheading Example
19836 N.A.
19837
19838
19839 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
19840 @findex -symbol-type
19841
19842 @subsubheading Synopsis
19843
19844 @smallexample
19845 -symbol-type @var{variable}
19846 @end smallexample
19847
19848 Show type of @var{variable}.
19849
19850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19851
19852 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
19853 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
19854
19855 @subsubheading Example
19856 N.A.
19857
19858
19859 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19860 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
19861 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
19862
19863
19864 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
19865 @findex -target-attach
19866
19867 @subsubheading Synopsis
19868
19869 @smallexample
19870 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
19871 @end smallexample
19872
19873 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
19874
19875 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
19876
19877 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
19878
19879 @subsubheading Example
19880 N.A.
19881
19882
19883 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
19884 @findex -target-compare-sections
19885
19886 @subsubheading Synopsis
19887
19888 @smallexample
19889 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
19890 @end smallexample
19891
19892 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
19893 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
19894
19895 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19896
19897 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
19898
19899 @subsubheading Example
19900 N.A.
19901
19902
19903 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
19904 @findex -target-detach
19905
19906 @subsubheading Synopsis
19907
19908 @smallexample
19909 -target-detach
19910 @end smallexample
19911
19912 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
19913
19914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
19915
19916 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
19917
19918 @subsubheading Example
19919
19920 @smallexample
19921 (@value{GDBP})
19922 -target-detach
19923 ^done
19924 (@value{GDBP})
19925 @end smallexample
19926
19927
19928 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
19929 @findex -target-disconnect
19930
19931 @subsubheading Synopsis
19932
19933 @example
19934 -target-disconnect
19935 @end example
19936
19937 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
19938
19939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
19940
19941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
19942
19943 @subsubheading Example
19944
19945 @smallexample
19946 (@value{GDBP})
19947 -target-disconnect
19948 ^done
19949 (@value{GDBP})
19950 @end smallexample
19951
19952
19953 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
19954 @findex -target-download
19955
19956 @subsubheading Synopsis
19957
19958 @smallexample
19959 -target-download
19960 @end smallexample
19961
19962 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
19963 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
19964
19965 @table @samp
19966 @item section
19967 The name of the section.
19968 @item section-sent
19969 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
19970 @item section-size
19971 The size of the section.
19972 @item total-sent
19973 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
19974 @item total-size
19975 The size of the overall executable to download.
19976 @end table
19977
19978 @noindent
19979 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
19980 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
19981
19982 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
19983 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
19984
19985 @table @samp
19986 @item section
19987 The name of the section.
19988 @item section-size
19989 The size of the section.
19990 @item total-size
19991 The size of the overall executable to download.
19992 @end table
19993
19994 @noindent
19995 At the end, a summary is printed.
19996
19997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19998
19999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20000
20001 @subsubheading Example
20002
20003 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20004 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20005
20006 @smallexample
20007 (@value{GDBP})
20008 -target-download
20009 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20010 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20011 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20012 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20013 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20014 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20015 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20016 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20017 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20018 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20019 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20020 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20021 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
20022 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
20023 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
20024 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
20025 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
20026 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
20027 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
20028 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
20029 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
20030 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
20031 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
20032 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
20033 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
20034 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
20035 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
20036 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20037 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20038 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
20039 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
20040 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
20041 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
20042 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
20043 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
20044 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
20045 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
20046 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
20047 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
20048 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
20049 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
20050 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
20051 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
20052 write-rate="429"
20053 (@value{GDBP})
20054 @end smallexample
20055
20056
20057 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
20058 @findex -target-exec-status
20059
20060 @subsubheading Synopsis
20061
20062 @smallexample
20063 -target-exec-status
20064 @end smallexample
20065
20066 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
20067 not, for instance).
20068
20069 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20070
20071 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20072
20073 @subsubheading Example
20074 N.A.
20075
20076
20077 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
20078 @findex -target-list-available-targets
20079
20080 @subsubheading Synopsis
20081
20082 @smallexample
20083 -target-list-available-targets
20084 @end smallexample
20085
20086 List the possible targets to connect to.
20087
20088 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20089
20090 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
20091
20092 @subsubheading Example
20093 N.A.
20094
20095
20096 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
20097 @findex -target-list-current-targets
20098
20099 @subsubheading Synopsis
20100
20101 @smallexample
20102 -target-list-current-targets
20103 @end smallexample
20104
20105 Describe the current target.
20106
20107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20108
20109 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
20110 other things).
20111
20112 @subsubheading Example
20113 N.A.
20114
20115
20116 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
20117 @findex -target-list-parameters
20118
20119 @subsubheading Synopsis
20120
20121 @smallexample
20122 -target-list-parameters
20123 @end smallexample
20124
20125 @c ????
20126
20127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20128
20129 No equivalent.
20130
20131 @subsubheading Example
20132 N.A.
20133
20134
20135 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
20136 @findex -target-select
20137
20138 @subsubheading Synopsis
20139
20140 @smallexample
20141 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
20142 @end smallexample
20143
20144 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
20145
20146 @table @samp
20147 @item @var{type}
20148 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
20149 @item @var{parameters}
20150 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
20151 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
20152 @end table
20153
20154 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
20155 which the target program is, in the following form:
20156
20157 @smallexample
20158 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
20159 args=[@var{arg list}]
20160 @end smallexample
20161
20162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20163
20164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
20165
20166 @subsubheading Example
20167
20168 @smallexample
20169 (@value{GDBP})
20170 -target-select async /dev/ttya
20171 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
20172 (@value{GDBP})
20173 @end smallexample
20174
20175 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20176 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
20177 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
20178
20179
20180 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
20181 @findex -thread-info
20182
20183 @subsubheading Synopsis
20184
20185 @smallexample
20186 -thread-info
20187 @end smallexample
20188
20189 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20190
20191 No equivalent.
20192
20193 @subsubheading Example
20194 N.A.
20195
20196
20197 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
20198 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
20199
20200 @subsubheading Synopsis
20201
20202 @smallexample
20203 -thread-list-all-threads
20204 @end smallexample
20205
20206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20207
20208 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
20209
20210 @subsubheading Example
20211 N.A.
20212
20213
20214 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
20215 @findex -thread-list-ids
20216
20217 @subsubheading Synopsis
20218
20219 @smallexample
20220 -thread-list-ids
20221 @end smallexample
20222
20223 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
20224 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
20225
20226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20227
20228 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
20229
20230 @subsubheading Example
20231
20232 No threads present, besides the main process:
20233
20234 @smallexample
20235 (@value{GDBP})
20236 -thread-list-ids
20237 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
20238 (@value{GDBP})
20239 @end smallexample
20240
20241
20242 Several threads:
20243
20244 @smallexample
20245 (@value{GDBP})
20246 -thread-list-ids
20247 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20248 number-of-threads="3"
20249 (@value{GDBP})
20250 @end smallexample
20251
20252
20253 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
20254 @findex -thread-select
20255
20256 @subsubheading Synopsis
20257
20258 @smallexample
20259 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
20260 @end smallexample
20261
20262 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
20263 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
20264
20265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20266
20267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
20268
20269 @subsubheading Example
20270
20271 @smallexample
20272 (@value{GDBP})
20273 -exec-next
20274 ^running
20275 (@value{GDBP})
20276 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
20277 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
20278 (@value{GDBP})
20279 -thread-list-ids
20280 ^done,
20281 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20282 number-of-threads="3"
20283 (@value{GDBP})
20284 -thread-select 3
20285 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
20286 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
20287 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
20288 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
20289 (@value{GDBP})
20290 @end smallexample
20291
20292 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20293 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20294 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20295
20296 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20297
20298 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20299
20300 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20301
20302 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20303
20304 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20305
20306 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20307
20308 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20309
20310 @c @subheading -trace-find
20311
20312 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20313
20314 @c @subheading -trace-info
20315
20316 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20317
20318 @c @subheading -trace-list
20319
20320 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20321
20322 @c @subheading -trace-save
20323
20324 @c @subheading -trace-start
20325
20326 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20327
20328
20329 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20330 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
20331 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
20332
20333
20334 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20335
20336 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
20337 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
20338 used by @code{Insight}.
20339
20340 The two main reasons for that are:
20341
20342 @enumerate 1
20343 @item
20344 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
20345
20346 @item
20347 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
20348 now).
20349 @end enumerate
20350
20351 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
20352 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
20353 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
20354 hints about their use.
20355
20356 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
20357 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
20358 least, the following operations:
20359
20360 @itemize @bullet
20361 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
20362 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
20363 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
20364 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
20365 @end itemize
20366
20367 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20368
20369 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20370 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
20371 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
20372 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
20373 examining or changing its properties.
20374
20375 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
20376 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
20377 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
20378 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
20379 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
20380
20381 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
20382 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
20383 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
20384 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
20385 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20386 for pointers, etc.).
20387
20388 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20389 access this functionality:
20390
20391 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20392 @item @strong{Operation}
20393 @tab @strong{Description}
20394
20395 @item @code{-var-create}
20396 @tab create a variable object
20397 @item @code{-var-delete}
20398 @tab delete the variable object and its children
20399 @item @code{-var-set-format}
20400 @tab set the display format of this variable
20401 @item @code{-var-show-format}
20402 @tab show the display format of this variable
20403 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20404 @tab tells how many children this object has
20405 @item @code{-var-list-children}
20406 @tab return a list of the object's children
20407 @item @code{-var-info-type}
20408 @tab show the type of this variable object
20409 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
20410 @tab print what this variable object represents
20411 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20412 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20413 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20414 @tab get the value of this variable
20415 @item @code{-var-assign}
20416 @tab set the value of this variable
20417 @item @code{-var-update}
20418 @tab update the variable and its children
20419 @end multitable
20420
20421 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20422 how it can be used.
20423
20424 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20425
20426 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20427 @findex -var-create
20428
20429 @subsubheading Synopsis
20430
20431 @smallexample
20432 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20433 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20434 @end smallexample
20435
20436 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20437 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20438 register.
20439
20440 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20441 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20442 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20443 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20444 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20445
20446 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20447 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20448 frame should be used.
20449
20450 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20451 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20452
20453 @itemize @bullet
20454 @item
20455 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20456
20457 @item
20458 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20459
20460 @item
20461 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20462 @end itemize
20463
20464 @subsubheading Result
20465
20466 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20467 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20468 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20469
20470 @smallexample
20471 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20472 @end smallexample
20473
20474
20475 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20476 @findex -var-delete
20477
20478 @subsubheading Synopsis
20479
20480 @smallexample
20481 -var-delete @var{name}
20482 @end smallexample
20483
20484 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20485
20486 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20487
20488
20489 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20490 @findex -var-set-format
20491
20492 @subsubheading Synopsis
20493
20494 @smallexample
20495 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20496 @end smallexample
20497
20498 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20499 @var{format-spec}.
20500
20501 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20502
20503 @smallexample
20504 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20505 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20506 @end smallexample
20507
20508
20509 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20510 @findex -var-show-format
20511
20512 @subsubheading Synopsis
20513
20514 @smallexample
20515 -var-show-format @var{name}
20516 @end smallexample
20517
20518 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20519
20520 @smallexample
20521 @var{format} @expansion{}
20522 @var{format-spec}
20523 @end smallexample
20524
20525
20526 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20527 @findex -var-info-num-children
20528
20529 @subsubheading Synopsis
20530
20531 @smallexample
20532 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20533 @end smallexample
20534
20535 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20536
20537 @smallexample
20538 numchild=@var{n}
20539 @end smallexample
20540
20541
20542 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20543 @findex -var-list-children
20544
20545 @subsubheading Synopsis
20546
20547 @smallexample
20548 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20549 @end smallexample
20550 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20551
20552 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20553 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20554 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20555 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20556 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20557 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20558 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20559 and unions.
20560
20561 @subsubheading Example
20562
20563 @smallexample
20564 (@value{GDBP})
20565 -var-list-children n
20566 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20567 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20568 (@value{GDBP})
20569 -var-list-children --all-values n
20570 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20571 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20572 @end smallexample
20573
20574
20575 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20576 @findex -var-info-type
20577
20578 @subsubheading Synopsis
20579
20580 @smallexample
20581 -var-info-type @var{name}
20582 @end smallexample
20583
20584 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20585 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20586 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20587
20588 @smallexample
20589 type=@var{typename}
20590 @end smallexample
20591
20592
20593 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20594 @findex -var-info-expression
20595
20596 @subsubheading Synopsis
20597
20598 @smallexample
20599 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20600 @end smallexample
20601
20602 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
20603
20604 @smallexample
20605 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
20606 @end smallexample
20607
20608 @noindent
20609 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20610
20611 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20612 @findex -var-show-attributes
20613
20614 @subsubheading Synopsis
20615
20616 @smallexample
20617 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20618 @end smallexample
20619
20620 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20621
20622 @smallexample
20623 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20624 @end smallexample
20625
20626 @noindent
20627 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20628
20629 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20630 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20631
20632 @subsubheading Synopsis
20633
20634 @smallexample
20635 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
20636 @end smallexample
20637
20638 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20639 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
20640 for the object:
20641
20642 @smallexample
20643 value=@var{value}
20644 @end smallexample
20645
20646 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20647 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20648
20649 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20650 @findex -var-assign
20651
20652 @subsubheading Synopsis
20653
20654 @smallexample
20655 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20656 @end smallexample
20657
20658 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20659 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20660 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20661 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20662
20663 @subsubheading Example
20664
20665 @smallexample
20666 (@value{GDBP})
20667 -var-assign var1 3
20668 ^done,value="3"
20669 (@value{GDBP})
20670 -var-update *
20671 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20672 (@value{GDBP})
20673 @end smallexample
20674
20675 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20676 @findex -var-update
20677
20678 @subsubheading Synopsis
20679
20680 @smallexample
20681 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20682 @end smallexample
20683
20684 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
20685 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
20686 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated. The
20687 option @var{print-values} determines whether names both and values, or
20688 just names are printed in the manner described for
20689 @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).
20690
20691 @subsubheading Example
20692
20693 @smallexample
20694 (@value{GDBP})
20695 -var-assign var1 3
20696 ^done,value="3"
20697 (@value{GDBP})
20698 -var-update --all-values var1
20699 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20700 type_changed="false"@}]
20701 (@value{GDBP})
20702 @end smallexample
20703
20704 @node Annotations
20705 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
20706
20707 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
20708 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
20709 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
20710 relatively high level.
20711
20712 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
20713 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
20714
20715 @ignore
20716 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
20717 @end ignore
20718
20719 @menu
20720 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
20721 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
20722 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
20723 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
20724 * Annotations for Running::
20725 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
20726 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
20727 @end menu
20728
20729 @node Annotations Overview
20730 @section What is an Annotation?
20731 @cindex annotations
20732
20733 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
20734 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
20735 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
20736 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
20737 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
20738 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
20739 cannot contain newline characters.
20740
20741 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
20742 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
20743 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
20744 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
20745 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
20746 means those three characters as output.
20747
20748 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
20749 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
20750 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
20751 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
20752 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
20753 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
20754 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
20755 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
20756 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
20757
20758 @table @code
20759 @kindex set annotate
20760 @item set annotate @var{level}
20761 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
20762 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
20763
20764 @item show annotate
20765 @kindex show annotate
20766 Show the current annotation level.
20767 @end table
20768
20769 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
20770
20771 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
20772
20773 @smallexample
20774 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
20775 GNU gdb 6.0
20776 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
20777 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
20778 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
20779 under certain conditions.
20780 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
20781 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
20782 for details.
20783 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
20784
20785 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
20786 (@value{GDBP})
20787 ^Z^Zprompt
20788 @kbd{quit}
20789
20790 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
20791 $
20792 @end smallexample
20793
20794 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
20795 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
20796 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
20797 output from @value{GDBN}.
20798
20799 @node Prompting
20800 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
20801
20802 @cindex annotations for prompts
20803 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
20804 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
20805 over, etc.
20806
20807 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
20808 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
20809 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
20810 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
20811 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
20812 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
20813 features the following annotations:
20814
20815 @smallexample
20816 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
20817 ^Z^Zprompt
20818 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
20819 @end smallexample
20820
20821 The input types are
20822
20823 @table @code
20824 @findex pre-prompt
20825 @findex prompt
20826 @findex post-prompt
20827 @item prompt
20828 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
20829
20830 @findex pre-commands
20831 @findex commands
20832 @findex post-commands
20833 @item commands
20834 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
20835 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
20836
20837 @findex pre-overload-choice
20838 @findex overload-choice
20839 @findex post-overload-choice
20840 @item overload-choice
20841 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
20842
20843 @findex pre-query
20844 @findex query
20845 @findex post-query
20846 @item query
20847 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
20848
20849 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
20850 @findex prompt-for-continue
20851 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
20852 @item prompt-for-continue
20853 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
20854 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
20855 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
20856 presence of annotations.
20857 @end table
20858
20859 @node Errors
20860 @section Errors
20861 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
20862
20863 @findex quit
20864 @smallexample
20865 ^Z^Zquit
20866 @end smallexample
20867
20868 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
20869
20870 @findex error
20871 @smallexample
20872 ^Z^Zerror
20873 @end smallexample
20874
20875 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
20876
20877 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
20878 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
20879 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
20880 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
20881 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
20882 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
20883 to the top level.
20884
20885 @findex error-begin
20886 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
20887
20888 @smallexample
20889 ^Z^Zerror-begin
20890 @end smallexample
20891
20892 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
20893 message.
20894
20895 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
20896 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
20897 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
20898
20899 @node Invalidation
20900 @section Invalidation Notices
20901
20902 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
20903 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
20904 changed.
20905
20906 @table @code
20907 @findex frames-invalid
20908 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
20909
20910 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
20911 have changed.
20912
20913 @findex breakpoints-invalid
20914 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
20915
20916 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
20917 deleted a breakpoint.
20918 @end table
20919
20920 @node Annotations for Running
20921 @section Running the Program
20922 @cindex annotations for running programs
20923
20924 @findex starting
20925 @findex stopping
20926 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
20927 @code{step} or @code{continue},
20928
20929 @smallexample
20930 ^Z^Zstarting
20931 @end smallexample
20932
20933 is output. When the program stops,
20934
20935 @smallexample
20936 ^Z^Zstopped
20937 @end smallexample
20938
20939 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
20940 annotations describe how the program stopped.
20941
20942 @table @code
20943 @findex exited
20944 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
20945 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
20946 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
20947
20948 @findex signalled
20949 @findex signal-name
20950 @findex signal-name-end
20951 @findex signal-string
20952 @findex signal-string-end
20953 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
20954 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
20955 annotation continues:
20956
20957 @smallexample
20958 @var{intro-text}
20959 ^Z^Zsignal-name
20960 @var{name}
20961 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
20962 @var{middle-text}
20963 ^Z^Zsignal-string
20964 @var{string}
20965 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
20966 @var{end-text}
20967 @end smallexample
20968
20969 @noindent
20970 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
20971 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
20972 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
20973 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
20974 user's benefit and have no particular format.
20975
20976 @findex signal
20977 @item ^Z^Zsignal
20978 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
20979 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
20980 terminated with it.
20981
20982 @findex breakpoint
20983 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
20984 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
20985
20986 @findex watchpoint
20987 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
20988 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
20989 @end table
20990
20991 @node Source Annotations
20992 @section Displaying Source
20993 @cindex annotations for source display
20994
20995 @findex source
20996 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
20997
20998 @smallexample
20999 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21000 @end smallexample
21001
21002 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21003 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21004 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21005 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21006 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21007 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21008 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21009 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21010 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21011 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21012 depend on the language).
21013
21014 @node GDB Bugs
21015 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21016 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21017 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21018
21019 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21020
21021 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21022 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21023 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21024 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21025
21026 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21027 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21028
21029 @menu
21030 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21031 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21032 @end menu
21033
21034 @node Bug Criteria
21035 @section Have you found a bug?
21036 @cindex bug criteria
21037
21038 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21039
21040 @itemize @bullet
21041 @cindex fatal signal
21042 @cindex debugger crash
21043 @cindex crash of debugger
21044 @item
21045 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21046 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21047
21048 @cindex error on valid input
21049 @item
21050 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21051 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21052 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21053
21054 @cindex invalid input
21055 @item
21056 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21057 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21058 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21059 for traditional practice''.
21060
21061 @item
21062 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21063 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21064 @end itemize
21065
21066 @node Bug Reporting
21067 @section How to report bugs
21068 @cindex bug reports
21069 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21070
21071 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21072 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21073 contact that organization first.
21074
21075 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21076 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21077 distribution.
21078 @c should add a web page ref...
21079
21080 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21081 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21082 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21083 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21084 be used.
21085
21086 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21087 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21088 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21089 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21090
21091 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21092 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21093 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21094 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21095 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21096 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21097 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21098 bug reports to the mailing list.
21099
21100 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21101 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21102 fact or leave it out, state it!
21103
21104 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21105 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21106 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21107 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21108 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21109 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21110 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21111 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21112 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21113
21114 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21115 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21116 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21117 self-contained.
21118
21119 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21120 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21121 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21122 bugs properly.
21123
21124 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21125
21126 @itemize @bullet
21127 @item
21128 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21129 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21130 version}.
21131
21132 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21133 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21134
21135 @item
21136 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21137 version number.
21138
21139 @item
21140 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
21141 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21142
21143 @item
21144 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21145 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21146 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21147 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21148 compilers.
21149
21150 @item
21151 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21152 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21153 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21154 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21155
21156 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21157 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21158
21159 @item
21160 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21161 reproduce the bug.
21162
21163 @item
21164 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21165 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21166
21167 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21168 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21169 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21170 a chance to make a mistake.
21171
21172 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21173 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21174 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21175 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21176 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21177 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21178 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21179 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21180
21181 @pindex script
21182 @cindex recording a session script
21183 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21184 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21185 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21186 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21187
21188 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21189 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21190
21191 @item
21192 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21193 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21194 it by context, not by line number.
21195
21196 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21197 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21198
21199 @end itemize
21200
21201 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21202
21203 @itemize @bullet
21204 @item
21205 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21206
21207 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21208 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21209 changes will not affect it.
21210
21211 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21212 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21213 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21214 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21215
21216 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21217 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21218 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21219 less time, and so on.
21220
21221 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21222 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21223
21224 @item
21225 A patch for the bug.
21226
21227 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21228 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21229 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21230 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21231
21232 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21233 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21234 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21235 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21236
21237 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21238 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21239 help us to understand.
21240
21241 @item
21242 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21243
21244 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21245 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21246 @end itemize
21247
21248 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21249 @c and consists of the two following files:
21250 @c rluser.texinfo
21251 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21252 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21253 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21254 @include rluser.texinfo
21255 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21256
21257
21258 @node Formatting Documentation
21259 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21260
21261 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21262 @cindex reference card
21263 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21264 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21265 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21266 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21267 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21268 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21269
21270 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21271 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21272
21273 @smallexample
21274 make refcard.dvi
21275 @end smallexample
21276
21277 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21278 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21279 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21280 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21281 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21282
21283 @cindex documentation
21284
21285 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21286 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21287 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21288 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21289 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21290 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21291
21292 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21293 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21294 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21295 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21296 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21297 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21298 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21299 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21300
21301 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21302 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21303 @code{makeinfo}.
21304
21305 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21306 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21307 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21308
21309 @smallexample
21310 cd gdb
21311 make gdb.info
21312 @end smallexample
21313
21314 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21315 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21316 Texinfo definitions file.
21317
21318 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21319 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21320 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21321 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21322 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21323 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21324 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21325
21326 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21327 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21328 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21329 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21330 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21331 directory.
21332
21333 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
21334 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
21335 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
21336 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
21337
21338 @smallexample
21339 make gdb.dvi
21340 @end smallexample
21341
21342 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
21343
21344 @node Installing GDB
21345 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
21346 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
21347 @cindex installation
21348 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
21349
21350 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
21351 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
21352 build the @code{gdb} program.
21353 @iftex
21354 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
21355 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
21356 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
21357 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
21358 @end iftex
21359
21360 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
21361 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
21362 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
21363
21364 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
21365 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
21366
21367 @table @code
21368 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
21369 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
21370
21371 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
21372 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
21373
21374 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
21375 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
21376
21377 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
21378 @sc{gnu} include files
21379
21380 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
21381 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
21382
21383 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
21384 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
21385
21386 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
21387 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
21388
21389 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
21390 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
21391
21392 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
21393 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
21394 @end table
21395
21396 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
21397 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
21398 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
21399
21400 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
21401 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
21402 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
21403 argument.
21404
21405 For example:
21406
21407 @smallexample
21408 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21409 ./configure @var{host}
21410 make
21411 @end smallexample
21412
21413 @noindent
21414 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
21415 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
21416 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
21417 correct value by examining your system.)
21418
21419 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
21420 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
21421 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
21422 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
21423
21424 @need 750
21425 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
21426 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
21427 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
21428
21429 @smallexample
21430 sh configure @var{host}
21431 @end smallexample
21432
21433 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
21434 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
21435 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
21436 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
21437 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
21438
21439 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
21440 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
21441 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
21442 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
21443 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
21444 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
21445 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
21446 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
21447 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21448
21449 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
21450 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
21451 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
21452 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
21453 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
21454
21455 @menu
21456 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21457 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
21458 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
21459 @end menu
21460
21461 @node Separate Objdir
21462 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21463
21464 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
21465 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
21466 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
21467 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
21468 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
21469 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
21470 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
21471 program specified there.
21472
21473 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
21474 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
21475 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
21476 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
21477 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
21478 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
21479
21480 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
21481 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
21482
21483 @smallexample
21484 @group
21485 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21486 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
21487 cd ../gdb-sun4
21488 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
21489 make
21490 @end group
21491 @end smallexample
21492
21493 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
21494 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
21495 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
21496 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
21497 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
21498 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
21499
21500 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
21501 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
21502 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
21503 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
21504 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21505
21506 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
21507 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
21508 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
21509 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
21510 You specify a cross-debugging target by
21511 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
21512
21513 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
21514 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
21515 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
21516
21517 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
21518 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
21519 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
21520 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
21521 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
21522
21523 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
21524 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
21525 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
21526 with each other.
21527
21528 @node Config Names
21529 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
21530
21531 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
21532 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
21533 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
21534 of information in the following pattern:
21535
21536 @smallexample
21537 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
21538 @end smallexample
21539
21540 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
21541 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
21542 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
21543
21544 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
21545 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
21546 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
21547 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
21548 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
21549 abbreviations---for example:
21550
21551 @smallexample
21552 % sh config.sub i386-linux
21553 i386-pc-linux-gnu
21554 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
21555 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
21556 % sh config.sub hp9k700
21557 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
21558 % sh config.sub sun4
21559 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
21560 % sh config.sub sun3
21561 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
21562 % sh config.sub i986v
21563 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
21564 @end smallexample
21565
21566 @noindent
21567 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
21568 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
21569
21570 @node Configure Options
21571 @section @code{configure} options
21572
21573 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
21574 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
21575 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
21576 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
21577
21578 @smallexample
21579 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
21580 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
21581 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
21582 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
21583 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
21584 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
21585 @var{host}
21586 @end smallexample
21587
21588 @noindent
21589 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
21590 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
21591 @samp{--}.
21592
21593 @table @code
21594 @item --help
21595 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
21596
21597 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
21598 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
21599 @file{@var{dir}}.
21600
21601 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
21602 Configure the source to install programs under directory
21603 @file{@var{dir}}.
21604
21605 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
21606 @need 2000
21607 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
21608 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
21609 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
21610 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
21611 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
21612 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
21613 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
21614 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
21615 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
21616 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
21617 @var{dirname}.
21618
21619 @item --norecursion
21620 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
21621 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
21622
21623 @item --target=@var{target}
21624 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
21625 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
21626 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
21627
21628 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
21629
21630 @item @var{host} @dots{}
21631 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
21632
21633 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
21634 @end table
21635
21636 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
21637 needed for special purposes only.
21638
21639 @node Maintenance Commands
21640 @appendix Maintenance Commands
21641 @cindex maintenance commands
21642 @cindex internal commands
21643
21644 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
21645 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
21646 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
21647 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
21648 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
21649
21650 @table @code
21651 @kindex maint agent
21652 @item maint agent @var{expression}
21653 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
21654 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
21655 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
21656
21657 @kindex maint info breakpoints
21658 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
21659 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
21660 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
21661 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
21662 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
21663 is shown:
21664
21665 @table @code
21666 @item breakpoint
21667 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
21668
21669 @item watchpoint
21670 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
21671
21672 @item longjmp
21673 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
21674 @code{longjmp} calls.
21675
21676 @item longjmp resume
21677 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
21678
21679 @item until
21680 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
21681
21682 @item finish
21683 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
21684
21685 @item shlib events
21686 Shared library events.
21687
21688 @end table
21689
21690 @kindex maint check-symtabs
21691 @item maint check-symtabs
21692 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
21693
21694 @kindex maint cplus first_component
21695 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
21696 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
21697
21698 @kindex maint cplus namespace
21699 @item maint cplus namespace
21700 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
21701
21702 @kindex maint demangle
21703 @item maint demangle @var{name}
21704 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
21705
21706 @kindex maint deprecate
21707 @kindex maint undeprecate
21708 @cindex deprecated commands
21709 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
21710 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
21711 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
21712 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
21713 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
21714 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
21715 the replacement as part of the warning.
21716
21717 @kindex maint dump-me
21718 @item maint dump-me
21719 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
21720 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
21721 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
21722 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
21723
21724 @kindex maint internal-error
21725 @kindex maint internal-warning
21726 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
21727 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
21728 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
21729 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
21730 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
21731 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
21732 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
21733 @value{GDBN} session.
21734
21735 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
21736 used as the text of the error or warning message.
21737
21738 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
21739
21740 @smallexample
21741 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
21742 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
21743 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
21744 debugging may prove unreliable.
21745 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
21746 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
21747 (@value{GDBP})
21748 @end smallexample
21749
21750 @kindex maint packet
21751 @item maint packet @var{text}
21752 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
21753 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
21754 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
21755 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
21756 checksum.
21757
21758 @kindex maint print architecture
21759 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21760 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
21761 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
21762
21763 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
21764 @item maint print dummy-frames
21765 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
21766
21767 @smallexample
21768 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
21769 @dots{}
21770 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
21771 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
21772 58 return (a + b);
21773 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
21774 @dots{}
21775 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
21776 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
21777 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
21778 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
21779 (@value{GDBP})
21780 @end smallexample
21781
21782 Takes an optional file parameter.
21783
21784 @kindex maint print registers
21785 @kindex maint print raw-registers
21786 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
21787 @kindex maint print register-groups
21788 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21789 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21790 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21791 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21792 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
21793
21794 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
21795 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
21796 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
21797 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
21798 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
21799 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
21800
21801 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
21802 write the information.
21803
21804 @kindex maint print reggroups
21805 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21806 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
21807 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
21808 information.
21809
21810 The register groups info looks like this:
21811
21812 @smallexample
21813 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
21814 Group Type
21815 general user
21816 float user
21817 all user
21818 vector user
21819 system user
21820 save internal
21821 restore internal
21822 @end smallexample
21823
21824 @kindex flushregs
21825 @item flushregs
21826 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
21827
21828 @kindex maint print objfiles
21829 @cindex info for known object files
21830 @item maint print objfiles
21831 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
21832 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
21833 and symtabs.
21834
21835 @kindex maint print statistics
21836 @cindex bcache statistics
21837 @item maint print statistics
21838 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
21839 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
21840 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
21841 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
21842 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
21843 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
21844 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
21845 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
21846 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
21847 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
21848 lengths.
21849
21850 @kindex maint print type
21851 @cindex type chain of a data type
21852 @item maint print type @var{expr}
21853 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
21854 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
21855 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
21856 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
21857 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
21858
21859 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
21860 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
21861 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
21862 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
21863 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
21864
21865 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
21866 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
21867 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
21868 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
21869 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
21870 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
21871 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
21872 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
21873 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
21874
21875 @kindex maint set profile
21876 @kindex maint show profile
21877 @cindex profiling GDB
21878 @item maint set profile
21879 @itemx maint show profile
21880 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
21881
21882 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
21883 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
21884 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
21885 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
21886 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
21887 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
21888 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
21889
21890 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
21891 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
21892
21893 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
21894 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
21895 @item maint show-debug-regs
21896 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
21897 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
21898 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
21899 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
21900 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
21901
21902 @kindex maint space
21903 @cindex memory used by commands
21904 @item maint space
21905 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
21906 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
21907 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
21908 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
21909 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
21910
21911 @kindex maint time
21912 @cindex time of command execution
21913 @item maint time
21914 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
21915 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
21916 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
21917 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
21918 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
21919
21920 @kindex maint translate-address
21921 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
21922 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
21923 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
21924 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
21925 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
21926 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
21927 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
21928
21929 @end table
21930
21931 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
21932 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
21933
21934 @table @code
21935 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
21936 @kindex set watchdog
21937 @cindex watchdog timer
21938 @cindex timeout for commands
21939 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
21940 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
21941 reports and error and the command is aborted.
21942
21943 @item show watchdog
21944 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
21945 @end table
21946
21947 @node Remote Protocol
21948 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
21949
21950 @menu
21951 * Overview::
21952 * Packets::
21953 * Stop Reply Packets::
21954 * General Query Packets::
21955 * Register Packet Format::
21956 * Examples::
21957 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
21958 @end menu
21959
21960 @node Overview
21961 @section Overview
21962
21963 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
21964 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
21965 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
21966 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
21967
21968 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
21969 transmitted and received data respectfully.
21970
21971 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
21972 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
21973 @cindex remote serial protocol
21974 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
21975 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
21976 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
21977 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
21978
21979 @smallexample
21980 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
21981 @end smallexample
21982 @noindent
21983
21984 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
21985 @noindent
21986 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
21987 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
21988 eight bit unsigned checksum).
21989
21990 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
21991 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
21992
21993 @smallexample
21994 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
21995 @end smallexample
21996
21997 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
21998 @noindent
21999 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22000 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22001 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22002
22003 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22004 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22005 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22006 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22007 retransmission):
22008
22009 @smallexample
22010 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22011 <- @code{+}
22012 @end smallexample
22013 @noindent
22014
22015 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22016 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22017 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22018 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22019
22020 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22021 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22022 exceptions).
22023
22024 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22025 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22026 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22027 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22028
22029 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22030 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22031 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22032
22033 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22034 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22035 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22036 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22037 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22038 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22039 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22040
22041 So:
22042 @smallexample
22043 "@code{0* }"
22044 @end smallexample
22045 @noindent
22046 means the same as "0000".
22047
22048 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22049 error number. That number is not well defined.
22050
22051 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22052 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22053 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22054 on that response.
22055
22056 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22057 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22058 optional.
22059
22060 @node Packets
22061 @section Packets
22062
22063 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22064 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22065 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22066 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22067
22068 @table @r
22069
22070 @item @code{!} --- extended mode
22071 @cindex @code{!} packet
22072
22073 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22074 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22075 debugged.
22076
22077 Reply:
22078 @table @samp
22079 @item OK
22080 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22081 @end table
22082
22083 @item @code{?} --- last signal
22084 @cindex @code{?} packet
22085
22086 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22087 step and continue.
22088
22089 Reply:
22090 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22091
22092 @item @code{a} --- reserved
22093
22094 Reserved for future use.
22095
22096 @item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
22097 @cindex @code{A} packet
22098
22099 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22100 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
22101 See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22102
22103 Reply:
22104 @table @samp
22105 @item OK
22106 @item E@var{NN}
22107 @end table
22108
22109 @item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
22110 @cindex @code{b} packet
22111
22112 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22113
22114 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22115 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22116 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22117
22118 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22119 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22120 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22121 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22122 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22123
22124 @item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
22125 @cindex @code{B} packet
22126
22127 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22128 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22129
22130 This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
22131 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22132
22133 @item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
22134 @cindex @code{c} packet
22135
22136 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
22137 current address.
22138
22139 Reply:
22140 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22141
22142 @item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
22143 @cindex @code{C} packet
22144
22145 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22146 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
22147
22148 Reply:
22149 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22150
22151 @item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
22152 @cindex @code{d} packet
22153
22154 Toggle debug flag.
22155
22156 @item @code{D} --- detach
22157 @cindex @code{D} packet
22158
22159 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22160 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22161
22162 Reply:
22163 @table @samp
22164 @item OK
22165 for success
22166 @item E@var{NN}
22167 for an error
22168 @end table
22169
22170 @item @code{e} --- reserved
22171
22172 Reserved for future use.
22173
22174 @item @code{E} --- reserved
22175
22176 Reserved for future use.
22177
22178 @item @code{f} --- reserved
22179
22180 Reserved for future use.
22181
22182 @item @code{F}@var{RC}@code{,}@var{EE}@code{,}@var{CF}@code{;}@var{XX} --- Reply to target's F packet.
22183 @cindex @code{F} packet
22184
22185 This packet is send by @value{GDBN} as reply to a @code{F} request packet
22186 sent by the target. This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.
22187 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
22188
22189 @item @code{g} --- read registers
22190 @anchor{read registers packet}
22191 @cindex @code{g} packet
22192
22193 Read general registers.
22194
22195 Reply:
22196 @table @samp
22197 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22198 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22199 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22200 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
22201 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22202 @var{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22203 specification of several standard @code{g} packets is specified below.
22204 @item E@var{NN}
22205 for an error.
22206 @end table
22207
22208 @item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
22209 @cindex @code{G} packet
22210
22211 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
22212 data.
22213
22214 Reply:
22215 @table @samp
22216 @item OK
22217 for success
22218 @item E@var{NN}
22219 for an error
22220 @end table
22221
22222 @item @code{h} --- reserved
22223
22224 Reserved for future use.
22225
22226 @item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
22227 @cindex @code{H} packet
22228
22229 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22230 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22231 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22232 operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
22233 the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
22234
22235 Reply:
22236 @table @samp
22237 @item OK
22238 for success
22239 @item E@var{NN}
22240 for an error
22241 @end table
22242
22243 @c FIXME: JTC:
22244 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22245 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22246 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22247 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22248 @c described. For example:
22249 @c
22250 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22251 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22252 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22253 @c
22254 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22255 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22256 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22257
22258 @item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
22259 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22260 @cindex @code{i} packet
22261
22262 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
22263 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22264 step starting at that address.
22265
22266 @item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
22267 @cindex @code{I} packet
22268
22269 @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
22270
22271 @item @code{j} --- reserved
22272
22273 Reserved for future use.
22274
22275 @item @code{J} --- reserved
22276
22277 Reserved for future use.
22278
22279 @item @code{k} --- kill request
22280 @cindex @code{k} packet
22281
22282 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22283 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22284 thread?)}.
22285
22286 @item @code{K} --- reserved
22287
22288 Reserved for future use.
22289
22290 @item @code{l} --- reserved
22291
22292 Reserved for future use.
22293
22294 @item @code{L} --- reserved
22295
22296 Reserved for future use.
22297
22298 @item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
22299 @cindex @code{m} packet
22300
22301 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22302 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
22303 assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
22304 transfer mechanism is needed.}
22305
22306 Reply:
22307 @table @samp
22308 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22309 @var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
22310 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
22311 that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
22312 accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
22313 needed.}
22314 @item E@var{NN}
22315 @var{NN} is errno
22316 @end table
22317
22318 @item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
22319 @cindex @code{M} packet
22320
22321 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22322 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
22323
22324 Reply:
22325 @table @samp
22326 @item OK
22327 for success
22328 @item E@var{NN}
22329 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
22330 written).
22331 @end table
22332
22333 @item @code{n} --- reserved
22334
22335 Reserved for future use.
22336
22337 @item @code{N} --- reserved
22338
22339 Reserved for future use.
22340
22341 @item @code{o} --- reserved
22342
22343 Reserved for future use.
22344
22345 @item @code{O} --- reserved
22346
22347 @item @code{p}@var{hex number of register} --- read register packet
22348 @cindex @code{p} packet
22349
22350 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
22351 register value is encoded.
22352
22353 Reply:
22354 @table @samp
22355 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22356 the register's value
22357 @item E@var{NN}
22358 for an error
22359 @item
22360 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22361 @end table
22362
22363 @item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
22364 @anchor{write register packet}
22365 @cindex @code{P} packet
22366
22367 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
22368 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
22369
22370 Reply:
22371 @table @samp
22372 @item OK
22373 for success
22374 @item E@var{NN}
22375 for an error
22376 @end table
22377
22378 @item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
22379 @anchor{general query packet}
22380 @cindex @code{q} packet
22381
22382 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
22383 leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
22384 prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
22385 be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
22386 that they match the full @var{query} name.
22387
22388 Reply:
22389 @table @samp
22390 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22391 Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
22392 @item E@var{NN}
22393 error reply
22394 @item
22395 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22396 @end table
22397
22398 @item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
22399 @cindex @code{Q} packet
22400
22401 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
22402
22403 @xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
22404
22405 @item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
22406 @cindex @code{r} packet
22407
22408 Reset the entire system.
22409
22410 @item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
22411 @cindex @code{R} packet
22412
22413 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
22414 This packet is only available in extended mode.
22415
22416 Reply:
22417 @table @samp
22418 @item @emph{no reply}
22419 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
22420 @end table
22421
22422 @item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
22423 @cindex @code{s} packet
22424
22425 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
22426 same address.
22427
22428 Reply:
22429 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22430
22431 @item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
22432 @anchor{step with signal packet}
22433 @cindex @code{S} packet
22434
22435 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
22436
22437 Reply:
22438 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22439
22440 @item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
22441 @cindex @code{t} packet
22442
22443 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
22444 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
22445 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
22446
22447 @item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
22448 @cindex @code{T} packet
22449
22450 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
22451
22452 Reply:
22453 @table @samp
22454 @item OK
22455 thread is still alive
22456 @item E@var{NN}
22457 thread is dead
22458 @end table
22459
22460 @item @code{u} --- reserved
22461
22462 Reserved for future use.
22463
22464 @item @code{U} --- reserved
22465
22466 Reserved for future use.
22467
22468 @item @code{v} --- verbose packet prefix
22469
22470 Packets starting with @code{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
22471 up to the first @code{;} or @code{?} (or the end of the packet).
22472
22473 @item @code{vCont}[;@var{action}[@code{:}@var{tid}]]... --- extended resume
22474 @cindex @code{vCont} packet
22475
22476 Resume the inferior. Different actions may be specified for each thread.
22477 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
22478 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
22479 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
22480 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
22481 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
22482
22483 @table @code
22484 @item c
22485 Continue.
22486 @item C@var{sig}
22487 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22488 @item s
22489 Step.
22490 @item S@var{sig}
22491 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22492 @end table
22493
22494 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
22495 not supported in @code{vCont}.
22496
22497 Reply:
22498 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22499
22500 @item @code{vCont?} --- extended resume query
22501 @cindex @code{vCont?} packet
22502
22503 Query support for the @code{vCont} packet.
22504
22505 Reply:
22506 @table @samp
22507 @item @code{vCont}[;@var{action}]...
22508 The @code{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
22509 command in the @code{vCont} packet.
22510 @item
22511 The @code{vCont} packet is not supported.
22512 @end table
22513
22514 @item @code{V} --- reserved
22515
22516 Reserved for future use.
22517
22518 @item @code{w} --- reserved
22519
22520 Reserved for future use.
22521
22522 @item @code{W} --- reserved
22523
22524 Reserved for future use.
22525
22526 @item @code{x} --- reserved
22527
22528 Reserved for future use.
22529
22530 @item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
22531 @cindex @code{X} packet
22532
22533 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
22534 is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
22535 escaped using @code{0x7d}, and then XORed with @code{0x20}.
22536 For example, @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as @code{0x7d 0x5d}.
22537
22538 Reply:
22539 @table @samp
22540 @item OK
22541 for success
22542 @item E@var{NN}
22543 for an error
22544 @end table
22545
22546 @item @code{y} --- reserved
22547
22548 Reserved for future use.
22549
22550 @item @code{Y} reserved
22551
22552 Reserved for future use.
22553
22554 @item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
22555 @itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
22556 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
22557 @cindex @code{z} packet
22558 @cindex @code{Z} packets
22559
22560 Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
22561 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
22562 @var{length} bytes.
22563
22564 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
22565 separately.
22566
22567 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
22568 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
22569 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
22570 @code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
22571 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
22572 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
22573
22574 @item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
22575 @item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
22576 @cindex @code{z0} packet
22577 @cindex @code{Z0} packet
22578
22579 Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
22580 @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
22581
22582 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
22583 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
22584 @code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
22585 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
22586 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
22587
22588 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
22589 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
22590 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
22591 target, is not defined.}
22592
22593 Reply:
22594 @table @samp
22595 @item OK
22596 success
22597 @item
22598 not supported
22599 @item E@var{NN}
22600 for an error
22601 @end table
22602
22603 @item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
22604 @item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
22605 @cindex @code{z1} packet
22606 @cindex @code{Z1} packet
22607
22608 Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
22609 address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
22610
22611 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
22612 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
22613
22614 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
22615 movement.}
22616
22617 Reply:
22618 @table @samp
22619 @item OK
22620 success
22621 @item
22622 not supported
22623 @item E@var{NN}
22624 for an error
22625 @end table
22626
22627 @item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
22628 @item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
22629 @cindex @code{z2} packet
22630 @cindex @code{Z2} packet
22631
22632 Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
22633
22634 Reply:
22635 @table @samp
22636 @item OK
22637 success
22638 @item
22639 not supported
22640 @item E@var{NN}
22641 for an error
22642 @end table
22643
22644 @item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
22645 @item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
22646 @cindex @code{z3} packet
22647 @cindex @code{Z3} packet
22648
22649 Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
22650
22651 Reply:
22652 @table @samp
22653 @item OK
22654 success
22655 @item
22656 not supported
22657 @item E@var{NN}
22658 for an error
22659 @end table
22660
22661 @item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
22662 @item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
22663 @cindex @code{z4} packet
22664 @cindex @code{Z4} packet
22665
22666 Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
22667
22668 Reply:
22669 @table @samp
22670 @item OK
22671 success
22672 @item
22673 not supported
22674 @item E@var{NN}
22675 for an error
22676 @end table
22677
22678 @end table
22679
22680 @node Stop Reply Packets
22681 @section Stop Reply Packets
22682 @cindex stop reply packets
22683
22684 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
22685 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
22686 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
22687 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
22688 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
22689 conventions is used.
22690
22691 @table @samp
22692
22693 @item S@var{AA}
22694 @var{AA} is the signal number
22695
22696 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
22697 @cindex @code{T} packet reply
22698
22699 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
22700 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
22701 by @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread},
22702 @var{r...} = thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} =
22703 (@samp{watch} | @samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data
22704 address, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting
22705 with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...},
22706 @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can extend the
22707 protocol.
22708
22709 @item W@var{AA}
22710
22711 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
22712 applicable to certain targets.
22713
22714 @item X@var{AA}
22715
22716 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
22717
22718 @item O@var{XX@dots{}}
22719
22720 @var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
22721 any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
22722 to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
22723
22724 @item F@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
22725
22726 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
22727 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
22728 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
22729 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
22730 system calls.
22731
22732 @var{parameter@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for this very
22733 system call.
22734
22735 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to call
22736 a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies with
22737 an appropriate @code{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next reply
22738 packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or
22739 @samp{s} action is expected to be continued.
22740 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for more details.
22741
22742 @end table
22743
22744 @node General Query Packets
22745 @section General Query Packets
22746 @cindex remote query requests
22747
22748 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
22749
22750 @table @r
22751
22752 @item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
22753 @cindex current thread, remote request
22754 @cindex @code{qC} packet
22755 Return the current thread id.
22756
22757 Reply:
22758 @table @samp
22759 @item @code{QC}@var{pid}
22760 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexidecimal process id.
22761 @item *
22762 Any other reply implies the old pid.
22763 @end table
22764
22765 @item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
22766 @cindex list active threads, remote request
22767 @cindex @code{qfThreadInfo} packet
22768 @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
22769
22770 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
22771 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
22772 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
22773 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
22774 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
22775 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
22776
22777 NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
22778
22779 Reply:
22780 @table @samp
22781 @item @code{m}@var{id}
22782 A single thread id
22783 @item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
22784 a comma-separated list of thread ids
22785 @item @code{l}
22786 (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
22787 @end table
22788
22789 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
22790 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
22791 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
22792 ids (using the @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
22793 with @code{l} (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
22794
22795 @item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
22796 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
22797 @cindex @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
22798 Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
22799 string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
22800 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
22801 @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
22802 in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
22803 possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
22804 Mutex''.
22805
22806 Reply:
22807 @table @samp
22808 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22809 Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
22810 the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
22811 attributes.
22812 @end table
22813
22814 @item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
22815
22816 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
22817 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
22818 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
22819 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
22820 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
22821 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
22822
22823 NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
22824 (see above).
22825
22826 Reply:
22827 @table @samp
22828 @item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
22829 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
22830 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
22831 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
22832 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
22833 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
22834 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
22835 @end table
22836
22837 @item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
22838 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
22839 @cindex @code{qCRC} packet
22840 Reply:
22841 @table @samp
22842 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
22843 An error (such as memory fault)
22844 @item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
22845 A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
22846 @end table
22847
22848 @item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
22849 @cindex section offsets, remote request
22850 @cindex @code{qOffsets} packet
22851 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
22852 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
22853 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
22854 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
22855
22856 Reply:
22857 @table @samp
22858 @item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
22859 @end table
22860
22861 @item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
22862 @cindex thread information, remote request
22863 @cindex @code{qP} packet
22864 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
22865 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
22866
22867 Reply:
22868 @table @samp
22869 @item *
22870 @end table
22871
22872 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
22873
22874 @item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
22875 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
22876 @cindex @code{qRcmd} packet
22877 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
22878 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
22879 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
22880 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
22881 @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
22882 interpreter may have security implications}.
22883
22884 Reply:
22885 @table @samp
22886 @item OK
22887 A command response with no output.
22888 @item @var{OUTPUT}
22889 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
22890 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
22891 Indicate a badly formed request.
22892 @item @samp{}
22893 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
22894 @end table
22895 z
22896 @item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
22897 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
22898 @cindex @code{qSymbol} packet
22899 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
22900 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
22901
22902 Reply:
22903 @table @samp
22904 @item @code{OK}
22905 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
22906 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
22907 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
22908 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
22909 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
22910 @end table
22911
22912 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
22913
22914 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
22915
22916 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
22917 target has previously requested.
22918
22919 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
22920 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
22921 will be empty.
22922
22923 Reply:
22924 @table @samp
22925 @item @code{OK}
22926 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
22927 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
22928 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
22929 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
22930 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
22931 @end table
22932
22933 @item @code{qPart}:@var{object}:@code{read}:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} --- read special data
22934 @cindex read special object, remote request
22935 @cindex @code{qPart} packet
22936 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
22937 identified by the keyword @code{object}.
22938 Request @var{length} bytes starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data.
22939 The content and encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object;
22940 it can supply additional details about what data to access.
22941
22942 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far.
22943 All @samp{@code{qPart}:@var{object}:@code{read}:@dots{}}
22944 requests use the same reply formats, listed below.
22945
22946 @table @asis
22947 @item @code{qPart}:@code{auxv}:@code{read}::@var{offset},@var{length}
22948 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
22949 auxiliary vector}, and see @ref{Remote configuration,
22950 read-aux-vector-packet}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
22951 @end table
22952
22953 Reply:
22954 @table @asis
22955 @item @code{OK}
22956 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
22957 There is no more data to be read.
22958
22959 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22960 Hex encoded data bytes read.
22961 This may be fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
22962
22963 @item @code{E00}
22964 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
22965
22966 @item @code{E}@var{nn}
22967 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
22968 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
22969
22970 @item @code{""} (empty)
22971 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} or @var{annex} string was not
22972 recognized by the stub.
22973 @end table
22974
22975 @item @code{qPart}:@var{object}:@code{write}:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data@dots{}}
22976 @cindex write data into object, remote request
22977 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
22978 identified by the keyword @code{object},
22979 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data.
22980 @var{data@dots{}} is the hex-encoded data to be written.
22981 The content and encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object;
22982 it can supply additional details about what data to access.
22983
22984 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
22985 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
22986 specific request specifications ought to use.
22987
22988 Reply:
22989 @table @asis
22990 @item @var{nn}
22991 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
22992 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
22993
22994 @item @code{E00}
22995 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
22996
22997 @item @code{E}@var{nn}
22998 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
22999 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23000
23001 @item @code{""} (empty)
23002 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} or @var{annex} string was not
23003 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
23004 @end table
23005
23006 @item @code{qPart}:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
23007 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
23008 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
23009 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword,
23010 the stub must respond with an empty packet.
23011
23012 @item @code{qGetTLSAddr}:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm} --- get thread local storage address
23013 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23014 @cindex @code{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23015 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23016 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23017
23018 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23019 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23020
23021 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23022 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23023 information associated with the variable.)
23024
23025 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23026 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23027 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23028 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23029 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23030 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23031
23032 Reply:
23033 @table @asis
23034 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23035 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23036 local storage requested.
23037
23038 @item @code{E}@var{nn} (where @var{nn} are hex digits)
23039 An error occurred.
23040
23041 @item @code{""} (empty)
23042 An empty reply indicates that @code{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23043 @end table
23044
23045 Use of this request packet is controlled by the @code{set remote
23046 get-thread-local-storage-address} command (@pxref{Remote
23047 configuration, set remote get-thread-local-storage-address}).
23048
23049 @end table
23050
23051 @node Register Packet Format
23052 @section Register Packet Format
23053
23054 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
23055 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23056 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23057 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
23058 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
23059 most-significant - least-significant.
23060
23061 @table @r
23062
23063 @item MIPS32
23064
23065 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
23066 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
23067 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
23068
23069 @item MIPS64
23070
23071 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
23072 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
23073 as @code{MIPS32}.
23074
23075 @end table
23076
23077 @node Examples
23078 @section Examples
23079
23080 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
23081 does not get any direct output:
23082
23083 @smallexample
23084 -> @code{R00}
23085 <- @code{+}
23086 @emph{target restarts}
23087 -> @code{?}
23088 <- @code{+}
23089 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
23090 -> @code{+}
23091 @end smallexample
23092
23093 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
23094
23095 @smallexample
23096 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
23097 <- @code{+}
23098 -> @code{s}
23099 <- @code{+}
23100 @emph{time passes}
23101 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
23102 -> @code{+}
23103 -> @code{g}
23104 <- @code{+}
23105 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
23106 -> @code{+}
23107 @end smallexample
23108
23109 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
23110 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
23111 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
23112
23113 @menu
23114 * File-I/O Overview::
23115 * Protocol basics::
23116 * The F request packet::
23117 * The F reply packet::
23118 * Memory transfer::
23119 * The Ctrl-C message::
23120 * Console I/O::
23121 * The isatty call::
23122 * The system call::
23123 * List of supported calls::
23124 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
23125 * Constants::
23126 * File-I/O Examples::
23127 @end menu
23128
23129 @node File-I/O Overview
23130 @subsection File-I/O Overview
23131 @cindex file-i/o overview
23132
23133 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
23134 target to use the host's file system and console I/O when calling various
23135 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
23136 remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
23137 actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
23138 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
23139
23140 The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
23141 its own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
23142 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
23143 translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
23144 when data is transmitted.
23145
23146 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
23147 when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
23148 packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
23149 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
23150 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
23151 is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
23152
23153 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
23154 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
23155 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
23156 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
23157 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
23158
23159 @smallexample
23160 (@value{GDBP}) continue
23161 <- target requests 'system call X'
23162 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
23163 -> GDB returns result
23164 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
23165 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
23166 @end smallexample
23167
23168 The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
23169 for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
23170 named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
23171 system are not supported by this protocol.
23172
23173 @node Protocol basics
23174 @subsection Protocol basics
23175 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
23176
23177 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
23178 as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
23179 @value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
23180 File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
23181 of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
23182 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
23183 to call the appropriate host system call:
23184
23185 @itemize @bullet
23186 @item
23187 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
23188
23189 @item
23190 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
23191 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
23192 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
23193 Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
23194
23195 @end itemize
23196
23197 At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
23198
23199 @itemize @bullet
23200 @item
23201 If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
23202 to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
23203 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
23204 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
23205 packet.
23206
23207 @item
23208 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
23209 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
23210
23211 @item
23212 @value{GDBN} calls the system call
23213
23214 @item
23215 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
23216
23217 @item
23218 If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
23219 a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
23220 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
23221 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
23222 packet.
23223
23224 @end itemize
23225
23226 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
23227 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
23228
23229 @itemize @bullet
23230 @item
23231 Return value.
23232
23233 @item
23234 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
23235
23236 @item
23237 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
23238
23239 @end itemize
23240
23241 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
23242 the latest continue or step action.
23243
23244 @node The F request packet
23245 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
23246 @cindex file-i/o request packet
23247 @cindex @code{F} request packet
23248
23249 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
23250
23251 @table @samp
23252
23253 @smallexample
23254 @code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
23255 @end smallexample
23256
23257 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
23258 This is just the name of the function.
23259
23260 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
23261
23262 @end table
23263
23264 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
23265 of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
23266 datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
23267 of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
23268 from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
23269 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
23270
23271 @node The F reply packet
23272 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
23273 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
23274 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
23275
23276 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
23277
23278 @table @samp
23279
23280 @smallexample
23281 @code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
23282 @end smallexample
23283
23284 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
23285
23286 @var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
23287 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
23288
23289 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
23290 case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
23291 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
23292
23293 @smallexample
23294 F0,0,C
23295 @end smallexample
23296
23297 @noindent
23298 or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
23299
23300 @smallexample
23301 F-1,4,C
23302 @end smallexample
23303
23304 @noindent
23305 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
23306
23307 @end table
23308
23309 @node Memory transfer
23310 @subsection Memory transfer
23311 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
23312
23313 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
23314 a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
23315 all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
23316 the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
23317 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
23318 data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
23319
23320 @node The Ctrl-C message
23321 @subsection The Ctrl-C message
23322 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
23323
23324 A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
23325 reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
23326 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
23327 interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
23328 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
23329 packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
23330 state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
23331 not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
23332
23333 @itemize @bullet
23334 @item
23335 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
23336
23337 @item
23338 The system call on the host has been finished.
23339
23340 @end itemize
23341
23342 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
23343 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
23344 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
23345 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
23346 system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
23347 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
23348
23349 @value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
23350 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
23351 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
23352 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
23353 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
23354 The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
23355 or the full action has been completed.
23356
23357 @node Console I/O
23358 @subsection Console I/O
23359 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
23360
23361 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
23362 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
23363 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
23364 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
23365 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
23366 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
23367 conditions is met:
23368
23369 @itemize @bullet
23370 @item
23371 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
23372 @code{read}
23373 system call is treated as finished.
23374
23375 @item
23376 The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
23377 line feed.
23378
23379 @item
23380 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
23381 character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
23382
23383 @end itemize
23384
23385 If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
23386 the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
23387 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
23388 is stopped on users request.
23389
23390 @node The isatty call
23391 @subsection The @samp{isatty} function call
23392 @cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
23393
23394 A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
23395 is implemented as its own call inside of this protocol. It returns
23396 1 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
23397 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
23398 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
23399 needed.
23400
23401 @node The system call
23402 @subsection The @samp{system} function call
23403 @cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
23404
23405 The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
23406 is implemented as its own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
23407 task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
23408 call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
23409 to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
23410 in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
23411 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
23412
23413 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
23414 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
23415 @kbd{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
23416
23417 @table @code
23418 @item set remote system-call-allowed
23419 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
23420 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
23421 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
23422
23423 @item show remote system-call-allowed
23424 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
23425 Show the current setting of system calls for the remote File I/O
23426 protocol.
23427 @end table
23428
23429 @node List of supported calls
23430 @subsection List of supported calls
23431 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
23432
23433 @menu
23434 * open::
23435 * close::
23436 * read::
23437 * write::
23438 * lseek::
23439 * rename::
23440 * unlink::
23441 * stat/fstat::
23442 * gettimeofday::
23443 * isatty::
23444 * system::
23445 @end menu
23446
23447 @node open
23448 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
23449 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
23450
23451 @smallexample
23452 @exdent Synopsis:
23453 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
23454 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
23455
23456 @exdent Request:
23457 Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
23458 @end smallexample
23459
23460 @noindent
23461 @code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
23462
23463 @table @code
23464 @item O_CREAT
23465 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
23466 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
23467 are concerned.
23468
23469 @item O_EXCL
23470 When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
23471 an error and open() fails.
23472
23473 @item O_TRUNC
23474 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
23475 writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
23476 truncated to length 0.
23477
23478 @item O_APPEND
23479 The file is opened in append mode.
23480
23481 @item O_RDONLY
23482 The file is opened for reading only.
23483
23484 @item O_WRONLY
23485 The file is opened for writing only.
23486
23487 @item O_RDWR
23488 The file is opened for reading and writing.
23489
23490 @noindent
23491 Each other bit is silently ignored.
23492
23493 @end table
23494
23495 @noindent
23496 @code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
23497
23498 @table @code
23499 @item S_IRUSR
23500 User has read permission.
23501
23502 @item S_IWUSR
23503 User has write permission.
23504
23505 @item S_IRGRP
23506 Group has read permission.
23507
23508 @item S_IWGRP
23509 Group has write permission.
23510
23511 @item S_IROTH
23512 Others have read permission.
23513
23514 @item S_IWOTH
23515 Others have write permission.
23516
23517 @noindent
23518 Each other bit is silently ignored.
23519
23520 @end table
23521
23522 @smallexample
23523 @exdent Return value:
23524 open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
23525 occured.
23526
23527 @exdent Errors:
23528 @end smallexample
23529
23530 @table @code
23531 @item EEXIST
23532 pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
23533
23534 @item EISDIR
23535 pathname refers to a directory.
23536
23537 @item EACCES
23538 The requested access is not allowed.
23539
23540 @item ENAMETOOLONG
23541 pathname was too long.
23542
23543 @item ENOENT
23544 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
23545
23546 @item ENODEV
23547 pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
23548
23549 @item EROFS
23550 pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
23551 write access was requested.
23552
23553 @item EFAULT
23554 pathname is an invalid pointer value.
23555
23556 @item ENOSPC
23557 No space on device to create the file.
23558
23559 @item EMFILE
23560 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
23561
23562 @item ENFILE
23563 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
23564 has been reached.
23565
23566 @item EINTR
23567 The call was interrupted by the user.
23568 @end table
23569
23570 @node close
23571 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
23572 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
23573
23574 @smallexample
23575 @exdent Synopsis:
23576 int close(int fd);
23577
23578 @exdent Request:
23579 Fclose,fd
23580
23581 @exdent Return value:
23582 close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
23583
23584 @exdent Errors:
23585 @end smallexample
23586
23587 @table @code
23588 @item EBADF
23589 fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
23590
23591 @item EINTR
23592 The call was interrupted by the user.
23593 @end table
23594
23595 @node read
23596 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
23597 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
23598
23599 @smallexample
23600 @exdent Synopsis:
23601 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
23602
23603 @exdent Request:
23604 Fread,fd,bufptr,count
23605
23606 @exdent Return value:
23607 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
23608 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
23609 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
23610
23611 @exdent Errors:
23612 @end smallexample
23613
23614 @table @code
23615 @item EBADF
23616 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
23617 reading.
23618
23619 @item EFAULT
23620 buf is an invalid pointer value.
23621
23622 @item EINTR
23623 The call was interrupted by the user.
23624 @end table
23625
23626 @node write
23627 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
23628 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
23629
23630 @smallexample
23631 @exdent Synopsis:
23632 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
23633
23634 @exdent Request:
23635 Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
23636
23637 @exdent Return value:
23638 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
23639 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
23640 is returned.
23641
23642 @exdent Errors:
23643 @end smallexample
23644
23645 @table @code
23646 @item EBADF
23647 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
23648 writing.
23649
23650 @item EFAULT
23651 buf is an invalid pointer value.
23652
23653 @item EFBIG
23654 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
23655 host specific maximum file size allowed.
23656
23657 @item ENOSPC
23658 No space on device to write the data.
23659
23660 @item EINTR
23661 The call was interrupted by the user.
23662 @end table
23663
23664 @node lseek
23665 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
23666 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
23667
23668 @smallexample
23669 @exdent Synopsis:
23670 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
23671
23672 @exdent Request:
23673 Flseek,fd,offset,flag
23674 @end smallexample
23675
23676 @code{flag} is one of:
23677
23678 @table @code
23679 @item SEEK_SET
23680 The offset is set to offset bytes.
23681
23682 @item SEEK_CUR
23683 The offset is set to its current location plus offset
23684 bytes.
23685
23686 @item SEEK_END
23687 The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
23688 bytes.
23689 @end table
23690
23691 @smallexample
23692 @exdent Return value:
23693 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
23694 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
23695 value of -1 is returned.
23696
23697 @exdent Errors:
23698 @end smallexample
23699
23700 @table @code
23701 @item EBADF
23702 fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
23703
23704 @item ESPIPE
23705 fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
23706
23707 @item EINVAL
23708 flag is not a proper value.
23709
23710 @item EINTR
23711 The call was interrupted by the user.
23712 @end table
23713
23714 @node rename
23715 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
23716 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
23717
23718 @smallexample
23719 @exdent Synopsis:
23720 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
23721
23722 @exdent Request:
23723 Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
23724
23725 @exdent Return value:
23726 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
23727
23728 @exdent Errors:
23729 @end smallexample
23730
23731 @table @code
23732 @item EISDIR
23733 newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
23734 directory.
23735
23736 @item EEXIST
23737 newpath is a non-empty directory.
23738
23739 @item EBUSY
23740 oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
23741 process.
23742
23743 @item EINVAL
23744 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
23745 of itself.
23746
23747 @item ENOTDIR
23748 A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
23749 path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
23750 and newpath exists but is not a directory.
23751
23752 @item EFAULT
23753 oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
23754
23755 @item EACCES
23756 No access to the file or the path of the file.
23757
23758 @item ENAMETOOLONG
23759
23760 oldpath or newpath was too long.
23761
23762 @item ENOENT
23763 A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
23764
23765 @item EROFS
23766 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
23767
23768 @item ENOSPC
23769 The device containing the file has no room for the new
23770 directory entry.
23771
23772 @item EINTR
23773 The call was interrupted by the user.
23774 @end table
23775
23776 @node unlink
23777 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
23778 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
23779
23780 @smallexample
23781 @exdent Synopsis:
23782 int unlink(const char *pathname);
23783
23784 @exdent Request:
23785 Funlink,pathnameptr/len
23786
23787 @exdent Return value:
23788 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
23789
23790 @exdent Errors:
23791 @end smallexample
23792
23793 @table @code
23794 @item EACCES
23795 No access to the file or the path of the file.
23796
23797 @item EPERM
23798 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
23799
23800 @item EBUSY
23801 The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
23802 being used by another process.
23803
23804 @item EFAULT
23805 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
23806
23807 @item ENAMETOOLONG
23808 pathname was too long.
23809
23810 @item ENOENT
23811 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
23812
23813 @item ENOTDIR
23814 A component of the path is not a directory.
23815
23816 @item EROFS
23817 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
23818
23819 @item EINTR
23820 The call was interrupted by the user.
23821 @end table
23822
23823 @node stat/fstat
23824 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
23825 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
23826 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
23827
23828 @smallexample
23829 @exdent Synopsis:
23830 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
23831 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
23832
23833 @exdent Request:
23834 Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
23835 Ffstat,fd,bufptr
23836
23837 @exdent Return value:
23838 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
23839
23840 @exdent Errors:
23841 @end smallexample
23842
23843 @table @code
23844 @item EBADF
23845 fd is not a valid open file.
23846
23847 @item ENOENT
23848 A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
23849 path is an empty string.
23850
23851 @item ENOTDIR
23852 A component of the path is not a directory.
23853
23854 @item EFAULT
23855 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
23856
23857 @item EACCES
23858 No access to the file or the path of the file.
23859
23860 @item ENAMETOOLONG
23861 pathname was too long.
23862
23863 @item EINTR
23864 The call was interrupted by the user.
23865 @end table
23866
23867 @node gettimeofday
23868 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
23869 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
23870
23871 @smallexample
23872 @exdent Synopsis:
23873 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
23874
23875 @exdent Request:
23876 Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
23877
23878 @exdent Return value:
23879 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
23880
23881 @exdent Errors:
23882 @end smallexample
23883
23884 @table @code
23885 @item EINVAL
23886 tz is a non-NULL pointer.
23887
23888 @item EFAULT
23889 tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
23890 @end table
23891
23892 @node isatty
23893 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
23894 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
23895
23896 @smallexample
23897 @exdent Synopsis:
23898 int isatty(int fd);
23899
23900 @exdent Request:
23901 Fisatty,fd
23902
23903 @exdent Return value:
23904 Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
23905
23906 @exdent Errors:
23907 @end smallexample
23908
23909 @table @code
23910 @item EINTR
23911 The call was interrupted by the user.
23912 @end table
23913
23914 @node system
23915 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
23916 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
23917
23918 @smallexample
23919 @exdent Synopsis:
23920 int system(const char *command);
23921
23922 @exdent Request:
23923 Fsystem,commandptr/len
23924
23925 @exdent Return value:
23926 The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
23927 of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
23928 command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
23929 system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
23930 In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
23931
23932 @exdent Errors:
23933 @end smallexample
23934
23935 @table @code
23936 @item EINTR
23937 The call was interrupted by the user.
23938 @end table
23939
23940 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
23941 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
23942 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
23943
23944 @menu
23945 * Integral datatypes::
23946 * Pointer values::
23947 * struct stat::
23948 * struct timeval::
23949 @end menu
23950
23951 @node Integral datatypes
23952 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
23953 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
23954
23955 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
23956
23957 @smallexample
23958 int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
23959 @end smallexample
23960
23961 @code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
23962 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
23963
23964 @code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
23965
23966 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
23967 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
23968
23969 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
23970
23971 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
23972 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
23973 byte order.
23974
23975 @node Pointer values
23976 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
23977 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
23978
23979 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
23980 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
23981 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
23982 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
23983
23984 @smallexample
23985 @code{1aaf/12}
23986 @end smallexample
23987
23988 @noindent
23989 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
23990 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
23991 the trailing null byte. Example:
23992
23993 @smallexample
23994 ``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
23995 @end smallexample
23996
23997 @noindent
23998 is transmitted as
23999
24000 @smallexample
24001 @code{123456/d}
24002 @end smallexample
24003
24004 @node struct stat
24005 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
24006 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
24007
24008 The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
24009 as follows:
24010
24011 @smallexample
24012 struct stat @{
24013 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
24014 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
24015 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
24016 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
24017 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
24018 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
24019 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
24020 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
24021 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
24022 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
24023 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
24024 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
24025 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
24026 @};
24027 @end smallexample
24028
24029 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
24030 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
24031 structure is of size 64 bytes.
24032
24033 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
24034 range of values.
24035
24036 @smallexample
24037 st_dev: 0 file
24038 1 console
24039
24040 st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24041
24042 st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
24043 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
24044
24045 st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24046
24047 st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24048
24049 st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24050
24051 st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
24052 These values have a host and file system dependent
24053 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
24054 don't support exact timing values.
24055 @end smallexample
24056
24057 The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
24058 responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
24059 continuing.
24060
24061 Note that due to size differences between the host and target
24062 representation of stat members, these members could eventually
24063 get truncated on the target.
24064
24065 @node struct timeval
24066 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
24067 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
24068
24069 The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
24070 is defined as follows:
24071
24072 @smallexample
24073 struct timeval @{
24074 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
24075 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
24076 @};
24077 @end smallexample
24078
24079 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
24080 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
24081 structure is of size 8 bytes.
24082
24083 @node Constants
24084 @subsection Constants
24085 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
24086
24087 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
24088 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
24089 values before and after the call as needed.
24090
24091 @menu
24092 * Open flags::
24093 * mode_t values::
24094 * Errno values::
24095 * Lseek flags::
24096 * Limits::
24097 @end menu
24098
24099 @node Open flags
24100 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
24101 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
24102
24103 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
24104
24105 @smallexample
24106 O_RDONLY 0x0
24107 O_WRONLY 0x1
24108 O_RDWR 0x2
24109 O_APPEND 0x8
24110 O_CREAT 0x200
24111 O_TRUNC 0x400
24112 O_EXCL 0x800
24113 @end smallexample
24114
24115 @node mode_t values
24116 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
24117 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
24118
24119 All values are given in octal representation.
24120
24121 @smallexample
24122 S_IFREG 0100000
24123 S_IFDIR 040000
24124 S_IRUSR 0400
24125 S_IWUSR 0200
24126 S_IXUSR 0100
24127 S_IRGRP 040
24128 S_IWGRP 020
24129 S_IXGRP 010
24130 S_IROTH 04
24131 S_IWOTH 02
24132 S_IXOTH 01
24133 @end smallexample
24134
24135 @node Errno values
24136 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
24137 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
24138
24139 All values are given in decimal representation.
24140
24141 @smallexample
24142 EPERM 1
24143 ENOENT 2
24144 EINTR 4
24145 EBADF 9
24146 EACCES 13
24147 EFAULT 14
24148 EBUSY 16
24149 EEXIST 17
24150 ENODEV 19
24151 ENOTDIR 20
24152 EISDIR 21
24153 EINVAL 22
24154 ENFILE 23
24155 EMFILE 24
24156 EFBIG 27
24157 ENOSPC 28
24158 ESPIPE 29
24159 EROFS 30
24160 ENAMETOOLONG 91
24161 EUNKNOWN 9999
24162 @end smallexample
24163
24164 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
24165 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
24166
24167 @node Lseek flags
24168 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
24169 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
24170
24171 @smallexample
24172 SEEK_SET 0
24173 SEEK_CUR 1
24174 SEEK_END 2
24175 @end smallexample
24176
24177 @node Limits
24178 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
24179 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
24180
24181 All values are given in decimal representation.
24182
24183 @smallexample
24184 INT_MIN -2147483648
24185 INT_MAX 2147483647
24186 UINT_MAX 4294967295
24187 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
24188 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
24189 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
24190 @end smallexample
24191
24192 @node File-I/O Examples
24193 @subsection File-I/O Examples
24194 @cindex file-i/o examples
24195
24196 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
24197 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
24198
24199 @smallexample
24200 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
24201 @emph{request memory read from target}
24202 -> @code{m1234,6}
24203 <- XXXXXX
24204 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
24205 -> @code{F6}
24206 @end smallexample
24207
24208 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
24209 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
24210
24211 @smallexample
24212 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24213 @emph{request memory write to target}
24214 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
24215 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
24216 -> @code{F6}
24217 @end smallexample
24218
24219 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
24220 file descriptor (EBADF):
24221
24222 @smallexample
24223 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24224 -> @code{F-1,9}
24225 @end smallexample
24226
24227 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
24228 host is called:
24229
24230 @smallexample
24231 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24232 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
24233 <- @code{T02}
24234 @end smallexample
24235
24236 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
24237 host is called:
24238
24239 @smallexample
24240 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
24241 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
24242 <- @code{T02}
24243 @end smallexample
24244
24245 @include agentexpr.texi
24246
24247 @include gpl.texi
24248
24249 @raisesections
24250 @include fdl.texi
24251 @lowersections
24252
24253 @node Index
24254 @unnumbered Index
24255
24256 @printindex cp
24257
24258 @tex
24259 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
24260 % meantime:
24261 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
24262 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
24263 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
24264 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
24265 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
24266 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
24267 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
24268 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
24269 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
24270 \page\colophon
24271 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
24272 @end tex
24273
24274 @bye
This page took 0.567623 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.